Science Pyq All Chapters
Science Pyq All Chapters
online
k
2 : 1, that is why volume of H2 is double than that of Law of conservation of mass. It states Matter can
or
oxygen. neither be created nor be destroyed. The total mass
2. What can be seen when a strip of copper metal is of reactants must be equal to total mass of products.
w
placed in a solution of silver nitrate? 10. What is meant by a chemical reaction?
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
et
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
The solution will become blue, shiny silver metal will Chemical reaction, a process in which one or more
get deposited.
N substances, the reactants, are converted to one or more
Cu(s) + 2AgNO3(aq) $ Cu(NO3)2 (aq) + 2Ag(s) different substances, the products. Substances are
th
either chemical elements or compounds. A chemical
3. State one industrial application of reduction process.
reaction rearranges the constituent atoms of the
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
ou
4. Which one of the following is a chemical change? Give Consider the above mentioned two chemical equations
reason also. with two different kinds of arrows (- and . ) along
(a) Burning of wax (b) Melting of wax with the product. What do these two different arrows
n
burning.
12. Hydrogen being a highly inflammable gas and
5. Which one is a chemical change: oxygen being a supporter of combustion, yet water, a
@
Rusting of iron or melting of iron? compound made up of hydrogen and oxygen is used to
Ans : [CBSE 2014] extinguish fire. Why?
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Rusting of iron is a chemical change.
H2O is a compound constituted of hydrogen of oxygen
6. State one basic difference between a physical change elements and being a compound it has different
and a chemical change. properties as compared to its constituting elements.
Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2011]
13. N2(g) + 3H2(g) $ 2NH3(g), name the type of
In a physical change, no new substance is formed. reaction.
In a chemical change, new substance(s) with new
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
properties is/are formed.
Combination reaction.
7. Name the oxidising and reducing agent in the following
reaction: 14. If copper metal is heated over a flame it develops
a coating. What is the colour and composition of
CuO + H2 $ Cu + H2O
coating?
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
CuO is oxidising agent H2 is reducing agent.
Black coloured coating is formed. It is a due to
8. Write a complete balanced chemical equation for the formation of copper oxide.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 1
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 26. Complete and balance the following equation:
Fermentation of fruit juice is a chemical change. Fe2O3 + Al $
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
17. Is burning of a candle wax a physical or a chemical
change? Fe2O3 + 2Al $ 2Fe + Al2O3
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 27. Balance the following chemical equation:
Burning of a candle wax is a chemical change. Pb(NO3)2 $ PbO + NO2 + O2
Ans : [CBSE 2009]
18. Write a balanced equation for the chemical reaction
that can be characterised as precipitation reaction. 2Pb(NO3)2 Heat 2PbO + 4NO2 + O2
k
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 28. Identity the type of reaction in the following example:
or
AgNO3(aq) + NaCl(aq) $ AgCl(s) + NaNO3(aq) Na2SO4(aq) + BaCl2(aq) $ BaSO4(s) + 2NaCl(ag)
It is a precipitation reaction. Ans : [CBSE 2008(C)]
w
19. State the main difference between endothermic Double displacement reaction.
et
reaction and an exothermic reaction.
29. Identify the type of reaction in the following example:
Ans : [CBSE 2011] Fe(s) + CuSO4(aq) $ FeSO4(aq) + Cu(s)
N
In endothermic reaction, heat is absorbed. In Ans : [CBSE 2008(C)]
exothermic reaction, heat is evolved.
th
Displacement reaction.
20. What happens chemically when quick lime is added to
30. Identify the type of reaction in the following example:
ou
Combination reaction.
evolution of heat and hissing sound.
CaO(s) + H2O(l) $ Ca(OH)2(aq) 31. Balance the given chemical equation:
Al(s) + CuCl2(aq) $ AlCl3(aq) + Cu(s)
21. Define oxidation and reduction.
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 2
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
Respiration is an exothermic process because energy is collected by the method as shown in figure.
is given out in respiration.
k
(CaO)? Write the chemical equation. Ans : [CBSE 2015, CBSE 2010]
or
Ans : [CBSE 2016] a. The gas liberated is H2.
Heat b. It is collected by downward displacement of water.
(a) 2FeSO4(s) Fe2O3(s) + SO2(g) + SO3(g)
c. The gas is insoluble in water.
w
(b) Slaked lime Ca(OH)2 is formed. Hissing sound and
d. Hydrogen gas is lighter than air.
lot of heat is also produced:
et
CaO(s) + H2O(l) $ Ca(OH)2(aq) 43. Giving an example list two important information
which makes a chemical equation more useful
38. Write balanced chemical equation for the following
N (informative).
reactions: Ans : [CBSE 2015]
th
a. Hydrogen sulphide burns in air to give water and
sulphur dioxide. a. It should include physical states of reactants and
b. Barium chloride reacts in aqueous solution with products.
ou
zinc sulphate to give zinc chloride and barium b. It should specify conditions under which reaction
sulphate. takes place e.g.,
gY
nail is put inside copper sulphate solution. Write the (White ppt)
chemical equation for the reaction that occurs. Identify (a) X and Y (b) The type of reaction.
Fl
Reddish brown metal will get deposited. 2AgNO 3 (aq) + BaCl 2 (aq) $ 2AgCl . + Ba (3NO 3) 2 (aq)
Fe (s) + CuSO 4 (aq) $ FeSO 4 (aq) + Cu (s) (White ppt)
(Blue) (Pale Green) (Reddish brown) (b) The reaction is an example of double displacement
40. Name the reducing agent in the following reaction: (precipitation) reaction.
3MnO2 + 4A1 $ 3Mn + Al2O3
State which is more reactive, Mn or Al and Why? 45. (a) Write a balanced chemical equation for the process
of photosynthesis.
Ans : [CBSE 2016, 2015]
(b) When do desert plant take up carbon dioxide and
Al is the reducing agent. Al is more reactive than Mn. perform photosynthesis.
Reason: It is because Al is displacing Mn from MnO2. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
sunlight
41. “We need to balance a skeleton chemical equation”. a. 6CO2(g) + 6H2O(l) chlorophyll C6H12O6(aq) + 6O2(g)
Give reason to justify the statement. b. Desert plant take up carbon dioxide and perform
Ans : [CBSE 2015] photosynthesis at night.
We must balance a skeletal equation so as to ensure 46. Two reactions are given below:
that the reaction follows ‘Law of conservation of mass’. a. 2KI + Cl2 $ 2KCl + I2
The total mass of reactants must be equal to the total b. 2K + Cl2 $ 2KCl
mass of products, that is why all reactions should he Identify the type of reaction, giving justification in
balanced. each case.
42. A metal is treated with dilute H2SO4. The gas evolved Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 3
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
a. Displacement reaction because Cl2 is displacing I2 answer the questions which follow:
Heat
from KI solution. (i) CuO + H2 Cu + H2O
b. Combination reaction because K reacts with Cl2 (ii) ZnO + C
Heat
Zn + CO
to form potassium chloride. a. Name the substances that are oxidised and
reduced respectively in each case,
47. On heating copper powder in air, the surface of copper
b. Identify the reducing agent in each case.
powder becomes coated with black CuO. How can this
black coating be converted into brown copper? Write Ans : [CBSE 2013]
chemical equation for the reaction that occurs during a. H2 is getting oxidised to H2O, CuO getting reduced
the colour change. to Cu.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] b. H2 is reducing agent in (i) reaction whereas C is
Heat reducing agent in second reaction.
2Cu + O2 2CuO
(Black)
54. What is a redox reaction? Identify the substances
Copper oxide on heating with H2 will change back to
oxidised and the substance reduced in the following
reddish brown copper metal.
Heat reactions:
CuO(s) + H2(g) Cu(s) + H2O(g) a. MnO2+ 4HCl $ MnCl2 + Cl2 + H2O
48. What is observed when a solution of potassium iodide b. CuO + H2 $ Cu + H2O
is added to a solution of lead nitrate? Name the type Ans : [CBSE 2012]
k
of reaction. Write a balanced chemical equation to Redox reaction is a reaction in which oxidation and
or
represent the above chemical reaction. reduction takes place simultaneously.
Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2013] c. HCl is the substance oxidised, MnO2 is the
w
Yellow precipitate is formed due to formation of lead substance getting reduced.
iodide. d. H2 is getting oxidised, CuO is getting reduced.
et
It is a precipitation as well as double displacement 55. Write balanced chemical equations for the following
reaction. reactions:
Pb (NO 3) (aq) + 2KI (ag) $ PbI 2 (s) + 2KNO 3 (aq)
N a. Silver bromide on exposure to sunlight decomposes
Yellow ppt
49. Write a balanced chemical equation for the process of into silver and bromine.
th
photosynthesis and the conditions of reaction giving b. Sodium metal reacts with water to form sodium
physical state of all substances. hydroxide and hydrogen gas.
ou
Heat
b. FeSO4.7H2O(aq) FeSO4(s) + 7H2O(l) Ans : [CBSE 2012]
(Pale green) (Dirty white)
a. Oxidation reaction
@
51. Translate the following statement into chemical b. Double displacement reaction
equation and then balance it. “A metal in the form of c. Combination reaction
ribbon burns with a dazzling white flame and changes d. Displacement reaction
into white powder.”
Ans : [CBSE 2013] 57. Write balanced equation for the reaction between Mg
Burning
and hydrochloric acid. Name the product obtained,
2Mg(s) + O2(g) 2MgO(s) + Light + Heat identify the type of reaction.
52. It has been found that marble of Taj is getting corroded Ans : [CBSE 20i2]
due to development of industrial areas around it. Mg(s) + 2HCl(dil) $ MgCl2(aq) + H2(g)
Explain this fact giving a chemical equation. Magnesium chloride and hydrogen gas are formed in
Ans : [CBSE 2013] this reaction. It is a displacement reaction.
Taj is made up of CaCO3 which reacts with acid 58. a. What is colour of ferrous sulphate crystals? How
formed by pollution of SO2(g) and NO2 from Mathura does this colour change after heating?
refinery and other industries. b. Name the products formed on strongly heating
CaCO3 + 2H2SO4 $ CaSO4 + CO2 + 2H2O ferrous sulphate crystals. What type of chemical
CaCO3 + 2HNO3 $ Ca(NO3)2 + H2O + CO2 reaction occurs in this change?
53. Consider the chemical equations given below and Ans : [CBSE 2012.2009]
a. FeSO 4 $ 7H 2 O crystals are pale green in colour.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 4
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
They become dirty white on heating. 64. Translate the following statements into chemical
b. Ferric oxide, sulphur dioxide and sulphur trioxide equations and then balance them:
are formed: a. Hydrogen gas combines with nitrogen to form
Heat
2FeSO4(s) Fe2O3(s) + SO2(g) + SO3(g) ammonia.
It is a decomposition reaction. b. Hydrogen sulphide gas burns in air to give water
and sulphur dioxide.
59. Reaction of compound X with aluminium is used to c. Barium chloride reacts with aluminium sulphate
join railway tracks or cracked machine parts. to give aluminium chloride and a precipitate of
a. Identify the compound. barium sulphate. State the two types in which
b. Name the reaction. this reaction can be classified.
c. Write a balanced chemical equation for the d. Potassium reacts with water to give potassium
reaction. hydroxide and hydrogen gas.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. The compound X is Fe2O3 (Ferric oxide) or Iron a. 3H2(g) + N2(g) $ 2NH3(g)
(III) oxide. b. 2H2S(g) + 3O2(g) $ 2H2O(l) + 2SO2(g)
b. It is called Thermite Reaction. c. 3BaCl 2 (aq) + Al 2 (SO 4) 3 (aq) $ 3BaSO 4 (s) + 2AlCl 3 (aq)
Heat
c. 2Al(s) + Fe2O3(s) Al2O3(s) + 2Fe(l) This reaction can be classified as a double
displacement reaction as the two reacting species
k
60. Using balanced chemical equation explain the (BaSO4, Al2SO4)3 undergoes mutual exchange
difference between a displacement reaction and a
or
of ions. It can also be classified as precipitation
double displacement reaction. reaction, since a white ppt. of BaSO4 is obtained.
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2011] d. 2K(s) + 2H2O(l) $ 2KOH(aq) + H2(g)
w
Displacement reaction: A reaction in which a more
65. When a metal X is added to salt solution of metal Y,
reactive element displaces a less reactive element from
et
the following chemical reaction takes place:
its salt solution e.g.,
2KBr(aq) + Cl2(g) $ 2KCl(aq) + Br2(aq) Metal X + Salt solution of Y $
Double displacement reaction: A reaction in which
N
Salt solution of X + Metal Y
two compounds exchange their ions to form two new Mention the inference you draw regarding the
th
compounds e.g., reactivity of metal X and Y and also the type of
KOH + HNO3 $ KNO3 + H2O reaction. State the reason of your conclusions.
ou
61. Give an example each for thermal decomposition Ans : [CBSE 2012]
and photochemical decomposition reactions. Write X is more reactive than Y because , X displaces Y from
gY
balanced chemical equation also. its salt solution. Hence, this reaction is an example of
Ans : [CBSE 2012] displacement reaction.
Thermal decomposition: 66. Identify the type of each of the following reactions:
Heat
n
sunlight
2AgI(s) 2Ag(s) + I2(g) b. The reaction mixture becomes warm.
c. An insoluble substance is formed.
Fl
62. Why are decomposition reactions called the opposite d. External surface of the container in which reaction
of combination reactions? Give chemical equations for takes place becomes cold.
these reactions.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 5
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
k
solution to form FeSO4 (pale green) and reddish 75. Define combination reaction. Give one example of a
brown Cu metal gets deposited.
or
combination reaction which is also exothermic.
70. Balance the following reactions: Ans : [CBSE 2011]
w
a. BaCl2 + H2SO4 $ BaSO4 + HCl Combination reaction: The reaction in which two
b. Ca(OH)2 + HNO3 $ Ca(NO3)2 + H2O or more elements or compounds combine to form
et
c. Pb(NO3)2 $ PbO + NO2 + O2 compound(s) e.g.,
d. MnO2 + HCl $ MnCl2 + Cl2 + H2O N C(s) + O2(g) $ CO2(g) + Heat
Ans : [CBSE 2011, 2009, 2008, 2008C] It is an exothermic, combination reaction.
a. BaCl 2 (aq) + H 2 SO 4 (dil) $ BaSO 4 (s) + 2HCl (aq) 76. What happens when an aqueous solution of sodium
th
b. Ca (OH) 2 (aq) + 2HNO 3 $ Ca (NO 3) 2 (aq) + 2H 2 O (l) sulphate reacts with an aqueous solution of barium
Heat
c. 2Pb (NO 3) 2 (s) 2PbO (s) + 4NO 2 (g) + O 2 (g) chloride? State the physical conditions of reactants in
ou
d. MnO 2 + 4HCl $ MnCl 2 + Cl 2 + 2H 2 O which the reaction between them will not take place.
Write the balanced chemical equation for the reaction
71. Write the balanced equation for the following reactions and name the type of reaction.
gY
and identify the type of reaction in each case: Ans : [CBSE 2016, 2010]
a. Potassium bromide + Barium iodide $ White precipitate of BaSO4 is formed.
Barium bromide + Potassium Iodide BaCl 2 (aq) + Na 2 SO 4 (aq) $ BaSO 4 (s) + 2NaCl (aq)
n
a. 2KBr(aq) + BaI2 $ BaBr2(aq) + 2KI(aq) burns in air with a dazzling flame and forms a white
It is double displacement reaction. ash, is magnesium oxidised or reduced. Why?
sunlight
b. H2(g) +. Cl2(g) 2HCl(g)
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 6
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
above information answer the following questions: Oxidation reaction: The reaction in which O2 is added
a. What type of chemical reaction takes place in or H2 is removed or loss of electrons takes place is
each of the two given steps? called oxidation reaction. E.g.,
b. Name the metal initially taken in powdered form. 2Cu(s) + O2(g) $ 2CuO(s)
Write balanced equations for both the reactions. It is an exothermic reaction.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
a. Oxidation reaction, Redox reaction THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
b. Copper metal was present initially
Heat
2Cu (s) + O 2 (g) CuO (s)
(Black) 85. Decomposition reactions require energy either in the
Heat
CuO (s) + H 2 (g) Cu (s) + H 2 O (l) form of heat, light or electricity for breaking down the
(Reddish brown)
reactants. Write an equation each for decomposition
80. Why do we store silver chloride in dark coloured reactions where energy is supplied in the form of heat,
bottle? Explain in brief. light and electricity.
Ans : [CBSE 2010] Ans : [CBSE 2018, 2014]
It is done so as to cut off the exposure to sunlight. a. CaCO3(s)
Heat
CaO(s) + CO2(g)
AgCl is photosensitive, it will decompose to Ag and sunlight
b. 2AgBr(s) 2Ag(s) + Br2(g)
Cl2 in the presence of sunlight.
k
Electricity
sunlight c. 2H2O(l) 2H2(g) + O2(g)
2AgCl(s) 2Ag(s) + Cl2( g)
or
86. In the electrolysis of water:
81. “Oxidation and reduction processes occur
a. Name the gas collected at the cathode and anode
simultaneously”. Justify this statement with the help
w
respectively.
of example.
b. Why is volume of gas collected at one electrode
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
et
double than that at the other? Name this gas.
Oxidation involves loss of electrons or addition of c. How will you test this gas?
oxygen. Whereas reduction involves gam of electrons
N Ans : [CBSE 2012, CBSE Sample Paper 2018]
or addition of hydrogen e.g.,
a. Hydrogen is collected at the cathode, oxygen is
th
collected at the anode.
b. It is because H2O contains hydrogen and oxygen
ou
in the ratio 2 : 1.
c. Bring a burning matchstick near the gas, if the
H2 is getting oxidised to H2O, CuO is getting reduced gas burns with ‘pop’ sound, the gas is H2.
gY
to Cu.
It shows oxidation and reduction occur simultaneously. 87. Define the term decomposition reaction. Give
one example each of thermal decomposition and
82. When magnesium ribbon bums in air or oxygen, a electrolytic decomposition reactions.
n
product is formed. State the type of chemical reaction Ans : [CBSE 2016]
and name the product formed in the reaction. Write
yi
compounds:
Heat
It is a combination reaction. The product formed is a. CaCO3(s) CaO(s) + CO2(g)
magnesium oxide: b. 2H2O(l)
Electricity
2H2(g) + O2(g)
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 7
Chap 1 : Chemical Reactions and Equations www.cbse.online
CaCO3 ^ s h + 2HCl ^dilh $ CaCl 2 ^aqh + H 2 O ^ l h + CO2 ^g h 95. In a schematic diagram for the preparation of hydrogen
c. Change in temperature: gas as shown in the figure. What would happen if the
d. CH4(g) + 2O2(g) $ CO2(g) + 2H2O(l) + Heat following changes are made
k
b. Change in tem-perature, acid is taken?
c. Formation of precipitate. c. Sodium hydroxide is taken in place of dilute
or
Ans : [CBSE 2015] sulphuric acid and the flask is heated?
a. Change in colour: Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2010]
w
Zn (s) + FeSO 4 (aq) $ ZnSO 4 (aq) + Fe (s) a. Zinc dust will react faster, H2(g) will be liberated
Pale green (Colourless)
at a faster rate.
et
b. Change in Temperature:
b. Same volume of H2(g) will be formed.
2Mg + O2(g) $ 2MgO(s) + Heat
c. On heating Zn with NaOH, hydrogen gas will be
c. Formation of precipitate:
N formed at a faster rate.
Pb (NO 3) 2 (aq) + 2HCl (dil) $ Pbcl 2 (s) + 2HNO 3 (aq)
White ppt
th
96. (a) Why is it necessary to balance a chemical
92. State the type of chemical reactions and chemical
equation?
equations that take place in the following:
(b) Write the balanced chemical equation for the
ou
k
(P) (Yellow ppt)
or
well as precipitation reaction. b. BaCl 2 (aq) + ZnSO 4 (aq) $ BaSO 4 (s) + ZnCl 2 (aq)
sunlight c. CH4(g) + 2O2 $ CO2(g) + 2H2O(l)
2AgBr(s) 2Ag(s) + Br2(g)
w
The above reaction is photochemical decomposition
reaction. FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
100. A green coloured hydrated metallic salt on heating
et
loses water of crystallisation molecules and gives a gas
N
105. Write balanced chemical equation for the following
with suffocating smell. Identify the salt and write the statements:
chemical equation for the reaction.
th
a. NaOH solution is heated with zinc granules.
Ans : [CBSE 2011] b. Excess of carbon dioxide is passed through lime
water.
ou
acid.
101. a.Can combination reaction be an oxidation
reaction? Ans : [CBSE 2016]
b. How will you test whether the gas evolved in a a. Zn(s) + 2NaOH $ Na2ZnO2 + H2
n
c. Why does copper not evolve hydrogen on reacting c. Na2CO3 + H2SO4 $ Na2SO4 + H2O + CO2
with dilute sulphuric acid? d. CaCO3(s) + 2HCl(dil) $ CaCl2 + H2O + CO2
Fl
d. Displacement reaction: The reaction in which a surface of copper powder turns black.
more reactive element can displace a less reactive c. On heating green coloured ferrous sulphate
element. crystals, raddish brown solid is left and smell
e. Neutralisation reaction: The reaction in which of a gas having odour of burning sulphur is
acid reacts with base to form salt and water. experienced.
d. Iron nails when left dipped in blue copper sulphate
107. Define chemical reaction. State four observations solution become reddish brown in colour and the
which helps to determine whether a chemical reaction blue colour of copper sulphate fades away.
has taken place or not. Write one example of each e. Quick lime reacts vigorously with water releasing
observation with a balanced chemical equation. a large amount of heat.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2009]
Chemical reaction is a reaction which represents a a. Double displacement reaction,
chemical change. b. Oxidation,
a. Change in colour: c. Decomposition reaction,
Cu (s) + 2AgNO 3 (aq) $ Cu (NO 3) (aq) + 2Ag (s) d. Displacement reaction,
(Colourless) (Blue)
b. Evolution of gas: e. Combination reaction.
Heat
CaCO 3 (s) CaO (s) + CO 2 (g) WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
(Carbon dioxide gas)
k
c. Formation of precipitate: NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
or
Pb (NO 3) 2 (aq) + 2KI $ PbI 2 (s) + 2KNO 3 (aq) For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
(Yellow ppt)
d. Change in temperature: www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
CaO(s) + H2O(l) $ Ca(OH)2 + Heat
Bank
108. a.Define a balanced chemical equation. Why should 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
an equation be balanced?
b. Write a balanced chemical equation for the
et
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
N
following reactions: All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
(i) Phosphorus burns in the presence of chlorine provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
th
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
to form phosphorus pentachloride. New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
(ii) Burning of natural gas. study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
ou
conservation of mass.
b. (i) 2P(s) + 5Cl2(g) $ 2PCl5(S)
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 10
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
k
2. Three acidic solutions A, B and C have pH = 0, 3 and Carbon dioxide, it turns lime water milky. In this way,
or
5 respectively. CO2 gas is recognised.
a. Which solution has the highest concentration of
H+ ions? 11. What are olfactory indicators?
w
b. Which solution has the lowest concentration of Ans : [CBSE 2013]
H+ ions?
et
Those indicators whose smell changes in acidic and
Ans : [CBSE 2015] N basic solutions.
a. The solution with pH = 0 has highest concentration
of H+ ions. 12. Why does 1 M HCl solution have a high concentration
of H+ ions than 1 M CH3COOH solution?
th
b. The solution with pH = 5 has lowest concentration
of H+ ions. Ans : [CBSE 2013,2009]
It is because 1M HCl is a strong acid and it is completely
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 11
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
it is diluted? family.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
pH of the solution increases when it is diluted. NaCl, Na2CO3 are two salts belonging to sodium
family.
16. At what pH rain water is said to be acidic ?
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 26. Which among distilled water, tap water and sea water
is the best conductor of electricity?
When pH < 5.5, the rain water becomes acidic.
Ans : [CBSE 2010, 2011]
17. Which gas is evolved when dilute hydrochloric acid Sea water is a better conductor due to the presence
reacts with zinc metal? Write the molecular formula of ions.
of this gas.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 27. Name the acids present in (i) nettle sting, (ti) curd.
k
Dry HCl (g) does not form ions, therefore it does not
affect dry blue litmus. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
or
NaHCO3 is a salt that does not contain water of
19. Why is HCl a stronger acid than acetic acid? crystallisation.
w
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
29. Write the name and chemical formula of the product
HCl is completely ionised in aqueous solution whereas
et
formed by heating gypsum at 373 K.
acetic acid is only partially ionised in aqueous solution.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
20. Name the chemicals used in acid fire extinguisher and
N Plaster of Paris, CaSO . H2O1
4 2
the gas evolved from it when it is used?
th
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2011] 30. The pH of a sample of vegetable soup was found to be
6.5. How is this soup likely to taste?
NaHCO3 (Sodium hydrogen carbonate) and H2SO4
ou
(Sulphuric acid). The gas evolved is carbon dioxide. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
It will be sour in taste.
21. Which is a stronger acid, with pH = 5 or with pH=2?
gY
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 31. Which bases are called alkalies? Give one example of
alkali.
The acid with pH = 2 is a stronger acid.
Ans : [CBSE 2010,2009]
22. A compound which is prepared from gypsum has
n
23. What is meant by term pH of solution? The pH of 33. Write a balanced chemical equation for the reaction
rain water collected from two cities A’ and ‘B’ were between sodium carbonate and hydrochloric acid
found to be 6.0 and 5.0 respectively. The water of indicating the physical state of reactants and the
which city will be more acidic? products.
Ans : [CBSE 2011] Ans : [CBSE 2010]
pH of solution is defined as negative logarithm of H+ Na 2 CO 3 (s) + 2HCl (dill) $ 2NaCl (aq) + CO 2 (g) + H 2 O (l)
ion concentration. It determines the strength of acid
and base. Rainwater with pH = 5 is more acidic. 34. Name the acid and base that have constituted the salt
ammonium nitrate.
24. A few drops of sulphuric acid are added to water Ans : [CBSE 2010]
before electrolysis, why?
Acid: HNO3,
Ans : [CBSE 2011] Base: NH4OH (i.e., Nitric acid, Ammonium hydroxide).
Water is not a good conductor of electricity. Few
drops of sulphuric acid makes it better conductor of 35. Suggest one way to reduce alkaline nature of the soil.
electricity. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Add ammonium nitrate (Acidic salt) to neutralise
25. Write the names of two salts belonging to sodium
alkaline nature of soil.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 12
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
36. Oxides of metals are basic while those of non-metals 46. How does the pH change when solution of a base is
are acidic. Explain. diluted?
Ans : [CBSE 2010] Ans : [CBSE 2008]
Metal oxides dissolve in water to form base basic in When solution of a base is diluted, its pH decreases.
nature. On the other hand non-metals dissolve in
water to form acids, acidic in nature. 47. Arrange the following in an increasing order of their
pH values: NaOH solution, Blood, Lemon juice.
37. What is the difference between slaked lime and lime Ans : [CBSE 2008]
water?
Lemon juice < Blood < NaOH solution.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
The solid Ca(OH)2 is slaked lime whereas clear 48. At what pH in the mouth is tooth decay faster and
solution of Ca(OH)2 in water is lime water. why?
Ans : [CBSE 2008]
38. Write a balanced chemical equation for the
At pH lower than 5.5, tooth decay becomes faster
neutralisation reaction, mentioning the physical state
because calcium phosphate (enamel) reacts with acid
of reactants and products.
and gets corroded.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
k
NaOH(aq) + HCl(aq) $ NaCl(aq) + H2O(l)
TWO MARKS QUESTIONS
or
39. During summer season, a milkman usually adds a very
small amount of baking soda to fresh milk. Give one
reason. 49. A white chemical compound becomes hard on mixing
w
proper quantity of water. It is also used to maintain
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2009]
joints in fixed position. Name the chemical compound
et
Baking soda is basic in nature, it will not allow milk and write its chemical formula. Write the chemical
to turn sour due to the formation of lactic acid. equation to show what happens when water is added
N to this compound in proper quantity.
40. Curd is not kept in copper and brass utensils, why?
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2018, CBSE 2016]
th
Ans : [CBSE 2009C]
CaSO4. 12 H2O is the formula of the compound. The
Curd contains lactic acid which can make poisonous name of compound is ‘Plaster of Paris’ (Calcium
ou
50. Two solutions ‘A’ and ‘B’ have pH value 3.0 and 10.5
Ans : [CBSE 2009] respectively. Which of these will turn
pH value will decrease when milk changes to curd. a. Blue litmus solution to red,
b. Phenolphthalein from colourless to pink? Justify
n
42. What would be the colour of litmus in a solution of your answer in each case.
yi
The red litmus will turn blue in Na2CO3 solution. it is acidic in nature.
b. “B’ with pH = 10.5, will turn phenolphthalein
43. What is the colour of litmus in a solution of ammonium
@
54. What is meant by the term water of crystallisation? 60. 15 mL of water and 10 mL of sulphuric acid are to be
How would you show that copper sulphate crystals mixed in a beaker
contains water of crystallisation? a. State the method that should be followed with
Ans : [CBSE 2016] reason.
b. What is this process called?
The molecules of water associated with a crystalline
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
substance are called water of crystallisation.
When hydrated copper sulphate is heated its colour a. Acid should be added to the water slowly with
changes from blue to dirty white and water droplets constant cooling because the reaction is highly
are formed. exothermic.
CuSO4.5H2O
Heat
CuSO4 + 5H2O b. This process is called dilution.
If we add little water to anhydrous CuSO4, we get blue
k
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
colour again. It is the presence of molecules of water of
or
crystallisation which was lost on heating. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
CuSO4 + 5H2O $ CuSO4.5H2O www.cbse.online for
(Anhydrous) 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
Bank
55. Mention the pH of aqueous solution of the following 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
et
salts as 7, more than 7, less than 7. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
KCl, Na2CO3, NH4C1, NaNO3 (Sodium nitrate) 4. NCERT Solutions
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
N All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
KCl and NaNO3 has pH = 7 provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
th
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
Na2CO3 has pH > 7 New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
NH4Cl has pH < 7 For School Education
ou
an aqueous solution of sodium metal is basic. 62. Explain how antacid works.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
@
Sodium chloride is made up of a strong base, NaOH Antacids are weakly basic in nature. They neutralise
and a strong acid, HCl. Therefore, its aqueous solution excess of HCl present in our stomach and gives us
is neutral in nature. relief from hyper-acidity.
Sodium metal reacts with water to form NaOH(Base)
and H2 gas: 63. Equal lengths of magnesium ribbon are taken in test
2Na (s) + 2H 2 O (l) $ 2NaOH (aq) + H 2 (g) tube ‘A’ and ‘B’. Hydrochloric acid (HCl) is added to
test tube A’ while acetic acid (CH3COOH) is added
58. What is the action of litmus on to test tube ‘B’. In which test tube, will fizzing occur
a. dry ammonia gas more vigorously and why?
b. solution of ammonia gas in water? Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
The fizzing will occur more vigorously in test tube ‘A’
a. There is no effect of dry litmus on dry ammonia because HCl is a strong acid and reacts faster than
gas. acetic acid which is a weak acid.
b. Solution of ammonia will turn red litmus blue.
64. State what does pH of solution signify? Three solutions
59. State the observations you would make on adding A, B and C have pH values of 6, 2 and 10 respectively.
sodium hydroxide to an aqueous solution of Which one of these solutions is highly acidic? Which
a. ferrous sulphate, solution will turn red litmus blue?
b. aluminium chloride. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 14
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
pH of solution signifies the nature of the solution i.e., place when it is heated.
it is weakly acidic, strongly 1 acidic, neutral, weakly Ans : [CBSE 2013, 2008(C)]
basic, strongly basic.
‘X’ is NaHCO3, sodium hydrogen carbonate. It is used
‘B’ with pH = 2 is strongly acidic.
in cooking and for curing acidity in stomach.
‘C’ with pH = 10 will turn red litmus blue. Heat
2NaHCO3 Na2CO3 + CO2 +H2O
65. Define an acid and a base. Name one weak acid and
one strong acid. 72. Crystals of a substance changes their colour on heating
in a closed vessel but regained it after sometime, when
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
they were allowed to cool down.
Acid is a substance which gives H+ ions in an aqueous a. Name one such substance.
solution. b. Explain the phenomenon involved.
Base is substance which gives OH- ions in the aqueous Ans : [CBSE 2012]
solution.
CH3COOH is a weak acid, H2SO4 is a strong acid. a. CuSO4.5H2O (Hydrated copper sulphate)
Heat
b. CuSO4.5H2O CuSO4 + 5H2O
Blue (Dirty white)
66. What is universal indicator? State the purpose for
which this indicator is used. The colour changes due to the loss of molecules
of water of crystallisation. Colour is regained by
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
absorbing water molecules from the atmosphere
k
Universal indicator is a mixture of a number of containing water vapours.
or
indicators. It is used to determine pH of a solution.
73. (a) Write the name given to the bases that are highly
67. Name the natural source of each of the following acid: soluble in water. Give an example.
w
a. Citric acid, (b) Why does bee sting causes pain and irritation?
b. Oxalic acid, Rubbing of baking soda on the sting area gives
et
c. Lactic acid, relief. How?
d. Tartaric acid. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
N
(a) Highly soluble bases are called alkalies e.g., KOH.
a. Citric acid—Lemon, Orange. (b) Bee sting contains HCOOH, formic acid which
th
b. Oxalic acid—Tomato, Guava causes irritation. Baking soda (basic) neutralises
c. Lactic acid—Curd, Sour milk HCOOH, therefore it gives relief from pain on
ou
kept in aluminium containers? Write the equation for What changes will occur in his mouth? How these
the reaction that may take place for the same. changes can be controlled? Write any two measures.
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2011, 2010]
n
It because ‘Al’ reacts with NaOH to form sodium Acid will be formed in the mouth which causes tooth
meta-aluminate and hydrogen gas: decay.
yi
2Al + 2NaOH + 2H2O $ NaAlO2+3H2 a. Wash your mouth with water after every meal.
b. Brush your teeth after meal. Toothpastes are basic
Fl
69. A student detected the pH of four unknown solutions in nature and it will neutralise the acid formed in
A, B, C and D as follows: 11, 5, 7 and 2. Predict the mouth.
nature of these solutions.
@
Ans : [CBSE 2013] 75. What is a neutralisation reaction? Give one example.
pH = 11 is basic Ans : [CBSE 2011 ]
pH = 5 is acidic The reaction in which acid reacts with a base to form
pH = 7 is neutral salt and water is called neutralisation reaction e.g.,
pH = 2 is strongly acidic KOH(aq) + HNO3(aq) $ KNO3(aq) + H2O(l)
70. Give two uses of baking soda and washing soda each. 76. Write the chemical name of Plaster of paris. Write
Ans : [CBSE 2013] a chemical equation to show the reaction between
Plaster of paris and water.
Use of baking soda:
a. It is used in making of bread, biscuits, cakes. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
b. It is used as an antacid. CaSO 4 $ 12 H 2 O (Calcium sulphate hemihydrate)
Use of washing soda:
a. It is used as a cleansing agent. CaSO 4 $ 12 H 2 O + 32 H 2 O $ CaSO 4 $ 2H 2 O
b. It is used to remove hardness of water.
77. State in brief the preparation of washing soda from
71. A compound ‘X’ of sodium is commonly used for baking soda. Write balanced chemical equation of the
making crispy pakoras. It is also used for curing reaction involved.
acidity in the stomach. Identify ‘X’. Write the formula Ans : [CBSE 2011]
and its chemical name. State the reaction which takes When sodium hydrogen carbonate (Baking soda)
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 15
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
k
neutral salts: Potassium sulphate, ammonium chloride, Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
or
sodium carbonate, sodium chloride
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
4. NCERT Solutions
w
Acidic: Ammonium chloride, All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Basic: Sodium carbonate, provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
et
Neutral: Potassium sulphate, sodium chloride. Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
80. A student dropped few pieces of marble in dilute HCl For School Education
change.
attached with CaSO4?
Ans : [CBSE 2011] b. Why is sodium hydrogen carbonate an essential
a. Lime water will turn milky. ingredient in antacids?
gY
What is the name of that powder? What are the as water of crystallisation.
yi
main ingredients in it? What are the functions of each b. It is a mild base and it can neutralise hyper acidity
ingredient? without harming our body.
Fl
Ans : [CBSE 2011,2010] 86. What happens when chlorine is passed over slaked
The powder is baking powder. It consist of sodium lime at 313 K? Write chemical equation of the reaction
@
hydrogen carbonate and tartaric acid. involved and state two uses of the product.
NaHCO3 gives CO2 on heating which makes the Ans : [CBSE 2010]
bread cake soft and fluffy. Tartaric acid neutralises Bleaching powder, CaOCl2 is formed:
Na2CO3 which is bitter in taste. Ca(OH)2 + Cl2
3313 K
CaOCl2 + H2O
a. It is used as an oxidising agent.
82. HCl and HNO3 show acidic characteristics in aqueous
b. It is used as a disinfectant.
solution while alcohol and glucose solutions do not.
Give reasons. 87. What is meant by ‘water of crystallisation’ of
Ans : [CBSE 2011] a substance? Describe an activity to show that
HCl and HNO3 form H or H3O ions in aqueous
+ + blue copper sulphate crystals contains water of
solution whereas alcohol and glucose do not dissociate crystallisation.
into ions. Ans : [CBSE 2009]
HCl + H2O $ H3O+ + Cl- The molecules of water associated with a crystalline
HNO3 + H2O $ H3O + NO + - substance are called ‘water of crystallisation.’
3
CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O $ CuSO 4 + 5H 2 O
83. What is bleaching powder chemically? Give a reaction When hydrated copper sulphate is heated its colour
for its preparation. State one of its use. changes from blue to dirty white and water droplets
Ans : [CBSE 2011] are formed. If we add little quantity of water to
anhydrous CuSO4, we get blue colour again. It is those
Bleaching powder is chemically CaOCl2, calcium
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 16
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
presence of molecules water of crystallisation which chemical equation for its formation. List its two uses.
was lost on heating. Ans : [CBSE 2018]
Activity: To study the effect of heat on hydrated
The salt is NaHCO3, sodium hydrogen carbonate.
crystalline salts.
NH 3 (g) + CO 2 (g) + NaCl (g) + H 2 O (l) $ NaHCO 3 (s) + NH 4 Cl
i. Take 2 g of CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O in a test tube.
Uses:
ii. Observe the initial colour of the salt.
a. It is used as an antacid.
iii. Heat the test tube at top of burner carefully as
b. It is used in soda-acid fire extinguishers.
shown in the diagram.
iv. Record your observations. No salt has pH = 14. NaHCO3 has pH = 8.4.
v. Cool the crystals and add few drops of water.
vi. Record your observations again. 92. (a) Why does aqueous solution of an acid conduct
Observations: Blue colour of CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O is changed electricity?
to dirty white anhydrous CuSO4 and water droplets (b) How does the concentration of H3O+ ions change
were formed. On adding water, blue colour of salt was when a solution of an acid is diluted?
restored. (c) Which one has a higher pH, a concentrated or a
Conclusion: CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O is a hydrated salt which dilute solution of hydrochloric acid?
loses water of crystallisation, which on heating (d) What would to be the gas evolved on adding
becomes dirty white and regains its colour when it dilute to hydrochloric acid to
comes in contact with water. (i) Solid sodium carbonate placed in a test tube?
k
Chemical reactions involved: (ii) Zinc metal in a test tube?
or
Heat Ans : [CBSE 2018(C)]
CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O (S) CuSO 4 (s) + 5H 2 O (l)
(Blue) (Dirty white) a. It contains ions which carry current.
w
CuSO 4 (s) + 5H 2 O (l)
Heat
CuSO 4 $ 5H 2 O b. H3O+ ions will decrease when it is 7 diluted.
(Blue) c. Dilute solution has higher pH than concentrated.
et
88. Write the chemical formulae of washing soda and d. (i) CO2 gas will be formed:
baiting soda. Which one of these two is an ingredient Na2CO3 + 2HCl $ 2NaCl + H2O + CO2
of antacids? How does it provide relief in stomachache?
N (ii) Hydrogen gas will be formed:
Ans : [CBSE 2000] Zn + 2HCl $ ZnCl2 + H2
th
Na 2 CO 3 $ 10H 2 O is washing soda, NaHCO3 is baking 93. pH has a great importance in our daily life. Explain
soda. NaHCO3 is an ingredient of antacid. It neutralises by giving three examples.
ou
hyper acidity in stomach and gives relief. Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2018]
89. What is baking powder? How does it make the cake a. pH of our stomach is 2.0 and it is needed for the
soft and spongy? digestion of proteins in our body.
gY
90. 2 mL of sodium hydroxide solution is added to a few is used for the manufacture of bleaching powder.
pieces of granulated zinc metal taken in a test tube. c. Name one indicator which specifies the various
When the contents are warmed, a gas evolves which is levels of H+ ion concentration.
bubbled through a soap solution before testing. Write Ans : [CBSE 2016]
the equation for the chemical reaction involved and a. Phenolphthalein will turn pink in soap solution.
the test to detect the gas. Name the gas which will b. Chlorine is the by-product of chlor-alkali process
be evolved when the same metal reacts with dilute which is used in the manufacture of bleaching
solution of a strong acid. powder.
Ans : [CBSE 2018] c. Universal indicator specifies the various levels of
Zn (s) + 2NaOH
Worm
Na ZnO + H 2 H+ ion concentration.
2 2
(Sodium zincate)
Test: Bring a burning splinter near the gas. If it burns 95. a. Define a universal indicator. Mention its one use.
with ‘pop’ sound, the gas liberated is hydrogen. b. Solution ‘A’ gives pink colour when a drop of
Zn + H2SO4(dil) $ ZnSO4(aq) + H2 phenolphthalein indicator is added to it. Solution
Hydrogen gas will be evolved by reaction of the same ‘B’ gives a red colour when a drop of methyl
metal with dilute H2SO4, strong acid. orange is added to it. What type of solutions are
‘A’ and ‘B’ and which of these will have higher
91. The pH of a salt which is used to make tasty and pH?
crispy pakoras is 14. Identify the salt and write a c. Name one salt whose solution has pH greater than
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 17
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
a. Universal indicator is mixture of indicators used b. Na2CO3.10H2O, washing soda (Sodium carbonate
to find pH of solution. It is used to measure levels decahydrate) has 10 molecules of water of
of H+ ion concentration. crystallisation. CaSO4.2H2O, gypsum, chemically
b. ‘A’ is basic in nature, ‘B’ is acidic in nature. ‘A’ calcium sulphate dihydrate has 2 molecules of
will have higher pH than ‘B’. It should be greater water of crystallisation.
than 7.
100. You are provided with magnesium ribbon and sulphur
c. Na2CO3 is the salt whose pH is more than, CuSO4
powder. Explain with the help of activity that metal
is the salt whose pH is less than 7.
oxides are basic and oxides of non-metals are acidic
96. a. Define pH scale. Draw a figure showing variation in nature.
of pH with change in concentration of H+(aq) and Ans : [CBSE 2014]
OH-(aq) ions. Bum magnesium ribbon with the help of tongs to
b. Mention the pH of acidic, basic and neutral form white ash. Dissolve the ash in hot water. Add
solutions respectively. red litmus which turns blue, showing that MgO is a
Ans : [CBSE 2016] basic oxide.
a. pH scale is a scale which is used for measuring 2Mg(s) + O2(g) $ 2MgO(s)
k
hydrogen ion concentration in a solution. MgO(s) + H2O(Hot) $ Mg(OH)2(aq)
or
Heat sulphur taken in a iron spatula and pass the gas
through water. Add blue litmus into it. It will turn red
showing SO2 is an acidic oxide.
w
S + O2 $ SO2
SO2 + H2O $ H2SO3 (Sulphurous acid)
b. pH < 7 is for acidic solution, pH > 7 basic solution,
pH = 7 for neutral solution.
et
101. List two differences between acids and bases on the
N basis of chemical properties.
97. a. Define olfactory indicators. Name two substances Ans : [CBSE 2013]
th
which can be used as olfactoiy indicators.
b. Choose strong acids from the following: Acids Bases
ou
CH3COOH, H2SO4, H2CO3, HNO3 1. Acids turn blue litmus Bases turn red litmus
Ans : [CBSE 2015] red. blue.
a. Olfactory indicators: They give different smell in 2. Acids liberate CO2 Bases do not react
gY
acidic and basic medium e.g., onion, clove, vanilla. with metal carbonates with metal carbonates
b. HNO3 and H2SO4 are strong acids among the given and hydrogen and hydrogen
acids. carbonates. carbonates.
n
following with suitable chemical equations: 102. A substance ‘X’ is used as antacid reacts with
a. Magnesium ribbon, hydrochloric acid to produce a gas W which is used in
fire extinguishers:
Fl
b. Sodium hydroxide,
c. Crushed egg shells. a. Name the substance X and ‘Y’.
b. Write a balanced equation of the reaction between
Ans : [CBSE 20151
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 18
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
with acid produces carbon dioxide. Write the relevant b. D is strongly alkaline,
equations of all the reactions that take place. Name c. ‘C’ is strongly acidic,
any two forms in which calcium carbonate is found in d. A is weakly acidic,
nature. e. ‘E’ is weakly basic. D<E<B<A<C is the
Ans : [CBSE 2012] increasing order of H+ ion concentration.
Activity: To show reaction of metal carbonates and 107. You have been provided with three test tubes. One
metal hydrogen carbonates with dilute acids. of them contains distilled water and the other two
1. Take marble chips in Woulfe bottle. contains an acidic solution and a basic solution
2. Set the apparatus as shown in the diagram. respectively. If you are given only red litmus, how will
3. Add dilute HCl with the help of thistle funnel. you identify the contents 5 of each test tube?
4. Collect the gas and pass through lime water and Ans : [CBSE 2011 ]
bring a burning matchstick near the gas.
5. Observe what happens. Add red litmus to each of them. The test tube in
Observation: Lime water turns milky. The burning which it turns blue contains the base.
matchstick gets extinguished. Add blue litmus to the remaining two test tubes.
Conclusion: Metal carbonates react with dilute acids The one in which it turns red contains the acid. The
to liberate carbon dioxide. other one in which blue litmus and red litmus do not
Repeat the experiment with NaHCO3 taken in change contains distilled water,
k
Woulfe bottle.
108. While constructing a house, a builder selects marble
or
Observation:
CO2 gas will be evolved which turns lime water milky. flooring and marble table top for the kitchen where
Conclusion: Metal hydrogen carbonates give CO2 with vinegar and lemon juice, tamarind etc., and more
w
dilute acids. often used for cooking are to be kept. Will you agree
to this selection and why?
et
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
No, he has taken wrong decision. Marble will react
N
with vinegar and other acids and get corroded.
CaCO 3 + 2CH 3 COOH $ (CH 2 COO) 2 Ca + H 2 O + CO 2
th
109. Name the products formed in each case when:
ou
105. What is neutralisation reaction? Give two examples. FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 19
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
111. State the reason for the following statements: and H2CO3 is added in test tube ‘B’ in equal amounts:
a. Tap water conducts electricity whereas distilled a. Identify the test tube showing vigorous reaction.
water does not. b. Give reason to support your answer.
b. Dry hydrogen chloride gas does not turn blue c. Name the gas liberated in both the test tubes.
litmus red whereas dilute hydrochloric acid does. How will you prove its liberation?
c. During summer season, a milkman usually adds a d. Write chemical equations for both the reactions.
very small amount of baking soda to fresh milk. e. Out of two acids taken above, which one will have
d. For dilution of an acid, acid is added to water and lower pH value and lower H+ ion concentration
not water to acid. respectively?
e. Ammonia is a base but it does not contain Ans : [CBSE 2014]
hydroxyl group.
a. ‘A’ will show vigorous reaction.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] b. H2SO4 is a strong acid, it reacts faster than H2CO3,
a. Tap water contains ions which makes it a good a weak acid.
conductor whereas distilled water does not contain c. H2 gas. If we bring a burning splinter near the gas,
any ions. it will burn with ‘pop’ sound.
b. Dry HCl gas does not dissociate into ions, so it d. Mg + H2SO4 $ MgSO4 + H2
has no effect on the litmus. Hydrochloric acid Mg + H2CO3 $ MgCO3 + H2
form ions, so it turns blue litmus red. e. H2SO4 will have lower pH. H2CO3 will have lower
k
c. Baking soda prevents the formation of lactic acid H+ ion concentration,
or
when milk turns sour.
d. Acid is added to water slowly because the reaction 115. Write chemical equations when zinc granules react
is highly exothermic. If water is added to acid, with
w
then glass container may break due to lot of heat a. Sulphuric acid,
evolved. b. Hydrochloric acid,
et
e. NH3 dissolves in H2O forming NH4OH, therefore c. Aluminium chloride,
it acts as base: d. Sodium hydroxide,
NH3 + H2O $ NH4OH $ NH4 + OH-
N e. Nitric acid
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
112. a.State the chemical properties on which the
th
a. Zn(s) + H2SO4(dil.) $ ZnSO4(aq) + H2(g)
following uses of baking soda are based:
b. Zn(s) + 2HCl(dil) $ ZnC(aq) + H2(g)
(i) as an antacid,
ou
Write the relevant balanced chemical equation. 116. The metal salt ‘A’ is blue in colour. When salt ‘A’ is
Ans : [CBSE 2015] heated strongly over a burner, then a substance ‘B’
a. (i) It is basic in nature. present in it is eliminated and a white powder ‘C’ is
n
(ii) It liberates CO2 with acid which extinguishes left behind. When a few drops of a liquid ‘D’ is added
to powder ‘C’, it becomes blue again.
yi
fire.
(iii) It releases CO2 gas on heating which makes a. Identify A, B, C and D.
bread and cake soft and spongy. b. Write the chemical equations involved.
Fl
b. Washing soda is obtained by heating baking soda c. Give an example of the salt which also shows the
followed by crystallisation: above property.
@
b. Blue crystals of copper sulphate are heated. c. FeSO4.7H2O is a salt which also shows this
c. Chlorine gas is passed through dry slaked lime. property.
d. Carbon dioxide gas is passed through lime water.
e. NaOH solution is heated with zinc granules. 117. a.Write the chemical name and chemical formula of
Ans : [CBSE 2014] washing soda.
b. How is chlorine obtained from sodium chloride?
a. CaOCl2 + CO2 $ CaCO3 + Cl2
Heat Give equations for the reactions involved.
b. CuSO4.5H2O CuSO4 + 5H2O c. Give an example of the salt which also shows the
c. Ca(OH)2 + Cl2 $ CaOCl2 + H2O above property.
d. Ca(OH)2 + CO2 $ CaCO3 + H2O
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
e. Zn + 2NaOH $ Na2ZnO2 + H2
a. Na 2 CO 3 $ 10H 2 O , Sodium carbonate decahydrate.
114. Equal length of magnesium ribbon are taken in two b. NaCl + H 2 O + NH 3 + CO 2 $ NaHCO 3 + NH 4 Cl
test tubes A and B. H2SO4 is added to test tube ‘A’ Heat
2NaHCO 3 Na 2 CO 3 + H 2 O + CO 2
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 20
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
k
a. NaOH (Sodium hydroxide) and HCl (Hydrochloric with the help of balanced chemical equations only:
acid) form common salt. NaCl is common salt, (1) when an acid reacts with a metal carbonate,
or
sodium chloride. (2) when an acid reacts with a metal bicarbonate,
b. Rock salt is sodium chloride found in the form of (3) when an acid reacts with a metal oxide.
w
rocks. It is yellowish in colour due to the presence b. You are given three solutions A, B and C with pH
of impurities. values, 2,10 and 13 respectively. Which solution
et
c. Sodium hydroxide, H2 gas and chlorine gas will has the highest hydrogen ion concentration among
be formed: the three and state the nature ‘acidic or basic’ of
2NaCl (aq) + 2H 2 O (l) $ 2NaOH (aq) + H 2 (g) + Cl 2 (g)
N each solution.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
119. a.Explain why is hydrochloric acid a strong acid and
th
acetic acid, a weak acid. How can it be verified? a. (1)Na2CO3 + H2SO4(dil) $ Na2SO4 + H2O + CO2
b. Explain why aqueous solution of an acid conducts (2) 2NaHCO3 + H2SO4(dil) $ Na2SO4+ H2O + CO2
ou
a. Hydrochloric acid is a strong acid because it is is ‘X’ and the gas evolved? Also write a balanced
completely ionised in its aqueous solution. Acetic chemical equation for the reaction which has
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 21
Chap 2 : Acid Bases and Salts www.cbse.online
k
124. (a) A salt is produced by reaction between an acid
or
and a base. Identify the acid and base from which
the following salts have been formed:
w
(i) Na2SO4, (ii) NH4Cl, (Hi) KNO3, (iv) NaCl
(b) Which one of these will have pH less than 7 and
et
why?
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
(a) (i) Na2SO4 is prepared from NaOH and H2SO4
N
(ii) NH4Cl is formed by NH4OH and HCl.
th
(iii) KNO3 is formed by KOH and HNO3.
(iv) NaOH is formed by NaOH and HCl.
ou
125. What are strong acids and weak acids? In the following
list of acids, separate strong acids from weak acids:
hydrochloric acid, citric acid, acetic acid, nitric acid,
n
solution:
CH3COOH(aq) CH 3 OO- (aq) + H+ (aq)
Strong acids: Hydrochloric acid, Nitric acid, Sulphuric
acid.
Weak acids: Citric acid, Acetic acid, Formic acid.
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 22
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Mn and Mg.
or
a. Amphoteric oxides.
b. Lustrous. 11. What is formed when sodium absorb moisture from
air? Give equation also.
w
2. Write the chemical equation for the reaction taking Ans : [CBSE 2013]
place when steam is passed over hot Aluminium?
et
Sodium hydroxide and hydrogen gas is formed:
Ans : [CBSE 2015] N 2Na(s) + 2H2O(l) $ 2NaOH(aq) + H2(g)
Heat
2Al(s) + 3H2O(aq) Al2O3(S) + 3H2(g)
12. Why sulphide and carbonate ores are converted into
3. What happens when carbon dioxide is compressed in oxides?
th
water at high pressure? Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2015] It is because oxides are more easier to be reduced than
ou
4. Why oxides of highly reactive metals cannot be For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
reduced by carbon? www.cbse.online for
Ans : [CBSE 2015] 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
n
5. Give reason why: Electric wires are coated with plastic. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Ans : [CBSE 2015, 2014] provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 23
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
15. Name the metals Which have low melting point. 4Al(s) + 3O2(g)
Heat
2Al2O3(S)
Aluminium oxide
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2011]
Gallium and Caesium. 26. A non-metal X exists in two different forms V and Z.
Y is the hardest known natural substance, whereas Z
16. Name a non-metal which is lustrous whereas a metal is a good conductor of electricity. Identify X, Y and Z.
which is non-lustrous.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2011]
X is Carbon, Y is Diamond, Z is Graphite.
Iodine is a lustrous non-metal, Lead is a non-lustrous
metal. 27. Why does calcium float in water?
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
17. Choose the amphoteric oxide amongst the following:
Na2O, ZnO, Al2O3, CO2, H2O Calcium form hydrogen gas on reaction with water,
Ans : [CBSE 2012] bubbles of hydrogen gas sticks to the calcium metal
and that is why calcium floats in water.
ZnO and Al2O3 are amphoteric oxides. Ca(s) + 2H2O(l) $ Ca(OH)2(aq) + H2(g)
18. A green layer is gradually formed on copper plate 28. Which gas is liberated when a metal reacts with an
when left exposed to air for a week in a bathroom. acid? How will you test this gas?
What could this green substance be?
k
Ans : [CBSE 20111
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
or
Hydrogen gas is formed.
CuCO3.Cu(OH)2, Basic copper carbonate. Bring a burning splinter near the gas, it will burn with
‘pop’ sound.
w
19. Why do ionic compounds have high melting point?
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 29. An element ‘A’ form two oxides AO and AO2. The
et
It is due to strong forces of attraction between oxide AO is neutral whereas the oxide AO2 is acidic
positively charged and negatively charged ions. in nature. Would you call element ‘A’ a metal or a
N non-metal?
20. Define metallurgy. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
th
Ans : [CBSE 2012] The element is carbon which is a non- metal. CO is
Metallurgy. All the processes involved in the extraction neutral and CO2 is acidic in nature.
ou
22. How are ionic compounds formed? 31. Why do we use copper and aluminium wire for
Ans : [CBSE 2012] transmission of electric current?
Fl
23. It nature, aluminium is found in combined state conductors of electricity, therefore they are used in
whereas silver/gold are found in free state. Give transmission wires.
reason.
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2010, 2011] 32. Why do we use copper and aluminium wire for the
transmission of electric current?
Aluminium is reactive metal, therefore it is found in
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
combined state whereas silver/gold are less reactive
(noble) metals and so are found in free state. It is has 4 to 8 valence electrons, it is a non-metal.
Exception is hydrogen which has 1 valence electron
24. Why do ionic compounds conduct electricity in molten and He which has 2 valence electrons, but these are
state and not in solid state? non- metals.
Ans : [CBSE 2010,2012]
33. Name two metals which are found in nature in free
Ionic compounds do not conduct electricity in solid state.
state because ions are not free to move. In molten
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
state, ions are free to move.
Gold and silver are found in free state.
25. Write a balanced chemical equation for the reaction:
Aluminium when heated in air. Write the name of the 34. Why do we apply paint on iron grills?
product formed. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Iron grills are painted to prevent them from rusting.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 24
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
35. Why does stainless steel not get rusted easily? c. Which is used to galvanise iron articles?
Ans : [CBSE 2010] d. Whose articles when exposed to air forms a black
coating?
Stainless steel is an alloy of Fe, C, Cr and Ni, therefore
it does not get rusted. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
a. Carbon makes it hard and strong. Tungsten also
36. Why do we use gold and platinum metals in jewellery? makes it hard and strong.
Ans : [CBSE 2010] b. Mercury is alloyed with metals to form amalgam.
Gold and Platinum are lustrous metals and do hot c. Zinc metal is used for coating over iron metal to
react with substances present in the atmosphere, galvanise iron.
therefore remain lustrous for a long time. d. Silver articles acquire black coating when left
exposed to the atmosphere.
37. Which property makes solder alloy suitable for welding
electric wires? 45. Which of the following listed metals can displace zinc
from its salt solution? Give reason for your answer
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
with a chemical equation:
Its melting point is low which makes solder suitable Copper, Lead, Magnesium, Silver
for welding. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
38. What is the valency of silicon with atomic number 14? Magnesium can displace zinc from zinc salt solution
k
Ans : [CBSE 2010] because Mg is more reactive than zinc:
or
Mg(s) + ZnSO4(aq) $ MgSO4(aq) + Zn(s)
Si (2,8,4): Its valency is 4 because it can share four
electrons to become stable. 46. The reaction of metal X with Fe2O3 is highly exothermic
w
and is used to join railway tracks. Identify metal X.
39. What is the valency of phosphorus with atomic
Write the chemical equation for the reaction.
et
number 15?
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
X is Al.
P (2, 8, 5): Its valency is 3 because it can gain three
N
2Al + Fe2O3 $ Al2O3 + 2Fe
electrons to become stable.
th
47. (a) In electrolytic refining of impure copper metal,
40. What is the valency of an element with atomic number
what are used as cathode and anode?
35?
ou
it can gain one electron to become stable. (a) Pure copper is used as the cathode, impure copper
41. Arrange the following metals in decreasing order of is used as the anode.
reactivity are Na, K, Cu, Ag
n
(b)
Ans : [CBSE 2009]
yi
K > Na > Cu > Ag is the decreasing order of reactivity. 48. Write one example of each of
a. a metal which is so soft, that it can be cut with a
Fl
52. A copper plate was dipped into a solution of silver 57. Define alloy. How an is alloy prepared?
k
nitrate. After sometime a black layer was observed on Ans : [CBSE 2014]
or
the surface of copper plate. State the reason for it and
Alloy is an homogeneous mixture of two or more
write chemical equation for the reaction involved.
metals. One of them can be a non-metal also. Alloys
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
w
are made by melting two metals together and then
Copper is more reactive than Ag, therefore it can cooling it.
et
displace Ag from AgNO3 solution:
Cu(s) + 2AgNO3(aq) $ Cu(NO3)2(aq) + 2Ag(s) 58. In one of the methods of rust prevention, iron is not
coated with anything. Name that method and define
N
53. Give reason: it.
a. Carbonate and sulphide ores are usually converted Ans : [CBSE 2014]
th
into oxides during the process of extraction of
The method is alloy formation, by adding a suitable
metals.
metal or a non-metal.
ou
jewellery.
a. It is easier to reduce an oxide than sulphide and b. Sodium, potassium and lithium are stored under
yi
included in the activity series. into oxides during the process of extraction.
d. Zinc is more reactive than iron, therefore it will Ans : [CBSE 2013, 2014]
get easily oxidised in preference to Fe and hence
protect iron from rusting even if zinc coating is a. It is because they are lustrous metals.
broken. b. These are highly reactive metals.
c. It forms an oxide layer on its surface which makes
54. A compound Z is formed by transfer of electrons from it passive.
the metal X to a non-metal Y, Identify the type of d. It is easier to reduce a metal oxide than sulphides
bond formed in the compound. List three properties and carbonates.
of compound formed by such type of bonds.
60. What happens to potassium and sodium if they are
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
kept in open? Why are they 3 immersed in kerosene
The bond formed is ionic bond: oil?
a. The compound will have high melting and boiling Ans : [CBSE 2013]
point.
b. It will be soluble in water. Potassium and Sodium if kept in open, can catch the
c. It will conduct electricity in molten state as well presence of moisture.
as in aqueous solution. They are immersed in kerosene so that they do
not react with air and H2O present in the atmosphere.
55. Give reason for the following:
a. School bells are made up of metals. 61. Why hydrogen gas is not evolved when a metal reacts
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 26
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
k
Roasting Calcination One of them can be a non- metal also.
or
1. It is done in the It is done in the Alloys are made by melting two metals together
presence of oxygen. absence of oxygen. and then cooling it.
w
2. It is done with It is done with 70. Why do silver articles turn black and copper items
sulphide ores eg. carbonate ores e.g. turn green after sometime?
oxide.
Cu2S(s) + 3O2(g) $ 2Cu2O(s) + SO2(g)
b. Ionic compounds conduct electricity in molten
b. Self-Reduction:
state.
@
Heat
Cu2S(s) + 2Cu2O(s) 6Cu(s) + SO2(g)
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
66. Explain, why calcium metal after reacting with water a. Al2O3 reacts with acids as well as bases, therefore
starts floating on its surface. Write the chemical it is regarded as amphoteric oxide.
equation for the reaction. b. In molten state, ions are free to move, therefore it
Ans : [CBSE 2013, 2012] conducts electricity.
Calcium reacts with water to form Ca(OH)2 and H2
73. How do properties of iron change when
gas.
a. a small quantity of carbon is mixed in it?
Ca(s) + 2H2O(l) $ Ca(OH)2(aq) + H2(g)
b. nickel and chromium are mixed in it?
The bubbles of hydrogen gas sticks to the surface of
calcium and therefore it floats over water. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. It becomes hard and does not get rusted.
67. When a metal X is reacted with cold water, it gives b. It becomes lustrous and malleable and so it does
a basic compound Y with molecular formula XOH not get rusted.
(Molecular mass 40) and liberates a gas Z which easily
catches fire. Identify X, Y, Z. 74. You must have seen tarnished copper vessels being
Ans : [CBSE 2013, 2012] cleaned with lemon or tamarind juice. Explain why
these sour substances are effective in cleaning the
X is Na (Sodium).
vessels.
2Na(s) + 2H2O(l) $ 2NaOH(aq) + H2(s)
(Cold) Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 27
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
Copper vessel coated with a green layer of CuCO3. and then cooling the mould of two metals being mixed
Cu(OH)2 which reacts with acid present in lemon or that forms the alloy.
tamarind juice and get removed it. Some substances Solder is an alloy of lead and tin. It has low melting
contain acids which react with basic substances to point, therefore it is used for welding purposes.
form soluble salt which can be easily removed.
82. Using the electronic configuration, explain how
75. Name two metals which can be used to reduce metal magnesium atom combines with oxygen atom to form
oxides to metals. magnesium oxide by transfer of electrons.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Aluminium and Magnesium
2Al + Fe2O3 $ Al2O3 + 2Fe
3Mg + Fe2O3 $ 3MgO + 2Fe
k
c. It helps to modify reactivity. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
or
d. It lowers the melting point. Al2O3 + 2NaOH $ 2NaAlO2 + H2O
Al2O3 + 3H2SO4 $ Al2(SO4)3 + 3H2O
77. State four general properties of ionic compounds.
w
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 84. Why is carbon not used for reducing aluminium oxide
a. They are soluble in water. to obtain Al?
et
[CBSE 2010]
b. They are hard but brittle solids.
or
c. They conduct electricity in solid state and in their
N Metals placed high in reactivity series cannot be
aqueous solution.
obtained from their compounds by heating with
d. They have high melting and boiling points.
th
carbon?
78. The way, metals like sodium, magnesium and iron Ans : [CBSE 2011]
ou
react with air and water is an indication of their It is because Al itself is a strong reducing agent,
relative positions in the ‘reactivity series’. Is this therefore it cannot be reduced by carbon.
statement true? Justify your answer with example.
gY
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 85. A metal A which is used in thermite process, when
heated with oxygen gives an oxide B which is
Yes, Na reacts vigorously with cold water because it
amphoteric in nature. Identify A and B. Write down
is highly reactive. Magnesium reacts with hard water
the reactions of oxide of B with HCl and NaOH.
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 28
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
k
brownish. What is the reason for this? Write the Na+ + e- $ Na
or
balanced chemical equation for this. At anode:
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Cl- e- $ Cl
w
Aluminium is more reactive than copper, Cl + Cl $ Cl 2
2Al(s) + 3CuSO4(aq) $ Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 3Cu(s) Metals in the middle of the reactivity series are
90. Zinc does not evolve hydrogen gas on reacting with
i.
, are electron dot structure of Na and chlorine with stream of water to remove earthly impurities.
yi
atoms. Sodium can lose an electron and Cl gains that ii. Calcination: Carbonate ores is heated strongly in
electron and they form an ionic bond. the absence of air to form oxides e.g.,
Fl
Heat
ZnCO3 ZnO + CO2
iii. Reduction: ZnO is reduced with carbon to get Zn:
ZnO + C $ Zn + CO
@
92. Give reason for the following: At cathode: Zn2+ + 2e- $ Zn(s)
(Pure)
a. Metals can be given different shapes according to
b. Copper sulphite is concentrated by froth floation
our needs.
process.
b. Hydrogen is not evolved when a metal reacts with
i. 2Cu2S + 3O2 $ 2Cu2O + 2SO2
nitric acid.
ii. Reduction: Cu2S + 2Cu2O $ 6Cu + SO2
Ans : [CBSE 2008(C)] iii. Electrolytic refining:
a. Metals are malleable, therefore they can be given At cathode: Cu2+ + 2e- $ Cu
(pure)
different shapes.
At anode: Cu $ Cu2+ + 2e-
b. It is because HNO3(dil.) is a good oxidising agent. (Impure)
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 29
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
k
b. At ordinary temperature the surface of metals
such as magnesium, aluminium, zinc etc. is covered
or
99. a. What is an alloy? How is it prepared? Give two
with a thin layer. What is the composition of this examples of alloys.
layer? State its importance. b. Iron is not used in pure state. Give reason.
w
c. Some alkali metals can be cut with knife. Ans :
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
et
a. Alloy is a homogeneous mixture of two or more
a. These oxides are basic in nature and their solution metals. One of them can be a non-metal also.
are called alkalies. Alloys are made by melting two metals together
N
b. The composition of this layer is metal oxide. It and then cooling it. Example: Brass and Bronze
prevents the metal from corrosion. b. Iron gets rusted, therefore it is not used in pure
th
c. Sodium can be cut with a knife because it is a state.
very soft metal.
ou
b. The best conductor of heat and poorest conductor the metal, write the name and chemical formula of
of heat. green coloured compound. List two ways to prevent
c. ‘A metal with highest melting point and a metal this process.
with lowest melting point. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
n
a. Gold is most malleable and ductile. Chemical formula of green coloured compound is
b. Copper is the best conductor and lead is a poor CuCO3.Cu(OH)2
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 30
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
c. Food cans are coated with tin rather than zinc. is malleable and ductile.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] c. Sulphur does not conduct electricity whereas
magnesium conducts electricity.
a. It is because copper is more reactive than silver,
it will displace Ag from AgNO3 solution. Thus 106. A metal forms an oxide having formula M2O3. It
we can’t store AgNO3 in a copper container but dissolves both in dilute sulphuric acid as well as dilute
CuSO4 can be stored in silver vessel as no reaction sodium hydroxide solution. Identify the metal and
will take place because silver is less reactive. write the equations for the reactions involved.
b. Dilute HNO3 is an oxidising agent. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
c. Tin is less reactive and less expensive than zinc.
The metal is Al. Its oxide is Al2O3.
103. Name a metal in each case: Al2O3 + 2NaOH $ NaAlO2 + H2O
a. It displaces hydrogen gas on reaction with nitric Al2O3 + 3H2SO4(aq) $ Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 3H2O(l)
acid.
b. It does react with any physical state of water. 107. State the conditions under which the following metals
c. It does not react with cold water or hot water, but react with water. Write chemical equation for its
reacts with steam. reaction with each: (a) Na (b) Mg (c) Fe
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
a. Mg and Mn (a) Sodium metal reacts with cold water as:
k
b. Cu 2Na + 2H2O $ 2NaOH + H2
or
c. Iron (b) Magnesium reacts with hot water as:
Mg + 2H2O $ Mg(OH)2 + H2
104. Distinguish between the following: (c) Iron reacts with steam as:
w
a. Electrolytic reduction and electrolytic refining. 3Fe + 4H2O $ Fe3O4 + 4H2
b. Mineral and ore.
et
c. Alloys and amalgams 108. What is cinnabar? How is metal extracted from
cinnabar? Explain briefly.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
N Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Electrolytic reduction Electrolytic refining Cinnabar (HgS) is an ore of mercury.
th
Roasting: HgS(s) + O2(g) $ 2Hg(l) + SO2(g)
Metal is obtained by Metal is refined by
Cinnabar, on roasting gives Mercury and sulphur
electrolysis of molten taking impure metal as
ou
substances from substances from which a. and are electron dot structures.
which metal may or metal is extracted
Fl
Alloys amalgams
Homogeneous mixture of Homogenous mixture
two or more metals. One of mercury with any
of them can be a non- other metals e.g., zinc c. and ions are present in KCl.
metal also e.g., steel. amalagam. 110. a.Write the electron-dot structure of calcium and
sulphur.
105. State three reasons for the following facts: b. Show the formation of CaS by transfer of electrons.
a. Sulphur is a non-metal. c. Name the ions present in the compound, CaS.
b. Magnesium is a metal. Atomic number of Ca = 20, S = 16.
One of the reason must be supported with a chemical
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
equation.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] a. and
a. Sulphur is a non-metal because it reacts with O2 b.
to form SO2 which is an
acidic oxide: S + O2 $ SO2
Magnesium is a metal which reacts with O2 to
form basic oxide:
2Mg + O2 $ 2MgO c. and are present in CaS.
b. Sulphur is not malleable and ductile, magnesium
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 31
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
111. Give one most suitable word for the following Heat
statements: c. Cr2O3(s) + 2Al(s) Al2O3(s) + 2Cr(l)
a. Metal oxides which show basic as well as acidic
116. A, B and C are three elements which undergo chemical
behaviour.
reactions according to the following equations:
b. Some metals produce a sound on striking with a
A2O3 + 2B $ B2O3 + 2A ,
hard surface.
3CSO4 + 2B $ B2(SO4)3 + 3C
c. Iodine, shining non-metal.
3CO + 2A $ A2O3 + 3C
Ans : [CBSE 2015] a. Which element is most reactive?
a. Amploteric oxide, b. Which element is the least reactive?
b. Sonorous, c. What type of reactions is listed above?
c. Lustrous. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
112. State the property utilised in the following: a. B is most reactive.
a. Graphite in making electrodes. b. C is least reactive.
b. Electric wires are coated with polyvinyl chloride c. Displacement reactions.
(PVC) or rubber like materials.
117. List three properties of sodium in which it differs from
c. Metal alloys are used for making bells and strings
general physical properties of most metals.
of music instruments.
k
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
a. It is soft.
or
a. Graphite is a good conductor of electricity.
b. It has low melting and boiling point.
b. PVC is an insulator, protects us from electric
c. It is not malleable and ductile.
current.
w
c. Alloys are stronger and more sonorous than metals NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
and used for bells and musical instruments. They
et
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
do not get rusted.
www.cbse.online for
113. Write chemical equations for the reactions taking
N
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
place when: Bank
th
a. Iron reacts with steam. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
b. Magnesium (Mg) reacts with dilute HCl. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
c. Copper is heated in air. 4. NCERT Solutions
ou
Ans : [CBSE 2014] All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Heat
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
a. 3Fe(s) + 4H2O(g) Fe3O4(s) + 4H2(g) Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
gY
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
b. Mg(s) + 2HCl(dil.) $ MgCl2(aq) + H2(g) study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
c. 2Cu(s) + O2(g) $ 2CuO(s)
anode during the electrolytic refining of copper. The process in which iron reacts with oxygen in the
Ans : [CBSE 2014] presence of moisture to form brown layer on its surface
is called rusting.
a. The impurities left behind at anode after impure
copper metal undergoes electrolytic refining is
called anode mud.
b. At anode:
Cu (s) $ Cu2+ (aq) + 2e-
(impure)
At cathode:
Cu2+ (aq) + 2e- $ Cu (s)
(Pure)
k
At cathode, pure metal is deposited. Cathode is made
up of pure metal. Anode is made up of impure metal.
or
Soluble salt of metal is used as electrolyte.
126. a.Show the formation of Na2O by transfer of
w
122. Write the balanced chemical equation in each case: electrons between the combining atoms.
a. Mg metal is reacted with very, little amount of b. Why are ionic compounds usually hard?
et
dilute HNO3. c. How is it that ionic compound in the solid state
b. Aluminium powder is added to Fe2Og. do not conduct electricity but they do so in the
c. Zinc sulphide is roasted. molten state?
N
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Ans : [CBSE 2012]
th
a. Mg (s) + 2HNO 3 (S) $ Mg (NO 3) 2 (aq) + H 2
a.
3Mg (s) + dil.HNO 3 $ Mg (NO 3) 2 + 2NO + 4H 2 O
ou
b. Metal B which gives vigorous reaction even with c. In solid state, ions are not free to move but in
water and air.
yi
Zn:
ZnS + 2ZnO $ 3Zn + SO2
ZnO + C $ Zn + CO
129. Observe the two test tubes A and B as shown in b. It is an ionic compound.
the diagram given below and answer the following 1. It is soluble in water.
questions : 2. It conducts electricity in molten state and in
aqueous solution.
3. It is a hard solid.
k
b. Write a balanced chemical equation for the Ans : [CBSE 2015]
or
reaction. a. Carbonate ores are calcined e.g.,
Heat
c. Name the type of reaction. CuCO3(s) CuO(s) + CO2(g)
Ans : [CBSE 2008(C)] b. It is obtained in oxide form. It is reduced by using
w
a suitable reducing agent e.g.,
a. In the first test tube reaction will take place. Heat
CuO(s) + C Cu(s) + CO(g)
et
b. Fe(s) + CuSO4(aq) $ FeSO4(aq) + Cu(s)
c. Displacement reaction.
N c. Al and Mg.
a. It is a carbonate ore.
a. Corrosion: The process in which a metal react (i) Hydraulic washing, (ii) Calcination,
yi
d. It weakens bridges and materials and a lot of iron 134. a.Define activity series of metals. Arrange the
gets wasted every year. metals: gold, copper, iron and magnesium in the
e. We can prevent corrosion of iron by order of their increasing reactivity.
1. Painting, b. What will you observe when:
2. Oiling and greasing, (1) Some zinc pieces are placed in copper sulphate
3. Galvanisation, solution.
4. By forming its alloys. (2) Some silver pieces are placed into green
coloured ferrous sulphate solution.
131. a.Write electron dot diagrams of chlorine (At. No. Ans : [CBSE 2013]
17) and calcium (At. No. 20). Show the formation
of calcium chloride by transfer of electrons. a. The series in which metals are arranged in
b. Identify the nature of the above compound decreasing order of reactivity is called activity
and explain three physical properties of such a series of metals. The metal at the top is most
compound. reactive, followed by less reactive metal and so on.
The metal at the bottom is least reactive.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Au < Cu < Fe < Mg is the increasing order of
a. reactivity.
b. (1) The solution will become colourless, reddish
brown copper metal will get deposited:
Zn(s) + CuSO4(aq) $ ZnSO4(aq) + Cu(s)
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 34
Chap 3 : Metals and Non-Metals www.cbse.online
135. A metal (E) is stored under kerosene oil. When a small This reaction need heat to start but it is highly
piece of it is left open in air, it catches fire. When exothermic.
the product formed is dissolved in water, it turns red This reaction belongs to the category of:
litmus blue. (1) Displacement reaction,
a. Name the metal (E). (2) Redox reaction.
b. Write the chemical equation for the reaction 137. Four metals A, B, C and D are added to the following
when it is exposed to air and when the product is aqueous solutions one by one. The observations made
dissolved in water. are tabulated below:
c. Explain the process by which metal is obtained
from its molten chloride. Iron (II) Copper (II) Zinc Silver nitrate
Ans : [CBSE 2012,2011] sulphate sulphate sulphate
A No Reaction Reddish Brown .......... ..........
a. E is sodium metal. Deposit
b. 2Na + 2H2O $ 2NaOH + H2
B Grey Deposit .......... No Reaction ..........
H2 gas will catch fire.
NaOH turns red litmus blue. C No Reaction No Reaction No Reaction White Shining
k
4Na(s) + O2(s) $ 2Na2O(s) Deposit
Na2O + H2O(aq) $ 2NaOH(aq)
or
D No Reaction No Reaction No Reaction No Reaction
c. It is obtained by electrolytic reduction e.g., ‘Na’
metal is obtained by electrolysis of molten NaCl: Answer the following questions based on the above
w
NaCl
Electrolysis
N+ + Cl- observations:
Molten a. Which is the most active metal and why?
At cathode: Na+ + e- $ Na
et
b. What would be observed if B is added to copper
At anode: Cl- $ Cl + e- (II) sulphate solution and why?
Cl + Cl $ Cl2 c. Arrange the metals A, B, C and D in order of
N
increasing reactivity.
136. a.Write two differences between calcination and d. Container of which metal can be used to store
th
roasting. [CBSE 2012] both zinc sulphate solution as well as silver nitrate
b. ‘No reaction takes place when granules of a solid solution?
ou
‘A’ is mixed with a powder of solid ‘B’. However e. Which of the above solutions can be easily stored
when the mixture is heated, a reaction starts with in a container made up of any of these metals?
the evolution of much heat. Product ‘C’ of the
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2009]
gY
a. Based on this information, make assumptions b. B will displace copper from CuSO4 solution
yi
about metals ‘A’ and ‘B’ and corresponding because it is more reactive than Cu.
deductions about ‘C’ and ‘D’ and write a balanced c. D is least reactive and D<C<A<B is the
chemical equation for the reaction. Include in increasing order of reactivity.
Fl
the chemical equation about the physical states d. Container of metal D can be used to store both
of the reactants and products, need for heating ZnSO4 and AgNO3.
@
for starting the reaction and the reaction being e. Zinc sulphate solution can be stored in container
exothermic. made up any of the metals A, B, C, D because none
b. Name two types of chemical reactions to which of them could displace zinc from zinc sulphate as
this reaction can belong to. these are less reactive than zinc.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 35
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
9. Write the molecular formula of 2nd and 3rd member
or
2. Write the molecular formula of first two members of
of the homologous series whose first member is ethene.
homologous series having functional group —Br.
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
w
(1) CH2=CH—CH3 Propene
(1) CH3Br Bromomethane
(2) CH2=CH—CH2—CH3 1-Butene
et
(2) C2H5Br Bromoethane
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
3. Write the molecular formula of first two members of
N
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
homologous series having functional group —OH.
www.cbse.online for
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
th
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
(1) CH3OH Methanol Bank
(2) C2H5OH Ethanol
ou
5. Write the formula of first two members of homologous 10. Write the next homologue of each of the following:
series whose functional group is —CHO. a. C2H4
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 36
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
carbon atoms in its molecules. 23. Write the next homologue of propanol CH3CH2CH2OH
Ans : [CBSE 2016] and butanal CH3CH2CH2CHO.
CH3CH2CH2OH, 1-Propanol Ans : [CBSE 2016,2011]
a. CH3CH2CH2CH2OH, Butanol
14. Write the name and structure of an alcohol with four b. CH3CH2CH2CH2CHO, Pentanal
carbon atoms in its molecule.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] 24. Unsaturated hydrocarbon gives a yellow flame with
lot of black smoke when burnt in oxygen. Give reason.
CH3CH2CH2CH2OH, 1-Butanol
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
15. Write the name and structure of an aldehyde with Unsaturated hydrocarbons have more amount of
four carbon atoms in its molecule. carbon, therefore burns with smoky flame due to
Ans : [CBSE 2016] incomplete combustion.
k
16. Which element exhibits the property of catenation to 26. Carbon has four electrons in its valence shell. How
or
maximum extent and why? does carbon attain stable electronic configuration?
Ans : [CBSE 2016] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
w
Carbon because it can form strong covalent bond with Carbon can share four electrons to acquire stable
other carbon atoms due to smaller size. electronic configuration.
which have same functional group and similar chemical CH3—CH3, Ethane
properties and each successive member has more — 29. Write the name and formula of 2nd member of
CH2 unit than the previous one. homologous series having general formula C n H 2n - 2 .
n
19. A colourless gas X has a formula C3H6. It decolourises Ans : [CBSE 2015]
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 37
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
groups: compounds.
Ans : [CBSE 2014,2010]
a. —OH b. (a) Tetravalency (b) Catenation
Ans : [CBSE2015]
41. The molecular formula of A is C10H18 and B is C18H36.
a. Alcohol Name the homologous series to which they belong.
b. Ketone
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
34. Write the name and molecular formula of the first C10H18 belongs to alkyne, C18H36 belongs to alkene.
member of homologous series of alkynes.
Ans : [CBSE2015] 42. Write the names of next homologue of CH3CH2OH
and HCOOH.
HC=CH, Ethyne
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
35. Mention the functional group which always occurs at (i) CH3CH2CH2OH, Propanol
the terminal position of a carbon chain of an organic (ii) CH3COOH, Ethanoic acid
compound.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] 43. Will micelle formation take place when soap is
dissolved in organic solvent?
a. Aldehyde
k
b. Carboxylic acid Ans : [CBSE 2014]
No, micelles will not be formed in organic solvent.
or
36. The formula of citric acid is shown below:
44. Explain why washing clothes with hard water is not
w
effective.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
et
Soap reacts with Ca 2+
and Mg 2+
ions present in hard
water to form scum.
N
45. Draw the structure of simplest ketone.
th
Ans : [CBSE 2014,2011]
ou
Carboxylic acid
38. State the valency of each carbon atom in (i) an alkane 47. What happens when a small piece of sodium is
and (ii) an alkyne. dropped into ethanol?
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Ans : [CBSE 2013,2011]
i. The valency of ‘C’ in alkane is 4. Sodium ethoxide and H2 gas is formed
ii. The valency of ‘C’ in alkyne is also 4. 2C2H5OH + 2Na $ 2C2H5ONa + H2
39. Write the molecular formula of benzene and state the 48. What will you observe on adding a 5% alkaline KMnO4
number of double bonds in its structure. solution drop by drop to some warm ethanol taken in
Ans : [CBSE 2014] a test tube? Write the name of the compound formed
during the above chemical reaction.
Ans : [CBSE 2013,2011]
The purple colour of KMnO4 decolourises and ethanoic
is benzene or acid will be formed
Alk. KMNO
C2H5OH CH2OOH
4
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 38
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
52. Name the functional group present in each of the
or
61. Draw the structure of butanone molecule,
following compounds:
CH3COC2H5.
a. CH3COCH3
w
b. C2H5COOH Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. Ketone
b. Carboxylic acid
et
N
53. Write the name and formula of the second member
th
of carbon compounds having functional group —OH. 62. Draw the structure of ethanoic acid molecule,
Ans : [CBSE 2012] CH3COOH.
ou
Methanal
C5HnCHO.
55. Write the name and formula of the first member of Ans : [CBSE2011]
Fl
Methanoic acid
56. Write the name and formula of the 2nd member of the
series of carbon compounds whose general formula is 64. Butanone has four carbon per molecule of a compound.
CnH2n+1—OH. Name the functional group present in it.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
57. Write the name and formula of 2nd member of the 65. Name the following compound:
series of carbon compounds whose general formula is
CnH2n.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
CH2=CH—CH3, Propene
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
58. State the difference between oils and fats.
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2012] 1-Hexyne
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 39
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
or
69. Name the compound formed when ethanol is warmed b. Sodium ethoxide and hydrogen gas is formed.
with ethanoic acid in the presence of few drops of 2C2H5OH + 2Na $ 2C2H5ONa + H2
cone. H2SO4.
w
Ans : [CBSE 2009 (C)] 76. State reasons to explain why covalent compounds:
a. are bad conductors of electricity?
et
Ethyl ethanoate
Con. H 2 SO 4 b. have low melting and boiling points?
CH3COOH + CH3CH2OH T
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
N
CH3COOC2H5 + H2O a. Covalent compounds do not form ions, hence they
th
70. What is the difference in the molecular formula of
are bad conductor of electricity.
any two consecutive members of homologous series of b. Covalent compounds have weak intermolecular
forces of attraction, therefore, have low melting
ou
organic compounds?
and boiling points.
Ans : [CBSE 2008 (C)]
The difference between successive members of 77. What is homologous series? Write the name and draw
gY
homologous series is of —CH2 unit. the structure of the second member of alkene series.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
TWO MARKS QUESTIONS a. The series of organic compounds having same
n
72. Explain why cannot we have isomers of first three 78. List two characteristics of covalent compounds.
members of alkane family. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2017, CBSE 2015] (i) They have low melting and boiling point.
It is because branching is not possible with carbon (ii) They do not conduct electricity.
atoms, that is why, there are no isomers till propane.
79. Name an element, other than carbon, which exhibits
73. Write balanced equations for the burning of (a) property of catenation up to seven or eight atoms. Are
methane (b) ethane in air. these compounds stable?
Ans : [CBSE 2017] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
(a) CH4(g) + 2O2(g) $ CO2(g) + 2H2O(l) Si and Sulphur (S8).
(b) 2C2H6(g) + 7O2(g) $ 4CO2(g) + 6H2O(l) No, these compounds are not stable, rather they are
reactive.
74. Compare the structures of benzene and cyclohexane
by drawing them. 80. Select alkenes and alkynes from the following:
C2H4, C3H4, C2H2, C4H8
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
Ans : [CBSE 2015,2014]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 40
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
Alkenes C2H4, C4H3 Alkynes C3H4, C2H2 88. Give the electron dot structure of chloro-methane. Also
write the formula and the name of next homologue of
81. Why are detergents preferred over soaps for washing it.
clothes in hard water? Explain.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2015,2014]
Detergents work well even with hard water because
their calcium and magnesium salts are soluble in
water. They do not form scum.
T
CH3COOC2H5 + H2O
89. The structural formula of an ester is
k
83. Name the functional groups of the following
compounds:
or
a. b.
Write the structural formula of the corresponding
w
alcohol and acid.
c. R—OH d. R—X
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
et
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
a. Carboxylic acid
N
b. Ester
c. Alcohol
th
d. Halogen
ou
it is used to convert vegetable oils to vegetable ghee. surface area increases which results an increase in
vander Waal’s forces of attraction between molecules.
yi
87. What are soaps? Why do they form scum with hard 92. Explain the action of soap in removing an oily spot
water? from a piece of cloth.
Ans : [CBSE 2013] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Soaps are sodium or potassium salts of fatty acids e.g. Cleansing action of soap: Soap has ionic end which
sodium stearate. They react with Ca2+ and Mg2+ ions is hydrophilic, interacts with water while carbon
in hard water to form calcium and magnesium salt chain is hydrophobic interacts with oil, grease. The
of fatty acids which are insoluble in water and called soap molecules orient themselves in a cluster in which
scum. hydrophobic tails are inside the cluster and ionic ends
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 41
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
b. Carbon forms only covalent bonds. 99. A compound X on heating with excess of cone. H2SO4
or
Ans : [CBSE 2011] at 443 K gives an unsaturated compound Y. X also
a. Unsaturated hydrocarbons have double or triple reacts with sodium metal to evolve a colourless gas
w
bonds to which a molecule can be added whereas Z. Identify X, Y and Z. Write the equations of the
saturated hydrocarbons have single bonds chemical reaction of formation of Y and also write the
et
addition reaction cannot take place. role of conc. sulphuric acid in the reaction.
b. It cannot lose four electrons because high energy Ans : [CBSE 2016]
is required. It cannot gain four electrons because
N X is CH3CH2OH, Ethanol Y is Ethene, Z is H2.
6 protons cannot hold 10 electrons. Thus it shares Conc $ H SO
C 2 H 5 OH CH 2 = CH 2 + H 2 O
2 4
th
four electrons to form covalent bonds and become X
443K Y
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 42
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
106. Two carbon compounds ‘X’ and ‘Y’ have the molecular
formula C3H6 and C4H10 respectively. Which one of the
two is most likely to show addition reaction? Justify
your answer. Also give chemical equation to explain
the process of addition in this case.
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
C3H6 will undergo addition reaction because it has
double bond.
Ni
CH2=CH—CH3 + H2 Heat CH3—CH2—CH3
Propene Propane
k
Con. H SO
b. C2H5OH CH2=CH2 + H2O
2 4
443 K
or
c. CH3COOH + NaHCO3 $
CH3COONa + H2O + CO2
w
108. The molecular formula of two carbon compounds
are C4H3 and C3H8. Which one is most likely to show
et
addition reaction? Justify your answer. Also give the
These are functional isomers.
chemical equation to explain the process of addition
N reaction in this case.
103. The carbon compounds X and Y have the molecular
formula C4H3 and C5H12 respectively. Which one of Ans : [CBSE 2017]
th
these is most likely to show addition reaction? Justify C4H3 will undergo addition reaction. It is because it is
your answer. Also give chemical equations to explain unsaturated compound.
ou
443 K
b. CH3COOH + NaOH $
Conc. H SO Concentrated H2SO4 is dehydrating agent.
c. C2H5OH + CH3COOH
2 4
Con. H 2 SO 4
+ H2O C2H5OH + CH3COOH
CH3COOC2H5 + H2O
105. Complete the following reactions: Ester
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 43
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
a. Ethanol is burnt in air? 114. Explain giving reasons, why carbon can neither form
b. Ethanol is heated with excess cone. H2SO4 at 443 C4+ cation nor C4- anion but forms covalent compounds
K? which are bad conductors of electricity and have low
c. A piece of sodium is dropped in ethanol. melting and boiling points.
Ans : [CBSE 2017] Ans : [CBSE 2017]
a. CO2 and H2O are formed. Carbon cannot lose four electrons because high energy
C2H5—OH + 3O2 $ 2CO2 + 3H2O is needed to remove four electrons. It cannot gain 4
b. Ethene is formed electrons because 6 protons cannot hold 10 electrons.
Con. H SO
CH3CH2OH CH2=CH2 + H2O
2 4
k
acid reacts with alcohol in presence of conc. H2SO4 to
or
form pleasant fruity smelling compound ester.
ConcH SO
C2H5OH + CH3COOH
2 4
CH3COOC2H5 + H2O
w
Activity:
To carry out esterification reaction.
et
• Take 2 mL of ethanol (100% alcohol) in a test
tube.
• Add 2 mL of glacial acetic acid.
N
• Add few drops of conc. H2SO4.
th
• Set the apparatus as shown in diagram. Covalent compounds Ionic compounds
• Heat the mixture in test tube in water bath for 5
1. They are bad con- They are good conduc-
ou
only
a. CnH2n+2 is general formula of saturated
hydrocarbon. For example, CH4
propanoic acid. a.
Alkaline KMnO4
CH3CH2CH2OH + 2(O)
CH3CH2COOH+ H2O
b.
118. What are covalent compounds? Why are they different
from ionic compounds? List three characteristic
properties.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
c.
Those compounds in which bonds are formed by
sharing of electrons are covalent compounds.
While ionic compounds are formed by complete
transfer of electrons.
122. Write three different chemical reactions showing the
Covalent compounds Ionic compounds conversion of ethanoic acid to sodium ethanoate.
Write balanced chemical equation in each case. Write
1. They have weak They have strong
the name of the reactants and products other than
intermolecular forces intermolecular forces of
ethanoic acid and sodium ethanoate in each case.
of attraction. attraction.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
k
2. They have low They have high
melting and boiling melting and boiling a.
or
points. points.
3. They do not They conduct electrici- b.
w
conduct electricity. ty in molten state or in
aqueous solution.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 45
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
(i) (a) Ethanol reacts with Na to liberate d. It is used for preparation of ethanoic acid, ethyl
H2 gas
or
ethanoate (esters).
2CH 3 CH 2 OH + 2Na $ 2CH 3 CH 2 ONa + H 2
(b) Ethanoic acid gives brisk effervescence of CO2 130. Explain the following reactions with chemical
w
with NaHCO3 equations:
CH 3 COOH + NaHCO 3 $ a. Oxidation
et
CH 3 COONa + H 2 O + CO 2 b. Hydrogenation
(ii) It is because pure acetic acid (anhydrous) solidifies c. Substitution
into solid crystals just below the room temperature at
N Ans : [CBSE 2016]
16.7°C and look like glacier of snow.
a. Oxidation
th
127. a.Chemical properties of ethanol is different from
methyl ethanoate. Justify the statement with
ou
proper reason.
b. Methyl ethanoate is used in making perfume.
Justify. b. Hydrogenation
gY
series.
differently. CH3CH2OH has functional group —
a. Define homologous series.
OH. It has specific smell, reacts with Na metal
b. Why the melting and boiling point of C5H10 is
@
443K
functional group and similar chemical properties
128. The structural formula of an ester is is called homologous series.
b. C5H10 has higher molecular mass, more surface
area, more van der Waal’s forces of attraction,
hence higher boiling point than C4H8.
c. C3H6 < C4H8 < C5H10
Write the structural formula of the acid and the
132. The general formula of three compounds A, B and C
alcohol from which it might be prepared. Name the
is C n (H 2n . ‘B’ has highest boiling point and ‘C’ has
process of formation of an ester.
lowest boiling point.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] a. Mention the type of compounds A, B, C.
b. Which of these have minimum number of carbon
atoms?
c. Name the homologous series to which A, B and
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 46
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
134. Classify the following carbon compounds into two
or
homologous series and name them. Soaps are sodium or potassium salts of fatty acids.
C3H4, C3H6, C4H6, C4H8, C5H8, C5H10 They contain —COONa group. Detergents are sodium
or potassium salts of sulphonic acids. They contains
w
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
—SO3Na or —SO4Na group. Soap has ionic end which
The series of organic compounds having same is hydrophilic, interacts with water while carbon
et
functional group and similar chemical properties is chain is hydrophobic interacts with oil, grease. The
called homologous series. soap molecules orient themselves in a cluster in which
Alkene: C3H6, C4H8, C5H10
N
hydrophobic tails are inside the cluster and ionic ends
Alkyne: C3H4, C4H6, C5H3 face outside. These cluster are called micelles. These
th
attract oil which is washed away by water.
135. Write the name and general formula of a chain of
hydrocarbons in which an addition reaction with
ou
Butane
is possible.
Hydrogen is added in presence of nickel as catalyst
Fl
b. , , C2H4
c. , , C2H2
137. Convert CH4 into CC14 by substituting hydrogen
atom with chlorine atom in successive reactions. Why
141. Why is homologous series of carbon compounds so
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 47
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
X
called? Write the chemical formula of two consecutive KMnO 4 /KOH
members of any two homologous series and state the CH3CH2OH + 2[O] CH3COOK
part of these compounds that determines their (a) H+
CH3COOH + K+
physical and (b) chemical properties.
X is CH3COOC2H5, ethyl ethanoate.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Homologous means members of same family that 145. What is meant by homologous series of carbon
is why series of carbon compounds having same compounds? Write the general formula of (i) alkenes,
functional group and similar properties is called and (ii) alkynes. Draw the structures of the first
homologous series. member of each series to show the bonding between
Homologous series of alcohol. the two carbon atoms.
CH3OH Methanol Ans : [CBSE 2014]
C2H5OH Ethanol The series of organic compounds having same
CH3— and C2H5— groups determine physical functional group and similar chemical properties is
properties and —OH group determines chemical called homologous series.
properties. Homologous series of aldehyde. i. Alkenes CnH2n
CH3OH Ethanol
C2H5OH Propanal
Here, CH3—and C2H5— groups determine physical
k
properties while —CHO group determines chemical
or
properties.
ii. Alkynes CnH2n–2
142. What are esters? How are they prepared? List two
w
uses of esters.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Esters are pleasant fruity smelling compounds with
general formula R—COOR’. They are prepared by
et
146. Write the chemical equations to show what happens
when
reaction of carboxylic acid and alcohol in presence
N
a. an ester reacts with a base?
of cone. H2SO4. b. methane is treated with chlorine in the presence
th
Conc. H SO
CH3COOH + C2H5OH
2 4
of sunlight?
CH3COOC2H5 + H2O c. ethanol reacts with ethanoic acid in the presence
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 48
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
has a molecular formula C2H4O2. Identify X and draw compounds. (1) Alcohol, (2) Carboxylic acid.
its structure. Write chemical equation for the reaction a. Soaps do not work well with hard water as form
and name of the product formed in each case when X insoluble scum whereas detergents work well with
reacts with hard water.
a. ethanol in the presence of concentrate H2SO4.
b. sodium carbonate. 153. Give reasons for the following observations:
a. The element carbon forms a very large number of
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
compounds.
X is CH3COOH b. Air holes of a gas burner have to be adjusted when
the heated vessels get blackened by the flame.
c. Use of synthetic detergents causes pollution of
water.
Ans : [CBSE 2009]
a. CH3CH2OH
Conc. H 2 SO 4
CH2=CH2 + H2O a. It is due to tetravalency of carbon and property of
443 K
catenation shown by carbon to maximum extent.
b. 2CH3COOH + Na2CO3 $ b. Air holes must be kept open fully so that complete
2CH3COONa + H2O + CO2 combustion of fuel takes place producing blue
flame.
150. What is meant by isomers? “We cannot have isomers
k
c. Some of detergents are not bio¬degradable, they
of first three members of alkane series.” Give reason create water pollution.
or
to justify this statement. Draw the structures of two
isomers of pentane, C5H12. 154. a.Why are covalent compounds generally poor
w
Ans : [CBSE 2013] conductors of electricity?
b. Name the following compound:
Isomers are those compounds which have same
et
molecular formula but different structural formula.
CH3– CH2– CH2– CH2– CH3
Pentane
N
th
c. Name the gas evolved when ethanoic acid is
added to sodium carbonate. How will you test the
presence of this gas.
ou
is structural formula.
@
155. You are given balls and stick model of six carbon
When ester is heated with NaOH, sodium salt of acid
atoms and fourteen hydrogen atoms and sufficient
and alcohol are formed. It is called saponification
number of sticks. In how many ways one can join the
reaction.
models of six carbon atoms and fourteen hydrogen
atoms to form different molecules of C6H14.
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2017-2018]
There are five ways in which six carbons can be joined
with 14 hydrogen atoms.
i.
152. a.What is meant by a functional group in an organic
compound? Name the functional group present in
(1) CH3CH2OH
(2) CH3COOH
b. State one point of difference between soap and
synthetic detergent. ii.
Ans : [CBSE2009]
a. Functional group is an atom or group of atoms
which determine chemical properties of organic
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 49
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
iii.
Alkene CnH2n
k
b. CH3COOH + NaOH $
H SO
c. CH3CH2OH
or
2 4
w
the difference between the two. Write the mechanism Ans : [CBSE 2018]
of the cleansing action of soaps. Why do soaps not
et
a. CH2= CH2 + H2 CH3– CH3
form lather (foam) with hard water? Mention any
two problems that arise due to the use of detergents Ethane
N
instead of soaps. b. CH3COOH + NaOH
Ans : [CBSE 2017] CH3COONa + H2O
th
Sodium ethanoate
a. Soaps are sodium or potassium salts of fatty c. CH3CH2OH
Conc. H 2 SO 4
CH2= CH2 + H2O
D
acids e.g. —COONa. Detergents are sodium or Ethene
ou
has ionic end which is hydrophilic, interacts with saturated and unsaturated hydrocarbons.
water while carbon chain is hydrophobic interacts b. Name the products formed when ethane burns in
yi
with oil, grease. The soap molecules orient air. Write the balanced chemical equation for the
themselves in a cluster in which hydrophobic tails reactions showing two types of energies liberated.
Fl
are inside the cluster and ionic ends face outside. c. Why is reaction between methane and chlorine in
These cluster are called micelles. These attract oil presence of sunlight is considered a substitution
reaction.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 50
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
a. Red litmus paper will become blue in soap solution the concerned chemical reaction.
only. Ethanoic acid will turn blue litmus red only. (1) Ethanol to ethene
Ethanol will react with Na metal to form sodium (2) Ethanol to ethanoic acid
ethoxide and hydrogen gas will be liberated. b. Give one example with chemical equation for the
b. Soaps are sodium or potassium salts of fatty acids following reactions:
which react with Ca2+ and Mg2+ ions in hard water (1) Substitution reaction
to form calcium or magnesium salts of fatty acids (2) Saponification reaction
which are insoluble in water called scum. (3) Combustion reaction
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
161. What are micelles? Why does it form when soap is
Conc. H 2 SO 4
added to water? Will a micelle be formed in other a. (1) CH3CH2OH D
CH2= CH2 + H2O
solvents such as ethanol also? State briefly how the Ethanol Ethene
k
in water they form a cluster due to hydrophobic part
CH3COOCH3 + NaOH
of molecules orient themselves away from water.
or
CH3COONa + CH3OH
So they arrange towards inside of the cluster while
hydrophilic part remain outside of cluster. (3) Combustion reaction
w
No, micelles will not be formed in alcohol. Soap in
CH4 + 2O2 CO2 + 2H2O
form of micelles is able to clean because the oily dirt
et
will be collected in centre of micelle which is rinsed 165. Identify the compounds ‘A’ to ‘E’ in the following
away by water. sequence:
N a. CH3CH2OH
KMNO 4 /KOH
A + H2O
162. a.Differentiate between soap and detergent. dil. HCl
d. A + NaHCO3 C + D + H2O
CH
e. CH3 2 OH + E CH3CH2ONa + H2
Soap Detergent
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
gY
CH3COOCH2CH3 + H2O
Ca2+ and Mg2+ ions in hard water to form insoluble ‘B’
‘B’
with Ca2+ and Mg2+.
CH3COONa + CH3CH2OH
‘C’
163. a.How is vinegar made?
@
d. CH3COOH + NaHCO3
b. What is glacial acetic acid? What is its melting
CH3COONa + CO2 + H2O
point? ‘C’ ‘D’
c. Why are carboxylic acids called weak acids? e. 2CH3CH2OH + 2Na 2CH3CH2ONa + H2
d. Write the name and formula of compounds ‘E’
formed when the ester CH3COOC2H5 undergoes A is CH3COOH, ‘B’ is CH3COOCH2CH3, *C’ is
saponification. CH3COONa, ‘D’ is CO2, ‘E’ is Na (Sodium metal).
Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2013]
166. An organic compound “X’ on heating with cone.
a. Vinegar is 5-8% solution of acetic acid (Ethanoic H2SO4 forms a compound ‘Y’ which on addition of
acid) in water. It can be made by fermentation of one molecule of hydrogen in the presence of nickel
ethanol in presence of oxygen. forms a compound ‘Z’. One molecule of compound
b. Glacial acetic is pure (100%) acetic acid. Its ‘Z’ on combustion forms two molecules of CO2 and
melting point is 290 K. three molecules of H2O. Identify giving reasons the
c. They do not ionise completely in aqueous solution. compounds X’, ‘Y’ and ‘Z’. Write the chemical
d. CH3COOC2H5 + NaOH equations for all the chemical reactions involved.
CH3COONa + C2H5OH Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Sodium ethanoate Ethanol Conc. H 2 SO 4
CH3CH2OH heat
CH2 = CH2 + H2O
‘X’ ‘Y’
164. a. How will you bring out following reactions? Write Ni
CH2 = CH2 + H2 CH3 – CH3
‘Y’ ‘Z’
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 51
Chap 4 : Carbon and Its Compounds www.cbse.online
k
a. Element carbon forms compound mainly by
covalent bonding.
or
3. Pure ethanol is liquid Pure acetic b. Diamond has high melting point.
of room temprature. acid is solid c. Graphite is good conductor of electricity.
w
below 290 K. d. Acetylene bums with sooty flame.
Chemical Properties e. Kerosene does not decolourise bromine water
et
whereas cooking oil does.
4. It does not It turn-s blue
change colour litmus red. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
of litmus
N a. It is because carbon can neither lose 4 electrons
nor gain 4 electrons. It can share four electrons to
5. It does not react with It liberstes
th
form covalent bonds.
NaHCO3 CO2 with
b. Diamond has strong C—C bonds and compact 3-D
NaHC03.
ou
Detergents are sodium or potassium salts of sulphonic partial oxidation causes it to bum with sooty or
acids of benzene or sulphates of unsaturated smoky flame.
e. Kerosene is a saturated compound, therefore,
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 52
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
10. Write the number of horizontal rows in the modern
period. periodic table. What are these rows called?
or
2. Out of Li and K, which will have stronger metallic Ans : [CBSE 2014]
character and why? There are 7 horizontal rows in the modern periodic
w
Ans : [CBSE 2016] Table. These rows are called periods.
et
K will have more metallic character because it can NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
lose electrons easily due to its bigger atomic size and
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
less effective nuclear charge.
Nwww.cbse.online for
3. Find the atomic number of the element whose 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
th
electronic configuration is 2, 8, 5. Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
Ans : [CBSE 2016)
ou
16, 3rd period. 11. Write one difference between Group 1 and Group 2
elements?
5. Write two reasons responsible for the late discovery of
Fl
P and R will show similar chemical properties because after the formation of Mendeleev’s periodic table.
they have the same number of valence electrons. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
15. Write the formula which is used to determine the Gallium and Germanium.
maximum number of electrons that a shell can
25. What is a metalloid? Name any two of them.
accommodate.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2013]
Metalloids are those elements which resembles both
2n2 , where n is the shell number.
with metals as well as non-metals e.g., Boron and
16. What would be the nature of oxides formed by the Silicon.
elements on the right side of periodic table?
26. Arrange the following metals in decreasing order of
Ans : [CBSE 2014] their atomic size:
On right hand side of the periodic table, most of them Ca, Mg, Ba, Be
are non-metals, therefore they form acidic oxides. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
17. Predict the maximum number of valence electrons Ba > Ca > Mg > Be is the decreasing order of atomic
possible for atoms in the first period of the periodic size.
table.
27. Why does atomic size decreases as we move from left
k
Ans : [CBSE 2014} to right along a period in a periodic table?
or
Maximum number of valence electrons in 1st period Ans : [CBSE 2011]
is 2.
It is because one proton and one electron is being
w
18. The electronic configuration of two elements X and Y added successively, therefore effective nuclear charge
are 2, 8, 7 and 2, 8, 8, 3 respectively. Write the atomic increases, atomic size decreases.
et
numbers of X and Y.
28. What is the valency of silicon with atomic number 14?
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
N Ans : [CBSE 2010]
X = 2 + 8 + 7 = 17
Si(2, 8, 4), the number of valence electrons in Si is 4.
Y = 2 + 8 + 8 + 3 = 21
th
Therefore, its valency is 4.
19. The atomic numbers of three elements X, Y and Z are
29. What is the valency of phosphorus with atomic
ou
20. Give reason why noble gases are placed in a separate Ans : [CBSE 2010]
group in the modern periodic table. Atomic number is 35, it has electronic configuration
Fl
filled and resemble with each other. 31. What were the criteria used by Mendeleev in creating
his periodic table?
21. Name any two pairs of elements which were adjusted
by Newlands in the same slot. Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2013] Increasing order of atomic mass and same formula of
oxides and hydrides.
(i) Co and Ni, (ii) Ce and La
32. Give the number of elements in 2nd and 5th period in
22. Define Newlands law of octaves.
the modern periodic table.
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Newlands Law of Octaves: When elements are arranged
In 2nd period, there are 8 elements.
in increasing order of their atomic mass, every eighth
In 5th period, there are 18 elements.
element resembles with the first.
33. Lithium, Sodium and potassium form a Dobereiner’s
23. State Mendeleev’s periodic law.
triad. The atomic masses of lithium and potassium
Ans : [CBSE 2012] are 7 and 39 respectively. Predict the atomic mass of
Mendeleev’s Periodic Law: Properties of elements are sodium.
a periodic function of their atomic mass. Ans : [CBSE 2009C]
24. Name any two elements which were discovered later Atomic mass of Sodium
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 54
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
Atomic mass of lithium Group 1 Group 2
+ Atomic mass of potassium
= Li(3): 2,1 Be(4): 2, 2
2
K(19):2,8,8,1 Mg (12): 2, 8, 2
Na = 7 + 39 = 46 = 23
2 2
Li and K are placed in group 1 due to same number of
34. Why was the system of classification of elements into valence electrons. In second group the atomic number
triads not found suitable? of first two elements will be 4 and 12 respectively.
Ans : [CBSE 2009(C)]
40. Calcium is an element with atomic number 20.
It is because all the elements discovered at that time
a. Will it be a metal/non-metal?
could not be classified as Dobereneire’s triads.
b. What will be its valency?
35. The formula of magnesium oxide is MgO. State the c. What would be the formula of its chloride?
formula of barium nitrate and barium sulphate, if d. Will it be smaller / larger than K?
barium belongs to same group as magnesium. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ca(20): 2, 8, 8, 2
The valency of Mg is 2. The valency of Ba is also 2 a. It will be a metal.
as they belong to the same group. Formula of Barium b. Its valency is equal to 2.
k
nitrate is Ba(NO3)2, and that of Barium sulphate is c. CaCl2 is the formula of its chloride.
BaSO4. d. It will be smaller than K.
or
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
36. Which has larger atomic radius, K(19) or Ca(20)?
w
Ans : [CBSE 2016] For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
K has larger atomic radius than Ca.
et
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
37. Chlorine, Bromine and Iodine form Dobereiner’s Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
triads. The atomic mass of Cl and I are 35.5 and 126.9
N
respectively. Predict the atomic mass of Bromine. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
th
Ans : [CBSE 2009]
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Atomic Mass of Br provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
ou
2
Electronic configuration: X = 2, 8, 7 41. List the anomalies of Mendeleev’s periodic table which
It has 7 valence electrons. It belongs to group 17. were removed in Modem Periodic Table.
n
TWO MARKS QUESTIONS Isotopes should have been given different slots
due to different atomic mass, but it is not possible due
@
38. An element X has mass number 35 and the number of to same chemical properties. The problem was solved
its neutrons is 18. Identify the group number, period because isotopes have same atomic numbers.
and valency of element X’. 42. Choose from the following:
Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2017-2018, CBSE 2016] C, 8O, 10Ne, 11Na, 14S1
6
X has mass number 35, number of neutrons = 18
a. Elements that should be in the same period.
Atomic Number = 35 - 18 = 17
b. Elements that should be in the same group.
a. Electronic configuration: X = 2, 8, 7 It has 7
State the reason for your selection in each case.
valence electrons. It belongs to group 17.
b. It has 3 shells, therefore it belongs to 3rd period. Ans : [CBSE 2016,2012]
c. It can gain 1 electron to become stable, so its a. 6
C(2, 4), 8O(2, 6), 10Ne(2, 8) belong to the same
valency is equal to 1. period i.e., 2nd period and 11Na(2, 8, 1), 14Si(2, 8,
4) belongs to the same period i.e., 3rd period.
39. Why is lithium with atomic number 3 and potassium b. 6C(2,4) and 14Si(2,8,4) belongs to the same group
with atomic number 19 are placed in group one? What -14 due to same number of valence electrons,
will be atomic number of the first two elements in the which is equal to 4.
second group?
Ans : [CBSE 2016] 43. The elements X, Y and Z having atomic numbers 11,
7 and 6 respectively react with oxygen to form their
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 55
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2015,2014]
or
a. Chlorine (17): 2, 8, 7 51. An element M has atomic number 11.
b. It belongs to 3rd period. a. Write its electronic configuration.
c. It belongs to group 17. b. State the group to which M belongs to.
w
d. 2, 8, 7 is the electronic configuration of chlorine. c. Is M a metal or a non-metal?
d. Write the formula of its chloride.
et
45. a. Amongst the following elements identify the ones Ans : [CBSE 2012]
that would form anions:
a. 2, 8, 1
K, O, Na, F, Ca, Cl, Mg
N
b. M belongs to group 1.
b. Write the electronic configuration of the anions
c. It is a metal.
th
identified above.
d. MCI is the formula of its chloride.
Ans : [CBSE 2015, 2014]
ou
a. 2, 8, 2,
a. State the number of valence electrons in it.
b. Group 2,
yi
b. Is it a metal or a non-metal?
c. Metal,
c. Name the element.
d. MO is formula of its oxide.
d. Write the formula of its oxide.
Fl
Ans : [CBSE 2015, 2011] 53. How can the valency of an element be determined if
its electronic configuration is known? What will be
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 56
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
55. Choose from the following: are 2, 8, 3 and 2, 8, 7 respectively. Find the atomic
20
Ca, 3Li, 11Na, 10Ne number of these elements. State the nature and
formula of the compound formed by union of these
a. An element having two shells completely filled elements.
with electrons.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
b. Two elements belonging to same group of the
periodic table. A has 2 + 8 + 3 = 13 as its atomic number B has 2 +
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 8 + 7 = 17 as its atomic number
a. 10
Ne (2, 8)
b. 3
Li(2, 1) and 11
Na(2, 9, 1) belong to the same
group.
AB3 is the formula of compound. It is an ionic
56. Why do all elements of the
compound.
a. same group have similar properties?
b. same period have different properties? 61. The atomic number of three elements are given below:
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Element (symbol) A B C
a. It is due to same number of valence electrons
Atomic number 5 7 10
k
which will decide the chemical properties.
b. They differ in number of valence electrons, Write the symbol of element which belongs to (a)
or
therefore they differ in chemical properties. They group 13, (b) group 15 of the periodic table. State
have the same number of shells. the period to which these elements belongs to. Give
w
reason for your answer.
57. An element ‘E’ has the following electronic
configuration: Ans : [CBSE 2012]
K L M
eta. A(2, 3) belongs to group 13 because it has 3
valence electrons.
N
2 8 6 b. B(2, 5) belongs to group 15 because it has 5
valence electrons. It belongs to 2nd period because
th
a. To which group of the periodic table does element
it has 2 shells.
E belong to?
b. To which period of the periodic table does element
ou
c. It has 6 valence electrons. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
d. The valency of E is 2. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
Fl
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
58. Choose from the following: 4Be, 9F,
19
K, 20Ca study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
a. The element having one electron in the outermost
@
shell.
b. Two elements of the same group. 62. The electronic configuration of two elements A and B
Ans : [CBSE 2012] are 2, 8, 7 and 2, 8, 8, 2 respectively. Write the atomic
a. K(2,8,8,1) has one valence electron, number of these elements. What will be formula of the
19
compound formed and the nature of bond between
b. 4
Be(2, 2) and 20Ca(2, 8, 8, 2) belongs to the same them when these two elements chemically combine
group. together?
59. An element has atomic number 13.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. What is the group and period number to which A - 2 + 8 + 7 = 17 is its atomic number.
this element belongs to? B - 2 + 8 + 8 + 2 = 20 is its atomic number.
b. Is the element a metal or a non-metal? Justify A(2, 8, 7) B(2, 8, 8, 2)
your answer.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. It belongs to group 13, 3rd period because it has
3 valence electrons and 3 shells.
b. It is a metal because it can lose 3 electrons to The nature of bond is ionic bond.
become stable.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 57
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
63. The atomic number of these elements are given below: and why?
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Element (symbol) A B C
Metallic character of elements decreases along a
Atomic number 3 6 9 period from left to right because atomic size decreases,
Write the symbol of element which belongs to tendency to lose electrons decreases.
a. group 1,
b. group 14 of the periodic table. 69. How does valency of the elements vary
State the period of the periodic table to which these a. in going down a group, and
elements belong to. State reason to support your b. in going from left to right in a period of the
answer. periodic table?
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
k
2 shells.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
or
64. How the electronic configuration of the atom of a. Tendency to lose electron(s) decreases across the
an element is related to its position in the modern period from left to right.
periodic table? Explain with one example.
w
b. Tendency to lose electron(s) increases down in a
Ans : [CBSE 2011] group.
et
Period No. = Number of shells
71. Give reasons:
Group No. = Number of valence electrons or valence
a. Elements in a group have similar chemical
electrons +10.
N
properties.
Example
b. Elements of Group 1 form ions with a charge of
th
Na(11): 2, 8,1. It has 1 valence electron, it belongs to
+1.
group 1. Also Al (13): 2, 8, 3. It has 3 shells, therefore
it belongs to 3rd period. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
ou
Z(17) : 2, 8, 7
X and Z have similar chemical properties because they The repetition of similar properties after a definite
have the same number of valence electrons. interval is called periodicity of properties. It is due to
Fl
identify the first and the last element of a period? 73. Elements Mg and O respectively belong to group
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 2 and group 16 of the modem periodic table. If the
atomic number of Mg and O are 12 and 8 respectively,
1st element will have 1 valence electron whereas last
draw their electronic structures and show the process
element will have 8 valence electrons except in first
of formation of the compound by transfer of electrons
period in which last element has 2 electrons.
between them.
67. In the modern periodic table, the element Calcium Ans : [CBSE 2010]
(atomic number = 20) is surrounded by elements Mg(12): 2,8,2
with atomic numbers 12, 19, 21 and 38. Which of O(8): 2,6
these elements has physical and chemical properties
resembling those of Calcium and why?
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ca(20): 2, 8, 8, 2
Mg(12): 2,8, 2
Sr(38): 2, 8, 18, 8, 2
Mg and Sr has similar properties to Ca because each
of them have 2 valence electrons.
k
properties. periodic table, why?
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
or
75. The elements of the second period of the periodic
a. Modem periodic table is based on the trend of
table are given below:
increasing order of atomic number. Elements
w
Li, Be, B, C, N, O, F
of same group have same number of valence
a. Give reason to explain why atomic radii decreases
electrons.
et
from Li to F.
b. Hydrogen resembles with both group 1 and group
b. Identify the most (i) metallic and (ii) non-metallic
17 elements, therefore it does not have a fixed
element.
N position.
Ans : [CBSE 2008(C)]
th
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
a. It is because effective nuclear increases due to
increase in forces of attraction between more For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
ou
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
Period 3 Na Mg Ai Su P S Cl For School Education
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 59
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
a. Which of the elements has the atomic size (i) They will be placed in the same slot because they
biggest and (ii) smallest? have similar chemical properties due to same number
b. Which element has valency equal to (i) 3 and (ii) of valence electrons.
zero?
87. The electronic configuration of an element X is 2, 8,
Ans : [CBSE2012]
8, 2. To which period and group of periodic table does
a. (i) A has the biggest size. (ii) G has the smallest the element X belong to? State the valency and justify
size. your answer in each case.
b. (i) C has valency equal to 3. (ii) H has valency Ans : [CBSE 2012]
equal to zero.
It belongs to 4th period because it has four shells.
82. a. State Modern Periodic Law It belongs to group 2 because it has 2 valence
b. Elements A, B, C and D have atomic number 1, electrons. X has a valency equal to 2 because it can
8, 11, 19 respectively. Choose the odd element and lose 2 electrons to become stable.
give reason for your answer.
88.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. Modern Periodic Law: It states ‘properties of 89. The atomic number of three elements are given below:
elements are a periodic function of their atomic A(5), B(7), C(10)
number’. Write the symbol of element which belongs to (a)
k
b. B(8): 2, 6 is an odd element because it has 6 group 13, (b) group 15 of the periodic table. State
or
valence electrons whereas others have 1 valence the period of periodic table to which these elements
electron. belong to. Give reason to your answer.
w
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
83. Arrange the following elements in descending order
of their atomic size and give reason for your answer. a. A(5): 2, 3 belong to group 13 because it has 3
et
Mg(12), P(15), Cl(17), Ar(18) valence electrons.
b. B(7): 2, 5 belong to group 15 because it has 5
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
N valence electrons.
Mg > P > Ar > Cl They i.e., A and B belong to second period because
As we move from left to right, atomic size decreases
th
they have 2 shells.
due to increase in effective nuclear charge. Ar is bigger
than Cl due repulsion between 8 valence electrons. 90. Arrange the following elements in increasing order of
ou
elements (a) has longest atomic radius, (b) is least Ans : [CBSE 2012]
reactive? Justify your answer stating reason for each.
a. F < N < Be < Li
Ans : [CBSE 2012, 2015]
b. Cl < Br < I < At
n
attraction between 11 protons and 11 electrons. elements given below and arrange them in an
b. A1 is the least reactive element due to small its increasing order:
Fl
size and least tendency to lose electrons. a. Name the element which have the smallest and
the largest atoms
85. The atomic number of these elements are given below:
@
Group Na Li Rb Cs K
Element B O N C
Radius in pm 161 152 244 262 231
Atomic radius (in pm) 86 66 74 97
b. How does the atomic size vary as you go down
Arrange this elements in increasing order of their the group?
atomic numbers. Give reason for your answer. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Li < Na < K < Rb < Cs
B(5), C(6), N(7), 0(8) is the increasing order of their a. Li is the smallest, Cs is the largest atom.
atomic numbers. b. Atomic size increases down the group.
It is because when we move along a period,
92. Atomic radii of the elements of second period are
atomic radii decreases due to increase in effective
given below:
nuclear charge due to increase in number of protons
and electrons continuously. Period II B Be O N Li C
86. Would you place the two isotopes Cl-35 and Cl-37 in elements
different slots because of their different atomic masses Atomic radius 88 111 66 74 152 77
or in the same slot because their chemical properties (in pm)
are same? Justify your answer.
a. Arrange them in decreasing order of their atomic
Ans : [CBSE 2012,2015] size.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 60
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
b. Are the elements now arranged in the pattern of a 96. Differentiate between the arrangement of elements
period in periodic table? in Mendeleev’s periodic table and Modern Periodic
c. Which elements have the largest and the smallest Table.
atoms? Ans : [CBSE Sample Paper 2017-2018]
d. How does the atomic radius change as you go
from left to right in a period. Mandeleev’s Periodic Modern Periodic Table
Ans : [CBSE 2011] Table
a. Li > Be > B > C > N > O It is based on increasing It is based on increasing
b. Yes, They belong to the second period. order of atomic mass. order of atomic number.
c. Li is the largest, oxygen is the smallest.
d. Atomic size decreases along a period from left to It has 8 groups and 6 It has 18 groups and 7
right. periods. periods.
Increasing order of Increasing order of
93. Li, Be, B, C are the elements of same period of Modem atomic mass could not atomic number can be
Periodic table. be maintained. maintained.
a. Arrange them in increasing order of their atomic
size.
97. Write the names given to the vertical columns and
b. In which shell (number) would last electron enter
horizontal rows in the Modern Periodic Table. How
k
for all of them.
does the metallic character of elements vary on
c. Calculate the valence electrons in each.
or
moving down a vertical column? How does the size of
d. Which element amongst them is most
atomic radius vary on moving from left to right in a
electropositive?
horizontal row? Give reason in support of your answer
w
Ans : [CBSE 2016] in the above two cases.
a. C < B < Be < Li Ans : [CBSE 2017]
b. Second shell
c.
etVertical columns are called groups. Horizontal rows
N are called periods. Metallic character of elements
increases down the group because tendency to lose
electrons increases down the group due to increase in
th
atomic size. Atomic size goes on decreasing along the
period due to increase in effective nuclear charge due
ou
They have 1, 2, 3, 4 valence electrons respectively. to increase in number of protons and electrons.
d. Li is the most electropositive element. NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
gY
Bank
94. An element X belongs to 3rd period and group 16 of 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
yi
the valency of X. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
b. Molecular formula of the compound of X when it provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
reacts with hydrogen and write its electron dot Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
@
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
diagram. study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
c. Name the element X and state whether it is
metallic or non-metallic.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] 98. An element ‘P’ (atomic number 20) reacts with an
a. X has 6 valence electrons and its valency is equal element ‘Q’ (atomic number 17) to form a compound.
to 2. Answer the following questions giving reason:
Write the position of ‘P’ and ‘Q’ in the Modem
b. H2X is its formula, Periodic Table and the molecular formula of the
compound formed when ‘P* reacts with ‘Q’.
c. X is sulphur. It is a non-metallic element. Ans : [CBSE 2017]
95. Two elements X and Y have atomic number 11 and P(20): 2, 9, 9, 2; Q(17): 2, 8, 7
16 respectively. ‘P’ belongs to group 2 and 4th period.
a. Write the electronic configuration of both. ‘Q’ belongs to group 17 and 3rd period.
b. Write the formula of the compound formed by
their combination (in terms of X and Y).
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a. X(11): 2, 8, 1; Y(16): 2, 8, 6
b. X2Y is the formula of compound formed. PQ2 is the molecular formula of the compound formed.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 61
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
99. Write the electronic configuration of two elements a. Metallic character decreases from left to right
X’ and ‘Y’ whose atomic numbers are 20 and 17 because atomic size decreases, tendency to lose
respectively. Write the molecular formula of the electrons decreases,
compound formed when element X’ reacts with b. Metallic character increases from top to bottom
element ‘Y’. Draw electron-dot structure of the in a group because atomic size increases due to
product and also state the nature of the bond formed which effective nuclear charge decreases.
between both the elements.
103. a.Identify the elements among the following which
Ans : [CBSE 2017, 2013]
will belong to the same group: H, He, Li, B, C.
X(20): 2, 8, 8, 2; Y(17): 2, 8, 7 b. State the group number of the recognised elements.
c. Name another one element belonging to the same
group.
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
a. H and Li belong to the same group.
X $ X 2 + 2 e- b. They belong to group 1.
Y + e- $ Y- c. Na (sodium) also belong to this group.
k
a. Cations are smaller than the corresponding atoms.
This bond is ionic bond. b. Size of atom increases as we move down the group.
or
c. Atomic size decreases as we move across a period.
100. What is periodicity in properties of elements with Ans : [CBSE 2017, 2014]
reference to the Modern Periodic Table? Why do all
w
the elements of the same group have similar properties? a. Cations are formed by loss of electrons, therefore
How does the tendency of elements to gain electrons effective nuclear charge increases, size of atom
et
change as we move from left in a period? State the decreases.
reason of this change. b. It is because number of shells goes on increasing
N down the group.
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
c. It is because effective nuclear charge increases
th
The repetition of similar properties after a definite along a period.
interval is called periodicity of properties.
Tendency to gain electrons increases along a period 105. Name the element with atomic number 19.
ou
from left to right because atomic size decreases. a. In which group it is placed?
b. To which period does it belong to?
101. The atomic number of an element is 19. c. Write its electronic configuration.
gY
metal?
b. Write the formula of the oxide of this element. b. It belongs to 4th period.
yi
c. Is this element more reactive or less reactive than c. Its electronic configuration is 2,8 8,1.
Na (atomic number 11)? Justify your answer,
106. The atomic number of an element is 20.
Fl
giving example.
a. Write its electronic configuration and determine
Ans : [CBSE 2017] its valency.
@
a. 2, 8, 8, 1 b. Is it a metal or a non-metal?
i. Valency = 1 c. Write formula of its chloride.
ii. It is a metal. d. Is it more or less reactive than Mg(12)? Give
a. X2O reasons for your answer.
b. It is more reactive than Na(11) because it is large Ans : [CBSE 2017]
in size and it can lose electrons easily due to less
a. Ca(20): 2, 8 8, 2. Its valency is equal to 2.
effective nuclear charge.
b. It is a metal.
K reacts more vigorously with H2O than Na.
c. CaCl2.
102. Why is atomic number considered to be a more d. It is more reactive than Mg due to larger atomic
appropriate parameter than atomic mass for the size. It can lose electrons easily due to less effective
classification of elements in a periodic table? How nuclear charge.
does the metallic character of elements vary as we
107. The atomic number of an element is 12.
move (a) from left to right in a period, and (b) top to
a. Write its electronic configuration and determine
bottom in a group of the modem periodic table? Give
its valency.
reasons to justify your answer.
b. Is it more reactive or less reactive than Ca(20)?
Ans : [CBSE 2017] c. Is it a metal or a non-metal?
It is because chemical properties depend upon the d. Write the formula of its oxide.
number of valence electrons which is determined with Ans : [CBSE 2017]
the help of atomic number.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 62
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
109. Calcium is an element with atomic number 20. Stating
the reason, answer each of the following questions: c. X is a non-metal.
or
a. Is calcium a metal or a non-metal?
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
b. Will its atomic radius be larger or smaller than
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
w
that of potassium with atomic number 19?
c. Write the formula of its oxide. www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
et
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Bank
a. Calcium is a metal because it can lose electrons 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
to form cations.
N
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
b. Its atomic radius will be smaller due to more 4. NCERT Solutions
th
number of protons and electrons, more forces of All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
attraction. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
c. CaO
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 63
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
Periodic Table and how valency of an element is
Ans : [CBSE 2016] calculated on the basis of its atomic number?
or
Basic character of oxides increases down the group Ans : [CBSE 2015]
because metallic character increases. S(16) has electronic configuration of 2,8, 6,
w
Basic character of oxides decreases along the Group number = valence electrons + 10
period from left to right because non¬metallic = 6 + 10 = 16
character increases, metallic character decreases.
a period. Also state the changes, if any, in the valency a. It belongs to group 2, 4th period because its
yi
and atomic size of elements as we move down the valence electrons are 2 and no. of shells = 4
group.
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 64
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
group because they have the same number of NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
valence electrons.
or
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
c. A(2, 2), B(2, 7) belong to the same period. A has www.cbse.online for
bigger atomic radius than B. 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
Bank
125. Write the main aim of classifying elements. Name
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
the basic property of elements which is used in the
et
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
development of Modern Periodic Table. State the
4. NCERT Solutions
Modern Periodic Law. On which side (part) of the
N All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Modern Periodic Table do you find metals, metalloids
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
and non- metals?
th
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
Ans : [CBSE 2015] study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
Classification is done so as to study the properties of
ou
of elements are a periodic function of their atomic the Modern Periodic Table and have respectively 1, 3,
numbers.’ Metals are placed on the left and middle, 5 and 7 electrons in their outermost shell. Write the
non-metals are placed on the right and Metalloids are electronic configurations of Q and R and determine
placed on the border line between metals and non- their valencies. Write the molecular formula of the
n
k
c. Size of atom increases down the group.
130. The electrons in the atoms of four elements A, B, C d. Metallic character of element increases down the
or
and D are distributed in three shells havingl, 3, 5 and group.
7 electrons in the outermost shell respectively. State e. Effective nuclear charge decreases down the group.
w
the period in which these elements can be placed
in the modern periodic table. Write the electronic 134. The electronic configuration of 4 elements A, B, C and
D are given as under:
et
configuration of the atoms of A and D and the
molecular formula of the compound formed when A A-2, 1; B-2, 2; C-2, 8, 2; D-2
a. Which amongst them belongs to the same group?
and D combine.
N
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Name it.
b. Which amongst them belong to the same period?
th
A: 2, 8, 1 Name it.
B: 2, 8, 3 c. Which amongst them is an inert element? Name
ou
C: 2, 8, 5 it.
D: 2, 8, 7
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
They belong to the 3rd period.
gY
131. Based on the group valency of elements state the 135. Two elements X and Y have atomic 12 and 17
formula for the following giving justification for each: respectively.
Fl
a. Oxides of 1st group elements, a. Write the electronic configuration of both these
b. Halides of the elements of group 13, and elements.
b. Which type of bond will they form?
@
k
a. K: 2, 8, 8, 1 142. Na/Mg and A1 are the elements having one, two and
or
19
three valence electrons respectively. Which of these
b. 4
Be, 20Ca belong to the same group because both elements (a) has the largest atomic radius, (b) is least
have same number of valence electrons.
w
reactive? Justify you answer stating reason for each.
Be: 2, 2; Ca: 2, 8, 8, 2 Ans : [CBSE 2012]
c. Be, 9F belong to the same period. 4Be has bigger
et
4
atomic size than 9F. Na has largest atomic radii due to 11 protons and 11
electrons and least effective nuclear charge. Na is most
138. The elements Li, Na and K each having one valence
N reactive because it can lose an electron easily due to
electron, are in period 2, 3 and 4 respectively of its large size and least effective nuclear charge.
th
modern periodic table.
a. In which group of the periodic table should they 143. a.How are the following related?
be placed? i. Number of valence electrons of different
ou
is smallest in size, has least tendency to lose iii. Atomic radius in moving from left to right
electrons. along a period.
Fl
c. K has largest atomic radius because it has iv. Atomic size as we go down a group.
maximum number of shells. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
@
139. Four elements P, Q, R and S have atomic numbers a. i. Same number of valence electrons.
12, 13, 14 and 15 respectively. Answer the following ii. Number of shells remains the same in a
questions giving reasons: period.
a. What is the valency of Q? b. i. Number of shells goes on increasing down the
b. Classify these elements as metals and non-metals. group.
c. Which of these elements will form the most basic ii. Number of valence electrons goes on increasing
oxide? in a period from left to right.
Ans : [CBSE 2013] iii. Atomic radius decreases along a period from
left to right.
a. Q(2, 8, 3) has valency = 3
iv. Atomic size increases down a group.
b. P, Q are metals, R and S are non¬metals.
c. P will form the most basic oxide. 144. a.How many periods are there in the Modem
Periodic Table of elements?
140. The atomic number an element is 17. Predict:
b. How do atomic radius, valency and metallic
a. its valency.
character vary down a group?
b. whether it is a metal or a non-metal?
c. How do atomic size and metallic character of
c. its relative size with respect to other members of
elements vary as we move from left to right in a
the group.
period?
Justify your answer in each case.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
a. There are 7 periods.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 67
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
b. Atomic radius and Metallic character increases (ii) Electropositivity decreases across the period
down the group. Valency remains the same in a from left to right.
group. b. Atomic number increases across the period as well
c. Atomic size and metallic character decrease along as down the group.
a period from left to right in a period.
150. (a) Identify the element that have two completely
145. Explain the variation in the following properties of the filled shells and the number of valence electrons
elements in periodic table: in each case if atomic numbers are: (i) 1, (ii) 2,
a. Atomic radius in the periodic table, (iii) 7, (iv) 8
b. Metallic character in a period, (b) Analyse which amongst them is inert.
c. Valency in a group. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Ans : [CBSE 2012] a. (i) 2, 8, 1: Sodium
a. Atomic radius and Metallic character increases (ii) 2, 8, 2: Magnesium
down the group. Valency remains the same in a (iii) 2, 8, 7: Chlorine
group. (iv) 2, 8, 8: Argon
b. Atomic size and metallic character decrease along (b) Argon is inert.
a period from left to right in a period.
151. The atomic number of K and Ca is 19 and 20
k
146. The elements of group 18 of the periodic table are respectively and they belong to same period.
given: a. Which amongst them would have smaller atomic
or
He, Ne, Ar, Kr, Xe, Rd, Dg size?
a. The elements of this group are unreactive, why? b. Which one would be more electro¬positive?
w
b. Which atom is bigger in size Ne or Ar and why? c. To which group would each one belong to?
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2014]
et
a. It is because they have their octet complete i.e., a. Ca has smaller atomic size.
stable electronic configuration. b. K is more electropositive.
b. Ar has bigger atomic size than Ne because Ar has
N c. K belongs to group 1, Ca belongs to group 2.
3 shells while Ne has 2 shells; Ar (2, 8, 8), Ne (2,
th
8) 152. The position of three elements A, B and C in the
periodic table are indicated below:
147. (a) State modern periodic law. Ans :
ou
- - (First Period)
(b) isotopes of an element has been solved in this
periodic table. - A (Second Period)
Ans : [CBSE 2012] - - (Third Period)
n
(ii) Isotopes do not need a separate place as they Ans : [CBSE 2011]
have the same atomic number.
a. O is a non-metal because it has 7 valence electrons.
148. a.Predict which of the following will form anions It can gain one electron to form an anion.
and which will form cations. b. A is more reactive than C because it is smaller in
(i) Na, (ii) Al, (iii) Cl, (iv) O size, therefore it can gain electron(s) easily.
b Name two elements that are inert.
153. Atoms of seven elements A, B, C, D, E, F and G have
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a different number of electronic shells but have the
a. Cl and O will form anions i.e., Cl- and O2- same number of electrons in their outermost shells.
Na and A1 will form cations i.e., Na+ and Al3+. The elements A and C combines with chlorine to form
b. He and Ne are inert elements. an acid and common salt respectively. The oxide of
element A is liquid at room temperature and it is a
149. a.How does electropositivity of elements gets neutral substance, while the oxides of the remaining
affected as we move (i) down the group, (ii) across six elements are basic in nature. Based on the above
the period? information, answer the following question:
b. Which atomic property increases both ways: as a. What could the element A be?
we move across the period or down the group? b. Will elements A to G belong to the same period
Ans : [CBSE 2014] or same group of the periodic table?
a. (i) Electropositivity increases down the group. c. Write the formula of the compound formed by the
reaction of the element A with oxygen.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 68
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
maintained.
e. CA4 i.e., 1:4 (ii) Position of hydrogen was not justified.
or
f. A has smallest atomic radius. (iii) Isotopes could not be placed in different
154. In the following table, six elements A, B, C, D, E
slots due to different atomic mass but same
w
and F (here letters are not the usual symbols of the properties.
elements) of the Modern Periodic Table with atomic c. Number of valence electrons keep on increasing
et
numbers 3 to 18 are given as follows: along a period from left to right in a period.
a. (i) G is a noble gas, (ii) F is a halogen. c. Tendency to gain electrons increases from left to
right across the period due to decrease in atomic
yi
155. In the following table, are given eight elements A, 158. The position of three elements A, B and C in the
B, C, D, E, F, G and H (here letters are not the Periodic Table is shown below:
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 69
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
its valency is equal to 1. group of the periodic table. Their atomic numbers are
4, 12, 20 respectively
159. The position of three elements A, B and C in the a. Write the electronic configuration of these
Periodic Table is shown below: elements.
b. Write the valency exhibited by them,
Group " 1 2 13 14 15 16 17
c. Which three elements will be the most reactive?
Period
. Ans : [CBSE 2013]
a.
1 B
2 A Shell K L M N
3 C Be(4) : 2 2
k
a. A is a non-metal because it can gain one electrons For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
or
to form anion. www.cbse.online for
b. C has more number of shells i.e., it has 3 shells 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
because it belongs to 3rd period whereas A has 2 Bank
w
shells as it belongs to 2nd period. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
c. B can lose 1 electron to become stable, therefore 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
et
its valency is equal to 1. 4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
160. What physical and chemical properties of elements
N
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
were used by Mendeleev in creating his periodic Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
th
table? List two observations which posed a challenge study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
to Mendeleev’s Periodic Law. For School Education
ou
b. Formulae of oxides and hydrides was the chemical the following questions:
property.
i. Increasing order of atomic mass could not be
maintained.
n
classification of elements.
table.
@
H He
Li Be B C N O F Ne
a. Pick out the two elements which are known as
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar alkali metals.
Using this table, explain why b. Pick out the two elements which have valency of
a. Li and Na are considered as active metals. 4.
b. Atomic size of Mg is less than that of Na. c. Pick out two elements which belong to group 16
c. Fluorine is more reactive than chlorine. of the periodic table.
Ans : [CBSE 2009] Ans : [CBSE 2013]
a. Li and Na have largest atomic size in respective a. Na, K are alkali metals.
period, therefore they can lose an electron easily, b. C, Si have valency equal to 4
hence they are active metals. c. O and S belongs to group 16.
b. Mg has 12 protons and 12 electrons which has
164. Examine elements of the third period: Na, Mg, Al, Si,
more forces of attraction, therefore, it is smaller
P, S, Cl and Ar Answer the following:
in size than Na which is having 11 protons and 11
a. Choose (i) Metals, (ii) Non-metals out of these
electrons.
elements.
c. F is smaller in size, it can gain electrons easily,
b. On which side of periodic table we find (i) metals
therefore, it is more reactive than Cl.
(ii) non-metals.
162. The element Be, Mg and Ca are placed in the second c. Name metalloids out of the elements given above.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 70
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
Where are they located in the periodic table? Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2011] a. Group 18
a. (i) Na, Mg, A1 are metals. b. They will form anions.
(ii) P, S, Cl, Ar are non-metals. c. F will have similar properties to ‘C’.
b. (i) Metals are placed on the left hand side and d. A has only one shell.
middle part of the periodic table. e. A and D both are inert elements.
(ii) Non-metals are placed on the right hand side f. C is the most abundant element in the Earth
of periodic table. crust.
c. Silicon is a metalloid. They are located between
metals and non-metals at the border line in a zig- FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
zag manner.
k
b. Atomic number goes on increasing along the fundamental than its atomic mass.
or
period from left to right. c. State modern periodic law.
c. Electronegativity goes on increasing along a Ans : [CBSE 2018]
period from left to right.
w
(a)
166. (a) Name metals among the first five elements of the Dobereiner Periodic Table
et
Modern Periodic Table. Advantage: It could predict the atomic mass of middle
(b) Write their symbols. elements quite correctly. Limitations: He could identify
(c) Write the formula of their oxides.
N only three triads of elements.
Newlands Periodic Table
Ans : [CBSE 2016, 2015]
Advantage: Every eight element had properties similar
th
a. Lithium and Beryllium are metals among first five to the first if elements are arranged in increasing order
elements. of atomic mass.
ou
b. Lithium (Li), Beryllium (Be). Limitations: It was applicable only upto calcium only.
c. Li2O and BeO are the formulae of their oxides. No future elements could fit into it.
Mendeleev’s Periodic Table
gY
b. They have 1 valence electron and form positive isotopes could not be sorted out.
ions with +1 charge. (b) Moseley:
Fl
c. They are largest in size in their respective periods. Properties of elements are a periodic function of their
atomic numbers.
168. The position of elements A, B, C, D, E, F and G in
@
the Modern Periodic Table is given as under: 170. Name the element which has
a. the electronic configuration 2, 8, 1.
Group " 16 17 18 b. a total of two shells, with 4 electrons in the
valence shell.
Period c. a total of three shells, with 3 electrons in the
. valence shell.
1 A d. one shell which is completely filled with electrons.
e. twice as many electrons in the second shell as in
2 B C D the first shell.
3 E F G Ans : [CBSE 2016]
a. In which group are inert elements placed? a. Sodium (2, 8, - 1)
b. What type of ions would ‘B’, ‘C’, ‘E’ and ‘F’will b. Carbon (2, 4)
form? c. Aluminium (2, 8, 3) i
c. Which element would have chemical properties d. Helium (2)
similar to ‘C’ ? e. Carbon (2, 4)
d. How many shells do ‘A’ have?
e. What is the similarity between ‘A’ and ‘D’ ? 171. a.Why do we classify elements?
f. Identify the most abundant element in the earth b. What were the two criteria used by Mendeleev in
crust. creating his periodic table.
c. Why did Mendeleev left some gaps in his periodic
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 71
Chap 5 : Periodic Classification of Elements www.cbse.online
k
172. Atoms of eight elements A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H belongs to group-13, ‘D’ belongs to group-14 which
have the same number of electronic shells but different
or
forms almost neutral oxide (actually amphoteric
number of electrons in their outermost shell. It was oxide), E and F belong to group-15, 16 forming
found that elements A and G combine to form an acidic oxides. ‘G’ belongs to group-17 because
w
ionic compound. This compound is added in a small NaCl is used in cooking. ‘H’ belongs to group 18.
amount to almost all vegetable dishes during cooking. they belong to third period of the periodic table.
et
Oxides of elements A and B are basic in nature while b. H belongs to noble gas elements.
those of E and F are acidic. The oxide of D is almost c. A will have largest atomic radius.
neutral. Based on the above information answer the
N d. E and F are likely to be non-metals,
following questions: e. D is likely to be a metalloid or semi metal.
a. To which group or period of the Periodic Table do
th
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
the listed elements belong to?
b. What would be the nature of the compound
ou
write the formula of the compound formed by the All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
combination of‘C’and ‘G’. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
Fl
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
Ans : [CBSE 2010] study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
a. A and B belongs to group-1 and group-2
@
Life Process
k
why does it takes food? [All India 2017] Starch and glycogen.
or
Ans :
12. What is the meaning of variegated leaf?
To carry out life processes, growth, reproduction and
Ans : [All India 2009]
w
for repair of worn out tissues.
Variegated leaf means leaf with some green and some
3. Which pathway is common to both aerobic and
et
non-green part.
anaerobic respiration? [All India 2012]
Ans : 13. Define the term ‘ translocation’. [Delhi 2008]
N
Glycolysis. Ans :
th
Transport of food from leaves to other parts of the
4. What would be the consequences of deficiency of plant is called translocation.
haemoglobin in our bodies? [Foreign 2012]
ou
www.cbse.online for
5. How does nutrition in a fungus different from that in 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
a tapeworm? [CBSE 2011 C] Bank
Ans : 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
n
saprophytic manner while tapeworm is only parasitic. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
6. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Fl
Name mode of nutrition in the following organisms: Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
(a) Fungi (b) Amoeba New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
Ans : [All India 2011] For School Education
@
a. Fungi - saprophytic
b. Amoeba — animal like nutrition 14. Why is respiration considered an exothermic process?
7. What is peristalsis? [Delhi 2011] Ans : [All India 2008]
Ans : Respiration is considered an exothermic process due
to breaking down of glucose/food in the presence of
Contraction and expansion of alimentary canal to
oxygen with release of energy.
push the food forward is called peristalsis.
15. What is breathing? [All India 2008]
8. What is the role of cartilaginous rings on trachea?
Ans :
Ans : [All India 2010]
The mechanism by which organisms intake oxygen
They prevent the collapsing of trachea when there is
from the environment and release carbon dioxide is
no air present in it.
called breathing.
9. Name the type of blood vessels, which carry blood
16. Mention two ways in which food gets oxidized in
from organs to the heart.
organisms. [CBSE 2008C]
Ans : [All India 2010]
Ans :
Veins.
Aerobic respiration and anaerobic respiration.
10. How is the passage of food regulated from stomach
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 73
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
17. What role do digestive enzymes play in the alimentary Saprophytic Parasitic Nutrition
canal? [CBSE 2008C] Nutrition
Ans :
1. Taking dead decay Living on or inside other
Digestive enzymes break down complex molecules of organic matter in organisms and deriving
food into simpler ones so that they can be absorbed the form of food is their food from them
by blood. called saprophytic without killing them.
nutrition.
18. Which enzyme is present in human saliva?
Ans : [Foreign 2008] 2. It shows It has intracellular
extracellular digestion.
Salivary amylase or ptyalin. digestion.
19. What are the end products of photosynthesis? 3. It does not depend It causes harm to the
Ans : [All India 2008] on living host. organism.
Glucose, oxygen and water.
4. E.g., fungi and E.g., lice, tapeworm,
20. Give two examples of variegated leaves. bacteria. leech.
Ans : [Delhi 2008]
24. How do plants exchange gases?
k
Crotons, money plant.
Ans : [Foreign 2017]
or
Plants exchange gases through stomata. Large
TWO MARKS QUESTIONS intercellular spaces ensure that each cell is in contact
w
with air. Carbon dioxide and oxygen are exchanged
here.
21. What is Lymph? How is it different from blood?
Ans : [All India 2018]
et
25. List two factors which decide direction of diffusion of
oxygen and carbon dioxide.
Lymph is the light yellow fluid containing lymphocyte,
N
which fights against infections. Ans : [All India 2017]
th
Blood Lymph Environmental conditions and requirement of the
plants decide direction of diffusion of oxygen and
1. Blood is pumped Lymph is moved along
ou
carbon dioxide.
throughout the body through the normal
by heart. function of the body. 26. What are the strategies of plants to get rid of their
wastes?
gY
the body in a circular lymph is in a single b. Some wastes like gums, oil and resins may be
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 74
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
Actively metabolizing cells of an extremely active Arteries carry blood away from the heart (arteriole:
skeletal muscle, during heavy exercise, carry oxidation small arterial branch). They have thick and flexible
in the anaerobic condition inside the muscle cell, we feel walls to endure higher pressure of blood.
pain after a vigorous exercise because of production of Veins transport blood toward the heart (venue:
ATP by anaerobic respiration in leg muscles. small vessel that carries blood from capillaries to
29. List two ways in which plants can get rid of the veins). They have thinner wall but there are valves in
wastes. them at regular distance to prevent back flow of blood
especially when blood is returning back to heart from
Ans : [All India 2016]
lower organs.
They can throw gases and excess water through
stomata through diffusion. They can store wastes like NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
gums and resins in old xylem tissue (wood). For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
30. What is the role of acid and mucus in stomach? 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Ans : [Delhi 2016] Bank
It kills germs in food and provides acidic medium for 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
the action of pepsin enzyme to digest the proteins in 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
stomach. 4. NCERT Solutions
k
Mucus protects the wall of stomach from the action of All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
or
acid and pepsin. Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
31. Which digestive secretion does not contain any enzyme study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
w
For School Education
but is important? Discuss. [All India 2016]
Ans :
et
Bile juice from liver. It contains bile salts which are 37. Differentiate between respiration and breathing.
necessary for emulsification of fats. It means breaking Ans : [All India 2015]
N
down large fat drops to very fine droplets so that
lipase can act upon them easily. Respiration Breathing
th
1. It is a biochemical It is a physical process.
32. Differentiate between auricles and ventricles. process.
ou
They prevent the back flow of blood especially when it 39. Name the enzyme present in Saliva? What is its
moves against gravity and under low blood pressure. role?
34. How is the small intestine designed to absorb digested
Ans : [All India 2014]
food? [All India 2016] Salivary amylase enzyme present in saliva. It breaks
Ans : down starch to sugar maltose.
Walls of small intestine has finger like projection called 40. How does nutrition take place in Amoeba? How is it
villi to increase surface area. The food is absorbed different in Paramoecium? [All India 2014]
by villi and brought into blood. Fat is brought into Ans :
lymph vessel.
Nutrition in amoeba: It occurs through phagocytosis.
35. Why are arteries thick walled and elastic? It capture food by pseudopodia (ingestion) ingested
Ans : [All India 2015] food, enclosed in cell membrane is called food vacuole.
The food is broken with enzymes present in cytoplasm
Arteries receive the blood pumped by heart with lots
and undigested food ‘is thrown out through cell
of pressure hence to tolerate and sustain this pressure
membrane.
they are thick walled and elastic.
Nutrition in Paramoecium: The cell has a definite
36. Differentiate between Artery and Veins. shape and food is taken in at a specific spot. Food is
moved to this spot by the movement of cilia present
Ans : [CBSE 2015 C]
on the entire surface of the cell.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 75
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
41. Discuss how the roles of vena cava and pulmonary organisms?
veins different from each other? Ans : [Delhi 2013]
Ans : [Foreign 2014] Autotrophs can use simple inorganic molecules like
Pulmonary vein carries oxygenated blood from lungs water and carbon dioxide while complex organic
to left auricle of heart in humans. molecule are used by heterotrophic organisms as
Vena Cava collects deoxygenated blood from all proteins, fats and carbohydrates.
parts of the body and transport it to right auricle of 49. Why are ventricles thick walled and muscular?
the heart in human.
Ans : [All India 2013]
42. Why is it advisable to breathe through nose? Since ventricles have to pump blood into various
Ans : [CBSE 2014 C] organs, they are thick-walled and muscular.
There are fine hair and mucus gland in the inner lining 50. How is the length of intestine related to food habit of
of nose which filter the incoming air of germs and dust. the animal? [All India 2012]
Moreover the air attains the optimum temperature
Ans :
before reaching the lungs.
Intestine where digestion and absorption occur is
43. Define transpiration. How does transpiration help in very long in herbivores and shorter in carnivores as
upward movement of water from roots to leaves? .
k
digesting meat is easier than digesting grass.
Ans : [All India 2014]
or
51. Differentiate between Photosynthesis and
Transpiration is the process of removal of water Respiration.
vapours from the aerial parts of a plant, mainly
w
Ans : [All India 2011]
through stomata in the leaves.
Evaporation of water molecules from the cells of Respiration Photosynthesis
a leaf creates a suction force which pulls water from
the xylem cells. This transpiration helps in upward
et 1. It occurs in all living It occurs in only
N cells. autotrophs.
movement of water from roots to leaves.
2. O2 reacts with food CO2 and H2O combine
th
44. Describe the structure of the human heart briefly. and energy is released. to form starch and
Ans : [Sample Paper 2014-15] water in the presence
ou
of light.
Human heart is four chambered. The two upper
chambers are called atria and they receive blood from 3. It occurs in cytoplasm Occur in plastid-
large veins while the two lower chambers are called and mitochondria. chloroplast
gY
ventricle.
yi
45. Name the respiratory pigment in human beings? What Alveoli in the Nephrons in the
is its role? [All India 2013] Lungs Kidneys
Fl
of plants, first is xylem and second is phloem. in desert plants they open at night to reduce the loss
of water. Water is absorbed by roots from the soil
Xylem Phloem
along with other materials like nitrogen, phosphorus,
1. Water and mineral Transportation of iron and magnesium.
from the roots to food and nutrients
aerial parts of the from leaves to growing 61. How do autotrophs obtain CO2 and N2 to make their
plant. parts of plant. food?
This movement of Ans : [All India 2008]
substance is called
CO2 from environment/atmosphere through diffusion/
translocation.
stomata. Nitrogen from soil/environment in inorganic
2. Its movement is Its movement is (nitrates) or organic form.
unidirectional - moves bidirectional - moves
up the plant’s stem. up and down 62. Write one function each of the following components
of the transport system in human beings
3. Tracheids, vessels are Sieve tubes, blood vessels
the elements of xylem. companion cells are blood platelets
the element of phloem. Lymph
55. What is respiration? What is its importance for an
Heart
k
organism. Ans : [All India 2008]
or
Ans : [CBSE 2009 C] a. Blood vessels: transport of blood.
The breakdown of food in cells to release energy. b. Blood platelets: clotting of blood preventing its
loss/leakage.
w
All kind of food is broken down through oxidation-
reduction reaction and its chemical energy is converted c. Lymph: carries digested fats/protects from
into a universal source of chemical energy - ATP, infection/exchange of materials between tissues
et
Adenosine Tri Phosphate. and blood/drains excessive fluid back to blood.
d. Heart: pumps blood to all parts.
56. What is residual volume in our lungs? What is its
N
importance? [All India 2011] THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
th
Ans :
Residual volume is the amount of air which is always
ou
left inside the lungs in spite of forceful exhalation. It 63. What is sequence of steps in photosynthesis? How is
helps in continuous gas exchange during exhalation or it different in desert plants and those in temperate
inhalation. regions?
gY
Saliva lubricates and softens the food so that it can photosynthesis are slightly different.
be easily chewed and swallowed. It contains enzyme
amylase which breaks down starch to maltose. These plants take up carbon dioxide at night and
prepare an intermediate which is acted upon by the
59. Why rate of breathing in aquatic animals has to be energy absorbed by the chlorophyll during the day.
faster than that in terrestrial animals?[CBSE 2008 C]
64. Design an activity to show that CO2 is produced
Ans :
during breathing. [Delhi 2017]
Amount of O2 dissolved in water is less than O2 Ans :
present in air therefore rate of breathing in aquatic
animals has to be faster than that in terrestrial Materials Required:
animals. Terrestrial organism need not spend so much Two test tubes, a cork with two holes, two glass tubes
energy to obtain oxygen. bent at right angle, syringe, lime water Ca(OH)2.
Procedure :
60. What are the raw materials for photosynthesis. How a. Take some freshly prepared lime water, Ca(OH)2
are they obtained by a plant? [CBSE 2008 C] in two test tubes,
Ans : b. Fit cork with two holes in test tubes A and B.
c. Fix two glass tubes in this cork of test tube A as
CO2 and water are needed for the photosynthesis. CO2
shown in the figure.
enters the leaf through stoma present on its surface.
d. Exhale air into the tube and record your
These pores open in day time in most of plants though
observations.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 77
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
e. Pass air by the syringe through the lime water (ii) Osmoregulation - The process of maintaining
contained in test tube B and record your the right amount of water and proper ionic
observations. balance in body. It is done by controlling
the amount of water and salts reabsorbed by
nephron - tubules.
k
or
67. a. How is oxygen and carbon dioxide exchanged
between blood and tissue? How are the gases
w
transported in human being?
b. What is haemoglobin? [CBSE 2016-17]
et
Ans :
a. Exchange of gases in tissues occurs through
N diffusion. Oxygen is carried as oxyhaemoglobin
from lungs to tissues. It dissociates and carbon
th
dioxide diffuses out into blood from tissues. It is
(B) transported in dissolved form and reaches lungs
ou
Air being passed into lime water with a syringe where again it diffuses to alveoli.
b. Respiratory pigment: Haemoglobin is a red
Observation: coloured protein present in red blood cells.
gY
Lime water turns milky sooner in test tube A than in Haemoglobin has affinity for O2.
test tube B.
Conclusion 68. What are the important features of all respiratory
a. The exhaled air contains lot of CO2 which turns structures in animals?
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 78
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
70. What is the need to have a transport system in d. Enzymes produced in intestinal juice complete
complex organisms? [CBSE 2013C] the digestive process.
Ans : e. Digested food - amino acids, sugar are absorbed
by the blood capillaries present in the villi of
The transport system of an animal moves substances
intestine.
to where they are needed in the body. Even the
f. Digested fats are absorbed by lymph vessels
smallest animal must have the means of transporting
present in the villi of intestine.
substances around its body. Oxygen and food molecules
must move to all the cells, and the waste products 74. Give schematic representation of different pathways of
must be removed from the cells and expelled into the breakdown of glucose molecule.
environment. It occurs through diffusion mainly. [All India 2010,2014,2016]
In a multicellular organism, all cells are not in Ans :
contact with the surrounding hence diffusion will be
insufficient for it. A variety of fluid systems, called
vascular systems, help such transport in most members
of the animal kingdom.
k
Ans : formation and precipitation? Define the process. How
or
is this process important for the plants?
Mechanism of inhalation:
Ans : [All India 2010]
a. The diaphragm and rib muscles contract which
w
make the throat move upwards and outwards. They are due to transpiration. Transpiration is
b. The volume inside the thoracic cavity increases evaporation of water from aerial parts, leaves of plant,
et
i.e., it expands. through mainly stomata.
c. Air pressure inside the thoracic cavity decreases. a. In plants, water rises because of transpiration and
in nature water cycle operates because of it.
Thus, air from outside rushes into the lungs /
N
alveoli through nostrils, trachea and bronchi. b. Transpiration is the process of cooling the parts
of a plant.
th
72. How is food transported in a plant? c. Evaporation of water molecules from the cells of
Ans : [Foreign 2011] a leaf creates a suction force which pulls water
ou
The food prepared by plant may be sucrose, amino from the xylem cells. This transpiration helps in
acids or other materials. It is done with the help of upward movement of water from roots to leaves.
living cells- sieve tubes and companion cell of phloem
gY
from storage organ to organ of its utilization (growing Write chemical equation for each type.
buds) depending upon the situation.
yi
or
a. Translocation: Transport of organic food from the What are the different ways in which glucose is
leaves to the other parts of the plants through the oxidized to provide energy in various organisms?
Fl
sieve tubes of phloem tissue is called translocation. [All India 2010, 2013, 2015]
b. Importance: It is an essential process as every part
Ans :
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 79
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
and aerobic respiration generates in total of 38 ATP pulling water and minerals upward through xylem
molecules. elements-ascent of sap. Thus transpiration helps
Presence of Oxygen
Glucose $ Pyruvate in upward movement of water from roots to leaves.
Carbon dioxide + Water + Energy 7. The roots of a plant absorb water and dissolved
substances from the soil, which is needed by the
77. Leaves of a healthy potted plant were coated with aerial parts of the plants. As such these substances
Vaseline to block the stomata. Will this plant remain are to be transported from roots up to stem,
healthy for long? Stage three reasons for your leaves and flowers.
answer. [All India 2009]
Ans : 80. Describe the mechanism of gaseous exchange in tissues
and lungs. [Delhi 2015]
No, the plant will not stay healthy for a long time. or
The reasons are: How is oxygen and carbon dioxide transported in
a. It will not be able to exchange O2 and CO2, hence human being? [CBSE 2016]
respiration will be affected adversely. or
b. Photosynthesis will also be affected as CO2 will How is oxygen and carbon dioxide transported in
not be available. human being? Explain clearly how the air is inhaled
c. Transpiration will not take place hence there will and exhaled during breathing in humans.
be no ascent of sap, hence no water absorption
Ans : [All India 2009]
k
from the soil.
Exchange of gases in tissues:
or
78. If a plant is kept covered with a polythene sheet, a. Most of oxygen is carried by haemoglobin in
we notice some water drops on the inner side of the blood. On reaching the tissues, it gets diffused
w
sheet after some time. What are they due to? Name into the cells as it is in higher concentration than
and define the process. What is the significance of in the cells.
et
this process in plants and in nature? How does b. The carbon dioxide, which is formed in the cells,
transpiration help in upward movement of water from gets accumulated there in higher concentration
roots to leaves? [Delhi 2015]
N as compared in the blood, now diffused into the
Ans : blood.
c. The CO2 mostly dissolved in blood plasma reaches
th
If a plant is kept covered with a polythene sheet, we
the lungs, from where it is expelled out during
notice some water drops on the inner side of the sheet
exhalation.
ou
and bronchi.
FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS Mechanism of Exhalation :
yi
79. How are water and minerals absorbed and transported thoracic cavity comes back to its original size as
in the plants? [All India 2009] diaphragm muscles relax. Air containing CO2 is
Ans : exhaled out through bronchi, trachea and nostrils.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 80
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
Aerobic Anaerobic 84. a. What are two vital functions of the human kidney?
respiration respiration b. Draw labelled diagram of human urinary system.
Ans : [Delhi 2017]
1. Presence of air Presence of air not
required. required a. The two vital functions of kidney are —
1. Excretion of nitrogenous wastes.
2. Occur in two steps: Complete process 2. Osmoregulation - regulation of water and salt
1st Glycolysis in occurs in cytoplasm. content in blood.
cytoplasm.
2nd in mitochondria.
3. Glucose completely Glucose incompletely
oxidized to CO, and oxidized to either an
H2O. organic acid or alcohol
with CO2.
4. Large amount of Less energy produced
energy produced
5 E.g., man, higher E.g., yeast,
plants lactobacillus
k
85. Describe double circulation in human beings. Name
82. a. Mention any two components of blood.
or
the group of animal with double circulation? How is it
b. Trace the movement of oxygenated blood in the
important for them?[Foreign 2017] [All India 2016-17]
body.
Ans :
w
c. Write the function of valves present in between
atria and ventricles. Such a flow in which blood enters the heart twice
et
d. Write one structural difference between the is called double circulation. It helps in keeping the
composition of artery and veins. [All India 2018] N oxygenated and deoxygenated blood separate.
Ans : The right atrium receives blood from the vena
a. plasma, blood cells. cava and pumps the blood into the right ventricle.
th
b. Pulmonary vein from lungs " left atrium left Blood is sent to lungs, where it is oxygenated. Then,
ventricle " aorta " arteries to all organs. it is sent through the right and left pulmonary veins to
ou
c. Valves prevent backflow of blood from ventricles the left atrium where it is pumped to the left ventricle.
to atria when latter are contracting. The blood then travels to the ascending aorta where it
d. Arteries have thick, muscular and elastic walls. leaves the heart and delivers oxygen to different parts
gY
Veins have thinner, less muscular walls but have of the body.
valves.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 81
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
concave portion faces medially. The kidney collects passes through the proximal convoluted tubule , Loop
and transports urine from the kidney to ureters. of Henle, the distal convoluted tubule so that useful
The kidneys regulate: substances are re-absorbed by blood present in the
a. The volume of blood plasma (blood pressure). capillaries around them.
b. The concentration of waste products in the blood
(excretion).
c. The concentration of electrolytes such as Na+, K+,
HCO3- and other ions (osmoregulation).
d. The pH of plasma.
e. Figure :
k
or
The liquid is now called urine is concentrated and
87. What are the different components of blood? Give the collected in collecting duct and poured in ureters to
w
function of each of them. [Foreign 2015] be carried to urinary bladder. Urine is passed out
Ans : through urethra, when the urinary bladder is full and
due to pressure there is an urge to do so. Sphincter
et
Blood is a liquid connective tissue. It is chiefly formed muscles regulate this process
of two components:
a. Fluid matrix or plasma: It is of pale colour
N Osmoregulation and excretion are intimately
and transports much substance like dissolved related, these processes together maintain homeostasis
th
carbon dioxide, glucose, amino acids, urea etc. (i.e. staying the same), and are performed by the
has mainly water, some proteins like albumin, same set of organs. The kidney is the major organ of
osmoregulation and excretion in vertebrates.
ou
(1) Red blood corpuscles (R.B.C) or erythrocyt. liquid A after about 10 minutes, she added a few
es, which transport O2 and CO2. They are drops of iodine solution to the mixture in the first test
enucleated, disc shaped, full of a red colored tube. It did not show any colour but when she treated
protein pigment, hemoglobin. the other test tube with iodine, a blue black colour
n
(2) White blood corpuscles (W.B.C) or leucocytes, appeared. Now answer the following questions:
yi
which fight disease-causing agent. They are a. What is the aim of this activity?
larger, nucleated and are of different types. b. What is liquid A?
(3) Blood platelets or thrombocytes, which help
Fl
c. Why did the first test tube not show any colour
in blood clotting. They are fragments of some change with iodine while the second one did?
larger cell hence do not have nucleus. d. Which enzyme is responsible for such a result?
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 82
Chap 6 : Life Process www.cbse.online
for exchange of gases? the dot like structures present in these cells.
Ans : [All India 2008,2016-17]
Exchange of gases in tissues occurs through diffusion.
Oxygen is carried as oxyhaemoglobin from lungs to
tissues. It dissociates and carbon dioxide diffuses out
into blood from tissues. It is transported in dissolved
form and reaches lungs where again it diffuses to
alveoli. Lungs have a tree like branching pattern Ans : [Delhi 2017]
of bronchi and bronchioles. The terminal part of
Stomata. Gas exchange and transpiration occur
bronchiole ends into sac like structures called alveoli
through the stomata. Dot like structures are called
which are present in groups. Alveoli have curved wall
chloroplasts.
to increase surface area for exchange of gases. The
wall of alveoli is extremely thin and is lined by blood 95. Name the chemical in small tube hanging in conical
capillaries. flask. Why is it being used?
91. (i) Explain the importance of the following:
(a) salivary amylase
(b) villi
k
(c) pepsin
(ii) Explain how oxygenated blood from this chamber
or
is sent to all parts of the body.
Ans : [All India 2008]
w
Ans : [Delhi 2017]
(i) (a) Salivary amylase: It’s an enzyme present in
the saliva, secreted by salivary glands. It Potassium hydroxide. It is used to absorb carbon
et
digests starch into maltose there by starting dioxide released by germinating seeds during
the digestion of carbohydrate in the buccal respiration.
cavity.
N
(b) Villi: They increase the surface area for 96. Identify structure 1-4 in the given figure:
th
absorption of digested food into the blood.
(c) Pepsin: It is a digestive enzyme secreted
ou
92. In order to prepare a temporary mount of a leaf peel 97. A student set up apparatus as shown in figure. After 8
yi
to observe stomata, which chemicals used for staining hours what is he likely to observe. Explain the reasons.
and mounting? [Delhi 2017]
Fl
Ans :
The chemicals used for staining and mounting
@
Ans :
a. Water would have risen in the tube as the oxygen
present in the airtight flask would have been used
up by germinating seeds for their respiration and
CO2 gas which is being produced them must
have been absorbed by KOH. As a result partial
Ans : vacuum created will make water from beaker
move up.
Nothing will happen to the level of water/ KOH as
b. Water will rise initially while seeds are germinating
vacuum will not be created in the flask.
but fall later.
94. Name the gap formed between the kidney shaped cells c. Water.
in the given figure. What role do they play? What are WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 83
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
k
2. List two body functions that will be affected if
or
cerebellum gets damaged. 11. At the time of puberty, both boys and girls show
Ans : [CBSE 2016] lots of changes in appearance. Name the hormones
responsible for these changes.
w
a. Walking in a straight line.
b. Picking up a thing from the ground. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
et
Testosterone in male and oestrogen in females.
3. Write the role of motor areas in brain.
Ans : NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
[CBSE 2015]
N
Motor areas of the brain control the movement of For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
th
voluntary muscles.
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
4. Give the scientific names of the following regions of Bank
ou
Ans : [CBSE 2015] All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
a. Temporal lobe (of the forebrain) Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
b. Medulla (of the hindbrain)
n
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
5. All information for our environment is detected by
yi
6. State the function of: 13. Which gland secretes growth hormone in human
a. gustatory receptors beings?
b. olfactory receptors Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Pituitary gland.
a. To detect taste.
14. Which mechanism control timing and amount of
b. To detect smell.
hormone released?
7. Which part of the nervous system controls reflex arcs? Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Ans : [CBSE 2014] Feedback mechanism.
Spinal cord.
15. Define‘Chemotropism’.
8. What type of movement is shown by mimosa plant Ans : [CBSE 2013]
leaves when touched with a finger? Chemotropism is a nastic response towards the
Ans : [CBSE 20141 chemicals like the germination of pollen tube when
Nastic movement. pollen grain lands on stigma.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 84
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
k
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
or
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
Reflex action is a sudden, involuntary, spontaneous www.cbse.online for
response to the stimulus that is usually helpful to 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
protect ourselves from any kind of harm. Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
et
20. Name the sensory receptors found in the nose and on
the tongue. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
N All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Olfactory receptors, gustatory receptors. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
th
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
21. Give one example of chemotropism. study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
ou
22. Name the plant hormone responsible for the promotion plants and response of the animals to stimuli?
of cell division. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Plants Animals
n
Cytokinin.
1. No specific or Specialised
yi
23. How is nerve impulses get transmitted across the specialized tissue tissues are present
synapse? present for conduction in the body for
Fl
next neuron through the chemical (neurotransmitter). 2. Plant cells change Specialised proteins
shape by changing the are found in muscle
24. What will happen to a plant shoot if sunlight falls
amount of water in cells which help in
on it from one direction only? What do you call this them. changing the shape.
movement?
Ans : [CBSE S.R 2012-13] 29. Trace the sequences of events through a reflex arc
Shoot will bend towards light. Phototropism. which occur when a bright light is focused on your
eyes.
25. How is spinal cord protected? Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Ans : [CBSE S.R 2010-11]
Vertebral column made by vertebrae protects the
spinal cord.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 85
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
k
Movement of plant parts towards the light is called d. Abscisic acid inhibits growth and respond to
phototropism, e.g., stem of plant usually move towards environmental stress.
or
light.
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
33. Tendrils encircle or coil around the object in contact
w
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
with it. Elaborate. www.cbse.online for
Ans : [CBSE 2011, 2012, 2013]
et
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Tendrils are sensitive to touch. When they come in Bank
contact with any support, the part of the tendril in
N
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
contact with the object does not grow as rapidly as 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
th
the part of the tendril away from the object. This
causes the tendril to circle around the object and All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
thus, cling to it. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 86
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
k
b. The components of central nervous system are: (i) to the digestive system and skin is reduced due
or
Brain (ii) Spinal cord. to contraction of muscles around small arteries
in these organs. This diverts the blood to our
41. a. Identify the phytohormone used by plants while skeletal muscles. The breathing rate also increases
w
performing the following functions: because of the contractions of the diaphragm
1. Cell division in shoot tip. and the rib muscles. All these responses together
et
2. Inhibiting growth on approach of unfavourable enable the animal body to get ready to deal with
conditions. the situation.
b. List in tabular form two differences between the
N
movement in ‘touch me not’ plant and movement 44. The two glands A and B which occur in pairs are
present in endocrine system. The pair of glands A is
th
of shoot towards light.
found only in females whereas the pair of glands B
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
occur only in males. The gland A make and secrete
ou
a. (1) Auxin, (2) Abscisic acid. hormone C whereas gland B make and secrete hormone
b. E. In addition to hormone, gland A makes gamete F
whereas gland B makes gamete G.
gY
3. It is growth It is growth
dependent. independent. 45. ‘Brain and spinal cord are two vital organs of our
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 87
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
at the end of its axon delivers the impulse to the other Ans : [CBSE 2011]
cells like muscles cells / glands (effector organs) which a. Sensory neurons carry impulses from receptors to
react to perform the action. brain. Motor neurons carry impulses from brain
to effectors.
b. The brain is kept inside a bony box (skull). Inside
the box, the brain is contained in a fluid-filled
balloon which provides further shock absorption.
This fluid is known as Cerebrospinal Fluid (CSF).
k
How does our body respond when adrenaline is provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
secreted in to the blood?
or
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
Ans : [CBSE S.R 2012-13] For School Education
w
Adrenaline is secreted during emergency situations.
Heart beats faster, supply of more oxygen to muscles,
51. (a) What is reflex arc?
more blood to skeletal muscles, increased breathing
et
(b) What are the components of reflex arc?
rate. It provides energy to muscles to act swiftly.
(c) How do muscle cells move?
48. a. Name the part of brain which controls
N Ans : [CBSE 2011]
(1) voluntary action, a. The process of detecting the signal or the input
th
(2) involuntary action. and responding to it by an output action might be
b. What is the significance of the peripheral nervous completed quickly. Such a connection is commonly
ou
Ans : [CBSE 2012] c. Muscle cells have special proteins that change
a. (1) Voluntary actions - cerebellum; their shape and arrangement in the cell in response
(2) Involuntary action — medulla oblongata. to electrical impulse. This leads the muscle cells
shortening.
n
spinal cord.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
49. a. Name the diseases by which a person is likely a. If the cerebellum is not functioning properly,
@
to suffer due to the deficiency of: (i) iodine (ii) voluntary action of our body will be affected
insulin maintaining the posture and balance of the body.
b. How the timing of secretion and amount of b. Muscle cells move by changing their shape so that
hormone secretion are regulated in human system. they get shorten.
Explain with example.
Ans : [CBSE 2012,13] 53. a. Name the hormone which is injected to a diabetic
patient.
a. (i) Goitre (ii) Diabetes.
b. Why should we use iodised salt in our diet?
b. The timing and amount of hormone released are
c. If iodine is insufficient in one’s diet, what might
regulated by feedback mechanisms, e.g., if the
be the deficiency disease and its symptoms?
sugar levels in blood rise, they are detected by the
cells of the pancreas which respond by producing Ans : [CBSE 2011]
more insulin. As the blood sugar level falls, insulin a. Insulin.
secretion is reduced. b. Iodine is necessary for the thyroid gland to
secrete thyroxine hormone. Thyroxine regulates
50. a. Differentiate between sensory neurons and motor carbohydrates, proteins and fat metabolism in the
neurons. body, to provide best balance for growth.
b. How is brain protected in our body? Name the c. If iodine is insufficient in one’s diet, iodine
part of the brain responsible for precision of deficiency disease called goitre occurs. Symptom
voluntary actions and maintaining body posture is swollen neck.
and balance of the body.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 88
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
k
b. Parathyroid gland: It secretes calcitonin hormone.
c. Pancreas: It secretes two hormones: actions like blood pressure, salivation, vomiting
or
(a) Insulin (b) Glucagon etc.
w
56. Name the hormone synthesised at the shoot tips. How
does it help the plant to respond to light? a. Auxins
b. Gibberellins
et
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
c. Cytokinins
Auxin is synthesised at the shoot tips when growing d. Abscisic acid
plant detects light and helps the cells to grow longer.
N e. Ethylene
When light is coming from one side of the plant, Ans : [CBSE 2015]
th
auxin diffuses towards the shady side of the shoot. a. Auxins promote cell elongation, root formation,
This concentration of auxin stimulates the cells to cell division, etc. It also promote fruit growth.
ou
grow longer on the side of the shoot which is away b. Gibberellins stimulate stem elongation, seed
from light. Thus, the plant appears to bend towards germination and flowering.
light. c. Cytokinins help in breaking the dormancy of
gY
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 89
Chap 7 : Control and Coordination www.cbse.online
phototropism and explain why does this occur. NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
Ans : [CBSE 2013] For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
a. Take a plant and make such an arrangement that www.cbse.online for
it receives the light coming from a window as 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
shown in the figure and observe it for few days. Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
k
d. When growing plants detect light, auxin,
or
synthesized at the shoot tip, helps the cells to
grow longer. Auxin always diffuses towards the
shady side of the shoot. This concentrations of
w
auxin stimulates the cells to grow longer on the
side of the shoot which is away from light. Thus,
the plant appears to bend towards light.
et
61. (a) What is phototropism and geotropism? With
N
labelled diagrams describe an activity to show
th
that light and gravity change the direction that
plant part grows in.
ou
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 90
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
Leishmania, Binary fission.
or
2. Name the method by which Planaria reproduce
under favourable conditions. Is this method sexual or 11. Name two simple organisms having the ability of
asexual? regeneration.
w
Ans : [Delhi 2017] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
et
Regeneration. Asexual Planaria/hydra/earthworm (any two).
3. Name the method by which Plasmodium reproduce 12. Give the respective scientific terms used for studying:
N
under favourable conditions. Is this method sexual or a. The mechanism by which variations are created
asexual? and inherited and
th
Ans : [Delhi 2017] b. The development of new type of organisms from
the existing ones.
Multiple Fission. Asexual
ou
b. Fission.
Its DNA first doubles up followed by its equal and NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
accurate division between two daughter cells.
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
n
In human female, ovary contains thousands of eggs. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
One egg is produced every month one of the ovaries. 4. NCERT Solutions
Ovary also secretes estrogens hormone for development
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 91
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2014,12] 28. Name two ways of vegetative propagation practiced
or
Because testes require temperature 2°C less than the by gardeners.
body temperature for the production of sperms. Ans : [All India 2009]
w
19. How does the embryo gets nourishment from the Cutting and grafting.
et
mother?
29. What is reproduction?
Ans : [All India 2013]
Ans : [All India 2009 C]
Through placenta.
N
Reproduction is the process of producing individuals
of its own kind.
th
20. Why does the lining of uterus become thick and
spongy every month?
30. What is the effect of DNA copying which is not
ou
31. State the changes that take place in the uterus when
organisms which have those cells only can show
a. implantation of embryo has occurred
regeneration.
b. female gamete/egg is not fertilized
Fl
22. What is the advantage of reproducing through spores? Ans : [Delhi 2017]
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 92
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
parts which grow further. a. Each piece grows into a complete organism.
b. Develops into new plants.
33. a. What is the location of the following: c. Changes occurs in the appearance at the time of
(i) DNA in a cell (ii) Gene puberty.
b. Expand DNA.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] 38. What does the diagram given below correctly
illustrate? Give reason in support of your answer.
a. (i) Nucleus. (ii) Located on the chromosomes.
b. Deoxyribo Nucleic Acid.
k
35. “Variations” are seen in the organisms. State the two cells during division in Amoeba can take place in any
plane.
or
main causes of variation.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] 39. What is the main difference between sperms and eggs
w
Variations are caused by: of human? Write the importance of this difference?
a. Change in the genetic material, i.e., DNA at the Ans : [All India 2014]
et
time of DNA copying.
Sperms are motile and are produced in . large
b. Environmental factors viz., light, temperature,
numbers by a male. Egg are non-motile and only one
nutrition, wind and water supply, etc.
N is produced at a time by the female.
c. Mutations.
Sperms are motile as they have to travel up to egg
th
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS for fertilization. It becomes zygote, remains protected
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at inside female’s body and gives rise to foetus and baby.
ou
www.cbse.online for
40. Draw labelled diagrams to illustrate budding in Hydra.
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank Ans : [CBSE 2014]
gY
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise). a. In sexual reproduction, fusion of male and female
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved). gametes takes place, these germ-cells/gametes
4. NCERT Solutions contain half the number of chromosomes and by
n
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be the fusion of these gametes the zygote is formed
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly. with full set of chromosomes.
yi
a. Reproduction seen in organisms by formation of a. DNA copying is essential for formation of addition
spores. cellular apparatus, so that when DNA copies
b. Organisms are cut into any number of pieces and separate, each cell gets its own cellular apparatus.
each piece grows into a complete organism. b. The process of DNA copying results in variation
c. Unicellular organisms divide into many daughter each time. As a result, the DNA copies generated
cells simultaneously. will be similar, but may not be identical to the
original.
37. What happens when the following situations are
initiated: 42. “The consistency of DNA copying during reproduction
a. A Planaria is cut into three different pieces. is important for the maintenance of body design
b. Leaf of the Bryophyllum with notches falls on the features.” Support this statement with two arguments.
soil. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
c. Testosterone is released in the male reproductive
system. 43. Why is vegetative propagation practised for growing
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 93
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
some types of plants? [Delhi 2012] a. Formation of sperms takes place in testes.
or b. Prostate gland contributes fluid to the semen.
Why is vegetative propagation practiced for growing
some types of plant? List two plants which are grown 50. Why do we need to adopt contraceptive measures?
by this method. Ans : [CBSE 2012, 13]
Ans : [All India 2013] a. Contraceptive measures are needed to be adopted
Advantages of vegetative propagation: to prevent unwanted pregnancies.
a. The plants bear flowers and fruits earlier than b. To prevent sexually transmitted diseases.
those propagated sexually. c. Spacing between children.
b. Plants have lost capacity to form seeds hence d. For sound health of a mother.
they are propagated vegetatively. Such plants are
51. Give two differences between a male and a female
genetically similar to parent plants and have all
gamete.
their characters.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
44. Define variation in relation to a species. Why is a. Male gamete is smaller in size or compared to the
variation beneficial to the species? female gamete.
Ans : [CBSE 2013] b. Male gamete is motile whereas female gamete is
Variation means certain changes which occur in non-motile.
k
sexually reproducing organisms because of errors in
52. What kind of contraceptive methods prevents STDs
or
DNA copying. Variations are beneficial for species
and how?
because they given survival advantage even in the
adverse environmental conditions. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
w
Barrier method prevent STDs.
45. State the importance of chromosomal difference By this method there is no direct contact of genital
et
between sperms and eggs of humans. organs of male and female and thus it prevents
Ans : [CBSE 2013] transmission of any infection.
N
Eggs always contain same type of sex chromosomes
53. List any two reasons why the Government has banned
(both X). Sperms contain X or Y sex chromosomes.
th
prenatal sex determination by law.
Thus, sperm containing X chromosome when combines
with X chromosome of egg results in a female child. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
ou
Whereas sperm containing Y chromosome when a. People may get female foetus aborted.
combines with X chromosome of egg results in a male b. Reckless female foeticide has disturbed male-
child. female ratio in society.
gY
46. a. List any two methods of asexual reproduction. 54. Mention any four ways of asexual reproduction.
b. Explain how Spirogyra reproduces. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
n
a. Fission
a. (i) Budding in Hydra and Yeast. b. Budding
yi
47. How can pregnancy be prevented surgically? tube in the human female , reproductive system.
Ans : Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Pregnancy can be prevented surgically by adopting: a. Placenta:
a. Vasectomy: When vas deferens in males are blocked (i) Helps in transporting glucose and oxygen
surgically, sperm transfer will be prevented. from the mother to the embryo.
b. Tubectomy: When fallopian tubes are blocked, (ii) Waste generated by the embryo is removed by
eggs will not be able to reach the uterus. transferring it to the mother’s blood.
b. Fallopian tube:
48. ‘Regeneration is not reproduction’. Justify this (i) Helps in carrying the egg from the ovary to
statement with reason. the uterus.
Ans : [CBSE 2013,14] (ii) Fertilization occurs here.
When a piece is cut from an organism, it grows into
56. List any four modes of asexual reproduction.
complete organisms. Regeneration is carried out by
specialized cells. It is not reproduction since most Ans : [All India 2011]
organisms would not be able to grow through pieces. a. Four modes of asexual reproduction:
b. Fission
49. State one function each performed by the following c. Budding
organs in human beings: (a) Testes (b) Prostate gland d. Spore formation
Ans : [CBSE 2013] e. Fragmentation
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 94
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
f. Regenerations c. ovule
d. sepals and petals
57. Give one example each of a unisexual and bisexual
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
flower. [All India 2011]
or a. forms zygote
Differentiate between unisexual and bisexual flower. b. forms fruit
or c. forms seed
Distinguish between unisexual and bisexual flowers d. shrinks and fall off
giving one example of each.
62. What is the function of copper-T used by some
Ans : [All India 2014-15] women? What is its effect?
Unisexual flower have only one type of sex organ, Ans : [CBSE 2011 ]
either carpels or stamen, hence they are either male
Copper-T prevents pregnancy as it prevents
or female flower. For example: Cucurbit and maize.
implantation in the uterus. It can cause side effect
Bisexual flower have both carpels and stamens. For
due to irritation of the uterus.
example: Marigold and rose.
63. Leaves of Bryophyllum fallen on the ground produce
58. List any two differences between pollination and
new plants. Why?
fertilization.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
k
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Leaves of Bryophyllum bears adventi¬tious buds/
or
Pollination Fertilization plantlets in the notches along the leaf margin. When
1. It is the transfer of It is the fusion of male the buds fall on the soil they develop into new plant
w
pollen grain from gamete with female under favourable condi-tions.
the anther to the gamete (egg).
64. Differentiate between self-pollination and cross-
et
stigma of flower.
pollination.
2. It is achieved by It is achieved by the Ans : [CBSE 2011]
N
agents like wind, growth of pollen tube
water or animals. so that the male Self-pollination Cross-pollination
th
gamete reaches the
1. Self-pollination is Cross-pollination is
female germ cells.
the transfer of pollen the transfer of pollen
ou
4. It is an external It is an internal
process process. 2. It occurs either in It occurs between
the same flower or two flowers which are
59. Differentiate between plumule and radicle. another flower of the on different plants
n
species.
Plumule Radicle
3. It occurs in the It occurs between
1. The part of growing The part of growing
Fl
k
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
69. Draw a labelled diagram of
or
4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be a. Spore formation in Rhizop us
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly. b. Multiple fission in Plasmodium.
w
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education, Ans : [CBSE 2008 C]
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
et
For School Education
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 96
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
Binary Fission Multiple Fission Define reproduction. How does it help in providing
stability to the population of species?
2. Each nuclear division Nuclear division Ans : [CBSE 2015 C]
is followed by occurs several times,
cytoplasmic division. they move towards the a. Reproduction is the process of producing
It can be irregular, periphery followed by individuals of its own kind. Through reproduction,
longitudinal or cytoplasmic division. the continuity is maintained.
transverse. b. Members of population are eliminated due to old
age, disease, accidents and other reason. They
3. Generally seen during Generally occurs have to be replaced by new members in order to
favourable conditions in unfavourable maintain a stable population.
e.g., Many bacteria conditions or in c. Reproduction brings variation so that population
and Protozoa like, parasitic forms e.g., may adapt better and evolution in species takes
Amoeba, Paramecium Plasmodium (malarial place. Ultimately new species originate from pre-
and Leishmania. parasite) existing ones.
d. Reproduction is not essential for an individual
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS as its survival is not dependent upon it but is
essential for a species for its survival.
k
71. What is vegetative propagation? List two advantages 74. Mention the total number of chromosome along
with sex chromosome. Explain how in a sexually
or
and two disadvantages of vegetative propagation.
reproducing organism chromosome number of parents
Ans : [All India 2017]
and their offsprings is the same.
w
Method of producing new plants from vegetative Ans : [Delhi 2017]
parts like roots, stem and leaves is called vegetative
Total number chromosomes is 23 pairs. The last pair
et
propagation.
Advantages are: is called sex chromosome. If they are similar, they are
a. The plants bear flowers and fruits earlier than termed as XX chromosome. They are present in the
N females. If they are dissimilar, they are called XY.
those propagated sexually.
b. Plants have lost capacity to form seeds hence they They are present in the males. DNA doubling is always
th
are propagated vegetatively. followed by cell division. But multicellular organisms
Disadvantages are: have special linkages of cells in specialised organs
ou
a. Such plants are genetically similar to parent plants which have only half the number of chromosomes and
and are vulnerable to infections and diseases. half the amount of DNA. Thus, when these germ-
b. They do not have variations therefore do not cells from two individuals combine during sexual
gY
adapt well to changing environment, the plant reproduction to form a new individual, it results in
species does not evolve. re-establishment of number of chromosome and DNA
content.
72. List three techniques to prevent pregnancy. Which of
n
them is not meant for males? How does the use of such 75. State the basic requirement for sexual reproduction.
Write the importance of such reproduction in nature.
yi
the health and prosperity of a family? type of cell division, number of chromosome is reduced
Ans : [Delhi 2015, All India 2014] to half and male and female germ cells/gametes form.
Three techniques to prevent pregnancy: These gamete fuse to form zygote on fertilization,
a. Mechanical barrier — male or female. thus the characteristic number of chromosome and the
b. Taking oral pills/i-pill/saheli - changing the normal DNA content for a cell is regained.
hormonal balance of the body so that eggs are Sexual reproduction gives rise to more variations
not released. which are essential for evolution as well as survival
c. Use of the loop or the Copper-T. of species under unfavorable conditions. Species
d. Surgical method - tubectomy / vasectomy reproducing sexually have better chances of survival.
Use of hormonal preparations is not meant for
males. 76. What happens when:
Effect on Health and Prosperity: a. Accidentally Planaria is cut into three different
a. Health of women is maintained pieces.
b. Parents can give more attention to children b. Bryophyllum leaf fall on the wet soil.
c. More resources can be made available. c. On maturation sporangia of Rhizopus burst.
Ans : [Delhi 2017]
73. Reproduction is one of the most important
characteristics of the living beings. Give three reasons a. Three new Planaria will form due to regeneration.
in support of your answer. [All India 2017] b. New plantlets will form from these buds helping
or the plant to propagate vegetatively.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 97
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
c. Spores are released which upon finding suitable flower by agents like wind, water or animals.
substratum germinates to form new individual. c. Style is the middle elongated part of the carpel.
It acts as a passage for pollen to reach ovary for
77. List four steps in sexual reproduction. Write two of the fertilization. Filaments is the elongated part
its advantages. of stamen.
Ans : [Delhi 2017]
81. a. Trace the path of sperms from where they are
a. Four steps in sexual reproduction :
produced in human body to the exterior.
b. Formation of gametes in the sex organs.
b. Write the functions of secretions of prostate gland
c. Transfer of male gamete to female gamete which
and seminal vesicles in humans.
involves release of both types of gametes in the
medium outside. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
d. Fusion of gametes, either inside or outside the a. The formation of sperms takes place in testes and
female parents body. delivered through the vas deferens which unites
e. Development of zygote to embryo and then with a tube coming from urinary bladder to form
complete individual. urethra from where they are excreted out of the
Advantages: body.
a. Variations are produced among the progeny. b. Prostate gland and seminal vesicles add their
b. Such populations are able to adapt well to secretions to make the sperms motile in a fluid
k
changing environment and thus evolves faster. which makes their transport easier and provides
nutrition.
or
78. Write one main difference between asexual and sexual
mode of reproduction. Which species is likely to 82. Give two examples each of the following:
w
have comparatively better chances of survival - the a. Plants having unisexual flowers
one reproducing asexually or the one reproducing b. Agents of pollination
sexually? Give reason to justify your answer. c. Physical changes on puberty that are common to
Ans : [CBSE 2017]
variation.
83. Why are the testes located outside the abdominal
2. Fertilization/zygote No fertilization/zygote
cavity? Mention the endocrine and exocrine function
gY
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 98
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
Placenta is a specialized tissue embedded in the
uterine wall. It contains villi on the embryo’s side and 4. NCERT Solutions
or
blood spaces on the mother’s side. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Function: provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
w
a. Helps in passing of nutrients from mother to New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
foetus. For School Education
et
b. Exchange of oxygen and carbon dioxide gases.
c. Passing of waste materials from embryo to the
90. List any two modes of asexual reproduction. Under
mother.
N
which mode of reproduction is vegetative propagation
87. Write one main difference between asexual and sexual placed and why? List two advantages of vegetative
th
mode of reproduction. Which species is likely to propagation.
have comparatively better chances of survival- the Ans : [All India 2014]
ou
a. Asexual reproduction does not involve genetic a. The plants bear flowers and fruits earlier than
yi
k
Ans : [All India 2014]
or
In some organism regeneration occurs but only DNA doubling is always followed by cell division. Due
to regain lost body parts like in tail of lizard, arm to this special cell division, gametes form with half the
w
of a star fish. In the case of Planaria, it is a way of content of DNA and single set of chromosomes. These
reproduction that is producing organisms of its own gamete fuse to form zygote on fertilization. Thus the
et
kind. characteristic number of chromosome and the normal
DNA content for a cell is regained.
93. In the process of reproduction as used by Spirogyra,
N Thus the consistency of the genetic material
the organism splits itself into small pieces.
throughout the species is maintained and for the
a. What is this process of reproduction called?
th
same reason the chromosome number of the sexually
b. Is this type of reproduction sexual or asexual?
reproducing parents and their offsprings is the same.
Answer with reason.
ou
a. Fragmentation.
b. Asexual as only one parent is involved, Ans : [All India 2014-15]
c. In fragmentation, the body of a simple multicellular Female Reproductive System consists of ovaries,
organism breaks down into many ‘fragments’. All fallopian tubes, uterus and vagina.
n
cells undergo division and the organism develops a. Ovaries are located inside the abdominal cavity,
yi
is capable of re-growing into a complete individual. • Secrete hormones like Estrogens which
stimulate the development of secondary
@
a. Identify the process. 97. Give the functions of the following in the process of
b. Which organism uses the above method of reproduction:
reproduction? a. Pollen tube.
c. How is the above method different from the b. ovary,
process of fragmentation? [All India 2014-15] c. Stigma.
or Ans : [All India 2015]
In context of reproduction of species, state the main
difference between fission and fragmentation. Also a. Pollen tube carries male gamete from stigma to
give one example of each. ovule.
b. Ovary has ovule and forms fruit to protect and
Ans : [All India 2016]
dispersal of seeds.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 100
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
Leishmania it is in a fixed plane.
or
99. What happens when:
a. APlanaria is cut into three different pieces,
w
b. Leaf of the Bryophyllum with notches fall on the
soil.
c. Testosterone is released in the male reproductive a. Two part have been incorrectly labelled. Identify
system.
et them.
b. Give the function of urethra.
Ans : [All India 2014-15]
N
c. Which hormone is released by testis?
a. Three new Planaria will form due to regeneration.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
th
b. New plantlets will form from these buds helping
the plant to propagate vegetatively. a. Testis, penis.
c. The male shows masculine features and attains b. Urethra serves as a common passage for both
ou
perfectly ccurate, on the reproduction process? How 103. Mention one function each of the following parts with
does the amount of DNA remain constant though respect to the female reproductive system:
each new generation is a combination of DNA copies a. Vagina
n
a. DNA copying leads to more variations in the a. The uterus open into vagina through the cervix.
offspring. The sperms enter through the vaginal passage
Fl
k
c. Use of condoms prevents pregnancy.
107. What is meant by DNA copying? Mention its
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
or
importance in reproduction.
Ans : [CBSE 2013,14] a. Transfer of pollen grains from anther to stigma.
b. Helps in evolution and survival.
w
Cells use chemical reactions to build copies of their
c. Prevents fertilization - Barrier method.
DNA. This creates two copies of the DNA in a
et
reproducing cell. DNA copying is accompanied by 112. What are secondary sexual characters in humans?
the creation of an additional cellular apparatus to Name one such character of male and female.
facilitate the DNA copies to separate with its own
N Ans : [CBSE 2013]
cellular apparatus. DNA copying gives rise to some
inbuilt tendency for variation during reproduction The characters which distinguish a male from female
th
which is the basis for evolution. are called secondary sexual characters.
Secondary sexual characters of male are moustache,
ou
108. Distinguish between the functions of ovary and testis. beard, thick growth of hair on body, strong muscles
Ans : and harsh voice.
gY
which produces eggs in males which 113. Name and explain the method by which Rhizopus
produces sperms. reproduces.
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 102
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
or
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
w
FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
et
a. Label parts A and B.
N
118. Name the type of asexual reproduction demonstrated
b. Name the hormone produced by organ “X’. What
th
is the role of this hormone in human male? by the following organisms:
c. Mention the name of substances that are a. Amoeba
b. Rhizopus
ou
120. a. List two reasons for the appearance of variations which when fall on the soil, develop into new
among the progeny formed by sexual reproduction. plants.
b. Cutting: A piece of stem, root, leaf or even a bulb
scale is placed partly under moist soil which grows
into a new plant, e.g., rose.
c. Layering: A part of the stem is pulled out and
buried in the soil. The layered stem grows into a
new plant, e.g., Pudina.
d. Grafting: In grafting, two parts from two different
plants are joined together so that they can unite
and grow into a new plant, e.g., sugarcane.
k
(iii) State the importance of , the part C.
(iv) What happens to the part marked D after a. (i) Deoxyribo Nucleic Acid.
or
fertilization is over? (ii) Informational source for making proteins.
Ans : [All India 2016] (iii) Proteins will be changed.
w
b. Its only due to DNA copying that body designs
a. Sexual reproduction confers new characteristics
are similar because DNA cell nucleus carries
on the offspring due to genetic recombination
et
information for making proteins if DNA copying
occurring during gamete formation in the sex
will not take place then body design will change.
organs. Moreover it involves union of two gametes
coming from two parents which different genetic
N
124. List five distinguishing features between sexual and
combination. Thus it ensures more diversity in asexual types of reproductions in tabular form.
th
characteristics.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
b. (i) Pollen
ou
b. Process of dividing of organisms into many cells 3. Gametes are formed in No gametes are
simultaneously. both males (sperms) produced.
Fl
Placenta is a special disc like tissue embedded (ii) Nourishment of developing embryo.
in the mother’s uterine wall and connected to the b. Placenta is a special disc like tissue embedded in
foetus/embryo. Placenta provides a large surface area the mother’s uterine wall and connected to the
for glucose and oxygen/ nutrients to pass from the foetus / embryo.
mother’s blood to the embryo/ foetus. Placenta provides a large surface area for glucose
and oxygen/nutrients to pass from the mother’s
126. a. Identify A,B,C and D in the given diagram and blood to the embryo/ foetus.
write their names.
128. Differentiate between:
a. Pollen tube and Style
b. Fission of Amoeba and Plasmodium
c. Fragmentation and regeneration
d. Bud of Hydra and bud of Bryophyllum
e. Vegetative propagation and spore formation.
Ans : [All India 2015]
a. Pollen tube forms and male gametes are carried
by it to the ovule.
Style is part of female part- carpel through
k
which pollen tube passes.
b. Amoeba shows binary fission where one cell splits
or
into two equal halves.
Plasmodium (malarial parasite) shows
w
b. What is pollination? Explain its significance. multiple fission where one cell divides into many
c. Explain the process of fertilization in flowers. daughter cells simultaneously.
Name the parts of flower that develop after
et
c. Fragmentation occurs in multi-cellular organisms
fertilization into (i) seed (ii) fruit with simple body organisation like Spirogyra (a
Ans : [Foreign 2015, CBSE 2017, All India 2014,]
N filamentous alga). It involves breaking up of a
a. A - pollen grain; B - stigma; C - Pollen tube, D - filament into many fragments and each fragment
growing into new individual.
th
Female germ cell/Egg cell.
b. Pollination - Transfer of pollen grains from anther Regeneration is the ability to give rise to new
to the stigma of a flower. individuals from the body parts of the parent
ou
Significance of pollination - Process of pollination individual, e.g., Hydra and Planaria, if their
leads to fertilization as it brings the male and bodies get broken into many pieces, each piece is
female gametes together for fusion. capable of regrowing into a complete individual.
gY
c. After a pollen falls on a suitable stigma, the pollen d. In Hydra, a bud is formed at a specific site by
tube grows out of the pollen grain and travels repeated cell division and develops into a tiny
through the style to reach the ovule in the ovary. hydra.
n
Here the male germ cell (carried by the pollen In Bryophyllum, vegetative buds arise from
tube) fuses with the female germ cell to form a the notches of its leaves and develops into a new
yi
zygote. plantlet.
e. Vegetative Propagation is the development of new
Fl
127. a.Write the function of following parts in human plants from parts like root, leaf and stem under
female reproductive system: (i) Ovary (ii) Oviduct suitable conditions, e.g., Bryophyllum vegetative
(iii) Uterus buds arise from the notches of its leaves. In potato,
@
b. Describe in brief the structure and function of ginger, garlic etc. it occurs through stems.
placenta. Spore formation: A spore is a special cell
[All India 2018] protected by thick coating. It is capable of
or germinating into a new plant when comes in
Write the functions of the following in human female contact with suitable and environment conditions
reproductive system: Ovary, oviduct, uterus and moist surface, e.g., in Rhizopus (bread
How does the embryo get nourishment inside the mould), they are formed inside reproductive,
mother’s body? Explain in brief. bob¬like sacs called sporangia.
Ans : [Delhi 2015]
129. What happens when
a. Functions of Ovary, oviduct, uterus a. Testosterone is released in the male reproductive
Functions of Ovary system.
(i) Production of female hormone, oestrogen and b. Pollen grain falls on the stigma of flower.
progesterone. c. Egg fuses with the sperm cell.
(ii) Production of female gamete / egg /germ cell. d. A Planaria is cut into three different pieces.
Functions of Oviduct: e. Buds are formed on the notches of leaf of the
(i) Transfer of female gamete from the ovary. Bryophyllum.
(ii) Site of fertilization.
Ans : [All India 2014-15]
Functions of Uterus:
(i) Implantation of Zygote/ embryo. a. The male shows masculine features and attains
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 105
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
fertility/ sperm starts forming in testis. organism. This is known as regeneration. Hydra
b. Pollen tube forms and male gametes are carried and Planaria reproduce through this process.
by it to the ovule.
c. Fertilization occurs and a zygote forms. 132. a. Identify the organisms A, B and the mode of
d. Three new Planaria will form due to regeneration. asexual reproduction exhibited by them.
e. New plantlets will form from these buds helping
the plant to propagate vegetatively.
k
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
a. (i) Bryophyllum - vegetative propagation. (ii)
Plasmodium - multiple fission.
or
For School Education
w
130. Explain what happens when: surface.
a. Testosterone is released in males. c. Budding and Regeneration.
et
b. Pollen grain falls on the stigma of the flower. Budding : A bud develops as an outgrowth due to
c. Egg fuses with sperm cell. repeated cell division at a specific site, these buds
d. Planaria is cut into many pieces.
N develop into tiny individuals, mature and detach
e. Buds are formed on the notches of the Bryophyllum from the parent to become new individuals.
leaf.
th
Regeneration: Specialized cells divide to form
Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2015] large number of cells and undergo changes to
become various cell types and tissues.
ou
plants.
a. Fertilization
b. Menstruation
@
c. Binary fission
d. Vegetative propagation
e. Regeneration
Ans :
a. The fusion of male gamete with female gamete is b. Identify the life process commonly shown in all
known as fertilization. the figures,
b. Menstruation cycle takes place every month when c. How is this life process .advantageous to the
egg is not fertilized. It lasts for about two to eight organisms? Mention any two advantages.
days and during this cycle the lining of uterus Ans :
slowly breaks and comes out through the vagina a. (A) Hydra (B) Rhizopus
as blood and mucus. (C) Bryophyllum (D) Planaria
c. Binary fission is the splitting of nucleus into two b. Asexual mode of reproduction
daughter cells which can take place in any plane. c. (i) Only one individual is required. (ii) Progeny
It can be observed in Amoeba. is identical like parents (iii) Produced in large
d. When vegetative part of a plant like the root, number (Any two)
stem or leaves develops into new plant under
appropriate conditions, it is known as vegetative 134. a.Draw a diagram of the longitudinal section of a
propagation. flower and label on it sepals, petal, ovary and
e. When body of an organism cuts into any number stigma.
of pieces and each piece grows into a complete b. Write the names of male and female parts of a
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 106
Chap 8 : How Do Organisms Reproduce www.cbse.online
k
135. a.Draw a sectional view of human female
or
reproductive system and label the part where:
(i) Eggs develop
w
(ii) Fertilization takes place
(iii) Fertilized eggs get implanted.
b. Describe in brief, the changes the uterus undergoes:
(i) To receive the zygote
(ii) If zygote is not formed.
et
N
Ans : [Delhi 2008, All India 2014, CBSE 2015]
th
a.
ou
n gY
yi
Fl
(i) Ovary
(ii) Oviduct or fallopian tube
@
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 107
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
All will bear violet flowers. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
k
www.cbse.online for
or
2. In a beetle population, the number of green beetles is 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
more than blue and red beetles. Give a reason behind Bank
this situation. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
w
Ans : [CBSE 2018] 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
et
Variation/Natural selection. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
3. What indication do we get by reappearance of dwarf provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
N Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
plant in F2 generation? New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
Ans :
th
For School Education
of character.
identified by their lengths, position of centromere and
4. How many pairs of chromosomes are present in human banding pattern on staining.
beings?
10. A normal baby girl receives her X chromosome from
n
that are really eye spots which detect light. Name that From both mother and father.
organism.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 108
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
Characters or traits of an organism are controlled by 24. Name the plant on which Mendel performed his
the genes /DNA. experiments.
Ans : [CBSE 2013,14]
14. What is a gene?
Ans : [All India 2014] Garden pea (Pisum sativum).
It is a functional piece of DNA that is responsible for 25. What are the basic events in evolution?
expression of a trait in the organisms. Ans : [CBSE 2013.14]
15. What is heredity? The changes in DNA during reproduction are the
Ans : [All India 2014] basic events in evolution.
Transmission of characters and traits from one 26. What is genetic drift?
generation to the next. Ans : [CBSE 2012,13]
16. Mendel observed a contrasting trait in relation to The change in the frequency of certain genes in a
position of flowers. Mention the trait. population over generations.
Ans : [All India 2014-15] 27. What are fossils?
Axial flower position (dominant), terminal flower Ans : [CBSE 2012, 13]
position (recessive).
k
Preserved traces of living organisms.
or
17. Name the term used for the traits that are exhibited
28. What are analogous organs?
externally.
Ans : [CBSE 2011, 12, 13]
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
w
The organs which have similar functions but different
Phenotype.
structures are called analogous organs.
18. Give the respective scientific terms used for studying:
a. the mechanism by which variations are created
et
29. The human hand, cat paw and the horse foot, when
N studied in detail show the same structure of bones and
and inherited, and
point towards a common origin.
b. the development of new type of organisms from
th
a. What do you conclude from this?
the existing ones.
b. What is the term given to such structures?
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
ou
20. What is the phenotypic ratio of a dihybrid cross in F2 It means reappearance of the dwarf character, a
generation? recessive trait in B’2 generation shows that the dwarf
Fl
21. Give an example where sex determination is regulated 31. How is the age of fossil determined?
by environmental factors.
Ans : [Panchkula 2008]
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
The age of fossil fuels is determined through carbon-
In snail, sex is determined by environmental factors dating or time dating method.
(temperature).
32. What is evolution?
22. Define speciation.
Ans : [Panchkula 2008, CBSE 2013,14]
Ans : [CBSE 2013,14]
Gradual unfolding of organisms from pre-existing
Speciation means origin of new species from the organisms through change is called evolution.
existing one.
23. What is the effect of DNA copying which is not TWO MARKS QUESTIONS
perfectly accurate on the reproduction process?
Ans : [CBSE 2013,14]
33. What are fossils? What is their significance in the
It will result in less variations which may further lead study of evolution?
to less adaptation to changing environment, thus,
Ans : [Sample Paper 2016-17]
giving less chances of survival.
Fossils are impressions of the body/ body parts or
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 109
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
the remains of organisms living in the past, which got or second generation.
preserved in sediments of earth.
a. Study of fossils helps in working out evolutionary 40. “The chromosome number of the sexually producing
relationships. parents and their offspring is the same”. Justify this
b. Fossils provide one of the most acceptable statement.
evidences in support of evolution, because we can Ans : [CBSE 2015]
study the evolutionary past of individuals in the In sexual reproduction, both the gametes (male and
form of their fossils. female) contain half the number of chromosomes
c. Age of fossils can also be found by time dating (haploid or n) and by the fusion of these gametes,
using isotopes of carbon! carbon dating. the zygote have full set (diploid 2n) chromosomes.
d. By studying fossils occurring in different strata of
rocks, geologists are able to reconstruct the time 41. If YYRR is round yellow, what do the following
course of evolutionary events. represent?
yyrr yyRR
34. (a) On what rules inheritance is based?
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
(b) Is each trait influenced by both paternal and
maternal DNA? yyrr - Wrinkled, green seeds
Ans : [CBSE 2016] yyRR — Round, green seeds
k
a. The rules of inheritance is based on the fact that 42. How did Mendel explain that it is possible that a trait
the traits in the progeny are carried out by DNA’s is inherited but not expressed in an organism?
or
of both the parents (mother and father). These Ans : [All India 2017]
rules are known s ‘Mendel’s Laws of Inheritance’.
Yes, it is possible.
w
The rules are:
(i) Law of dominance, Example - When pure tall pea plants are crossed
with pure dwarf pea plants, only tall pea plants are
et
(ii) Law of segregation, and
(iii) Law of independent assortment.
N obtained in F1 generation.
b. Yes, it is true that each trait is influenced by both On selfing tall plants of F1 both tall and dwarf
paternal and maternal DNA. plants are obtained in F2 generation in the ratio 3:1.
th
35. a. What is the genetic constitution of human sperm? Reappearance of the dwarf character, a recessive
b. Mention the chromosomes pair present in zygote trait in F2 generation shows that the dwarf trait/
ou
determining the sex of a male child. character was present in individuals of F1 but it did
not express (due to the present of tallness, a dominant
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
trait / character)
gY
a. 22 + Y or 22 + X
b. (22 + Y + 22 + X) 43. What is a dominant trait with respect to height in pea
plant. Give any two examples.
36. a. How many gene sets should a germ cell have? Ans : [All India 2014]
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 110
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
another and is responsible for its alteration. surface”. Comment on the statement stating
b. It ensures the stability of the DNA of the species. reason.
So, we can say that change in gene segment b. List two factors which could lead to the rise of
can bring about change in DNA. new species.
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
46. Where are the genes located? What is the chemical
a. This statement is correct as the fossils found
nature of gene?
closer to the surface of earth are more recent and
Ans : [CBSE 2014] those found in deeper layers are older ones.
Genes are located on chromosomes in linear sequence b. Natural selection and genetic drift.
and at fixed positions. Chemically, genes are acidic in
52. “Experience of an individual during its lifetime cannot
nature since they are nucleic acids which constitute
DNA. be passed on its progeny and cannot direct evolution”.
Justify this statement giving an example.
47. State the meaning of inherited traits and acquired Ans : [CBSE 2013]
traits. Which of the two is not passed on to the next
Since acquired characters are not inherited over
generation? Explain with the help of an example.
generations. Change in non-reproductive tissues
Ans : [All India 2013, (C) 2008] cannot be passed on to the DNA of the germ cells.
k
Acquired Trait Inherited Trait 53. What are sex chromosomes? Which sex chromosomes
or
1 Experiences of an Genetically inherited are found in male and female human beings? State the
individual during its chromosome responsible for the development of male
lifetime. child in human beings?
w
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
2. It cannot be passed on They can be passed on
et
from one generation to from one generation to Sex chromosomes are set of chromosomes present in
the next. the next. human beings which help in sex determination.
XX and XY.
3. Example: power to lift Example: Eye colour
N
Y chromosome.
weights and reading or height
th
French 54. How are fossil studies important in working out
evolutionary relationships. How would the age of
48. Tails of some mice were amputated and they were
ou
fossils be determined?
allowed to breed. The mice that were produced also
had their tails amputated and it was repeated for Ans : [CBSE 2012]
many generations. What is the reason of tail appearing Fossils are impressions of the body/ body parts or
gY
again and again? the remains of organisms living in the past, which got
Ans : [All India 2013] preserved in sediments of earth. Any remains of an
organism that has been preserved in the earth’s crust.
Such traits are acquired traits. Traits acquired during
n
passed on to the DNA of the germ cells, hence such 55. A tall pea plant was crossed with a dwarf one. F1
acquired changes are not inherited by the progeny. generation was allowed to self pollinate and F2
Example: tailless mice (if tail is removed by surgery) generation was also obtained. Answer the following
@
k
feature is not ingrained in the DNA of individual.
Some organs may be adapted to perform new
or
functions during evolution, e.g., feathers which 61. What is the difference between homologous and
were meant for providing insulation in cold analogous organs? Give one example each.
weather, slowly became adapted for flight. Hence
w
Ans : [CBSE 2008 C, 2012]
birds are closely related to reptile as dinosaurs
a. Homologous organs: Structures in animals share
had feathers, though could not fly.
et
a common ancestry. The structure, which has
58. From the set of figures given below, make a pair of similar basic structure and developmental origin
homologous and analogous organs each and give one
N but perform different functions.
reason in case of both, to justify your answer. For example: Fore limbs in vertebrates.
th
Homologous organs give an evidence of common
ancestory and evolutionary relationship between
apparently different species.
ou
Organs: or
a. Bird wing and Bat wing - Analogous organs. Explain the following:
Structures are different but functions are same. (a) Speciation (b) Natural Selection
b. Human forelimb and Bird wing — Homologous Ans : [All India 2015, CBSE 2011]
organs. a. The members of a population have minor
Structure are same but functions are different. differences among them which is called variations.
b. Two sources of variations are sexual reproduction
59. Why do human beings look different from each other?
and environmental factors.
What do you mean by species?
c. Sexual reproduction has greater chances of
Ans : [All India 2009] producing variation.
Human beings are sexually reproducing organisms. d. Variations with some advantage has greater
Genetic recombination occurs during gamete chances of surviving, for example, long neck of
formation in the sex organs followed by union of giraffe.
two gametes coming from two parents with different e. Natural selection and genetic drift lead to
genetic combination. Thus it ensures more diversity formation of new species hence evolution.
in characteristics in terms of colour, size, and looks. Natural Selection: Some variations may have
Inspite of this, they are able to reproduce among survival advantage hence they happen to gain
themselves to produce fertile offsprings. A species over others so that they can propagate more than
is a group of individuals which have some common others. Ultimately such variations are selected and
characters and they are able to reproduce among propagated among all members of the population.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 112
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
This is called adaptation of the species which with pure dwarf pea plants, only tall plants were
help them to cope well in their surroundings. obtained in F1 generation. On self pollinating the
In course of time, it could lead to accumulation F1 progeny, both tall and dwarf plants appeared
of adaptation. In geographically separated in F2 generation in the ratio 3 : 1.
populations of a species and development of Appearance of tall character in both the F1
reproductive barrier among them may lead to the and F2 shows that it is a dominant character.
formation of a new species. The absence of dwarf character in F1 generation
Genetic Drift: Some variation may not give and its reappearance in F2 shows dwarfness is the
survival advantage to members of population. recessive character.
But if by chance other variations are wiped out b. When Mendel conducted a dihybrid cross having
from populations, the remaining variations get two sets of characters, he obtained only one set of
propagated in next generations. parental characters in F1 generation whereas in F2
generation he obtained both the set of parental
63. Explain how gene expresses itself in a cell? Why are characters now recombined in the ratio of 9 : 3 :
we somewhat similar to our parents yet not identical 3 : 1.
to them? The appearance of new recombinants in the
Ans : [CBSE 2017] F2 generation along with parental type shows that
Genes are functional segments of DNA. They are units traits are inherited independently.
k
of heredity that gets passed on through reproduction
66. “Natural selection and speciation lead to evolution”.
from parents to progeny. It is the blue print of life.
or
Justify the statement.
DNA expresses itself through synthesis of proteins.
Proteins make structures in our body and also controls Ans : [Delhi 2017]
w
the functioning. In other words cells, tissues, organs Natural selection: Some variations are advantageous
and hence a living body expresses the traits inherited for an organism to adapt better in the prevailing
et
as genes/ DNA. Since we inherit the DNA, half from conditions of habitat. It makes it easy to obtain food
one and half from other parents, hence we somewhat and mating partner by them. In this manner they are
resemble them. At the same time we show mixed
N able to propagate more, transmitting their genes to
traits of both so can not be identical to either of them. next generation and producing more individuals with
similar genetic makeup and phenotype.
th
64. “It is a matter of chance whether a couple will have a. It leads to change in frequency of some genes in
a male or a female child.” Justify this statement by a population which give survival advantage to a
ou
depending upon the type of sperm fertilizing the ovum. each other.
d. Geographical barriers like mountains, rivers
yi
65. How do Mendel’s experiments show that the Acquired Trait Inherited Trait
a. traits may be dominant or recessive,
1 Experiences of an Genetically inherited
b. traits are inherited independently?
individual during its
Ans : [All India 2017] lifetime.
a. When Mendel cross pollinated pure tall pea plants
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 113
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
Acquired Trait Inherited Trait b. Mendel studied that genes segregate during the
formation of gametes (sperms in males and ova in
2. It cannot be passed on They can be passed on females) and they again combine in the offspring
from one generation to from one generation to (one from each parent) and appear as dominant or
the next. the next. recessive trait. This can be worked out by making
3. Example: power to lift Example: Eye colour a test cross.
weights and reading or height c. Mendel proposed three laws, namely:
French (i) Law of segregation: Each inherited trait is
defined by a pair of gene. Parental genes are
68. What is evolution? How does it occur? randomly separated to the germ-cells so that
Ans : [All India 2016] germ contain only one pair of gene.
(ii) Law of independent assortment: Genes of
Organic Evolution: Gradual unfolding of organisms
different traits are sorted separately from one
from pre-existing organisms through change is called
another so that the inheritance of one trait is
evolution.
not dependent on the inheritance of another.
a. Evolution occurs in the form of genetic drift and
(iii) Law of dominance: An organism with alternate
natural selection combined with geographical
forms of a gene will express the form that is
separation.
document.
b. Speciation - evolution of a new species from pre-
k
existing species-occurs. 71. a. What function is performed by human arms,
c. Fossils are impressions of the body/body parts or
or
forelimbs of dog and forelimbs of whales?
the remains of organisms living in the past, which b. Which type of organs are these?
got preserved in sediments of earth. c. Why do we call them so?
w
d. Study of not living species but also fossils helps in
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
working out evolutionary relationships.
et
e. Fossils provide one of the most acceptable a. Human arm : holding things Forelimbs of dog :
evidences in support of evolution, because we can running Forelimbs of whales : paddles
study the evolutionary past of individuals in the
N b. Homologous,
form of their fossils. c. Same origin, different functions.
th
69. “Two areas of study namely evolution and classification 72. If a population of red beetles, living on green bushes,
are interlinked”. Justify this statement. is being eaten by crows. During sexual reproduction,
ou
which came into existence earlier are likely to be colour. Green beetles increased, red decreased.
b. New trait will survive.
yi
This means that the classification of life forms will when crossed with the other having the same colour
be closely related to their evolution. On connecting produced 40 progenies, out of which 30 plants were
this idea of evolution to classification, it is seen with red coloured flowers, 10 plants were with white
@
that some groups of organisms with ancient body coloured flowers. Find out:
designs have not changed very much. However, other a. What is the possible genotype of parent plants?
groups of organisms have acquired their particular b. Which trait is dominant and recessive?
body designs relatively recently. Because there is a c. What is this cross called as and what is its
possibility that complexity in design will increase over phenotypic ratio?
evolutionary time, it may not be wrong to say that Ans : [CBSE 2016]
older organisms are simpler, while younger organisms
are more complex. a. Rr and Rr.
b. Red colour of flowers is the dominant trait while
70. Explain Mendel’s concept of heredity, by giving three white colour is the recessive trait.
points. c. Monohybrid cross, phenotypic ratio is 3 : 1.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
74. What is DNA copying? State its importance.
a. Mendel worked on pea plant {Pisum sativum) and Ans : [Delhi 2015]
discovered the fundamental laws of inheritance. He
found that traits (characteristics) are controlled A process where a DNA molecule produces two similar
by factors (which are now called genes) and each copies of itself in a reproducing cell.
factor (gene) come in pairs. These factors (genes) Importance -
are inherited as distinct units, one from each a. It makes possible the transmission of characters
parent. from parents to the next generation.
b. It causes variation in the population.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 114
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
75. “We cannot pass on to our progeny the experiences denoted by ww.
and qualifications earned during our lifetime”. Justify a. What is the expected colour of the flowers in their
the statement giving reason and examples. F1 progeny?
Ans : [Delhi 2015] b. What will be the percentage of plants bearing
white flower in F2 generation, when the flowers of
Acquiring knowledge / skill in one’s lifetime such as
F1 plants were selfed?
learning dance, music, physical fitness or any other
c. State the expected ratio of the genotypes BB and
suitable example.
Bw in the F2 progeny.
Reason:
a. Such characters / experiences acquired during Ans : [CBSE 2015]
one’s lifetime do not bring any change in the DNA a. F1 generation — blue.
of the reproducing c$ll/germ cell. b. 25%
b. Only germ cells are responsible for passing on the c. BB : Bw = 1 : 2.
characters from the parents to the progeny.
80. Give reasons for the following:
76. a. Insects, octopus and vertebrates all have eyes. a. Traits acquired during lifetime of an individual
Can we group eyes of these animals together to are not inherited.
establish a common evolutionary origin? Justify b. All the human beings belong to a single species.
your answer. c. Variations keep on accumulating during
k
b. “Birds have evolved from reptiles”. State evidence reproduction and do not disappear in next
to prove the statement. generation.
or
Ans : [Delhi 2015] Ans : [CBBE 2015]
a. No, the structure of the eye in each of the a. These are acquired traits that do not make any
w
organisms is different. change to the DNA of an organism.
b. Fossils of certain dinosaurs/reptiles show imprints b. Homo sapiens originated in Africa and spread
of feathers along with their bones but they
could not fly presumably using the feathers for
et across the globe in stages. The humans with
different colours in different regions have come
insulation.
N into being as an accident of evolution, so that
Later they developed / evolved and adapted they could live their lives the best they could. So
th
feathers for flight, thus becoming the ancestors of all belong to the same species.
present day birds. c. Inheritance from the previous generation provides
ou
(OR any other suitable evidence/example) both a common basic body design, and subtle
changes in it, for the next generation. So the
77. What are chromosomes ? Explain how in sexually changes keep on accumulating generations after
gY
k
Insects have them, so does an octopus, and Natural Selection: Nature selects the fittest individual
or
so do vertebrates. And the structure of the eye in in a population. Reproductive Isolation: When two
each of these organisms is different - enough for individuals are geographically isolated and natural
selection operates upon them differently leading to
w
them to have separate evolutionary origins.
inability of the individuals to interbreed.
84. Variation is useful for the useful over long time. But
et
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
the variants have unequal chances of survival. Explain
this statement. [All India 2014-15] For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
or
N
www.cbse.online for
Define variation in a species. How does it increases the 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
th
survival chances of a species? Bank
a. Identify the organism shown in the above figure. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
ou
85. (a) Identify the organism shown in the above figure. (b) Which type of origin and structure do these
organs have?
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a. These are organs which help in flying (wings of
insects and wings of birds).
b. The structure and components of these wings are
different. They look similar because they have a
common use for flying, but their origins are not
common, i.e., they are analogous.
(b) Name one incipient feature selected by the nature.
(c) Mention any other primitive feature of birds. 89. (a) “Each organism has its own identity”. Explain.
Ans : [All India 2014-15] (b) What is speciation?
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a. Planaria.
b. Eyes which were there only for detecting light. a. (i) The DNA of each organism is different from
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 116
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
k
of determining the age of fossils. inherited and the environmental conditions that
Ans : [All India 2013] each one of them living in.
or
Fossils are formed when dead organisms are not c. Awareness, logical thinking, scientific
completely decomposed. The organisms may get temperament.
w
trapped in resins of tree, lava of volcanoes or hot mud
95. A cross was carried out between a pure bred tall pea
which when hardens, retains the animal’s parts thus,
plant and a pure bred dwarf pea plant and F1 progeny
et
forming fossils.
was obtained. Later, the F1 progeny was selfed to
Two methods of determining the age of fossils:
obtain F2 progeny. Answer the following questions:
a. Relative method: By estimating the age of the
N
a. What is the phenotype of the F1 progeny and
layer of earth’s crust where the fossil is found.
why?
th
Fossils near the surface are recent and those in the
b. Give the phenotypic ratio of the F2 progeny.
deeper layers are more ancient.
c. Why is the F2 progeny different from the F1
b. Radio-carbon dating method: By detecting the
ou
progeny?”
ratios of different isotopes of carbon in the fossils.
Ans : [CBSE2013,14]
Fossils help in determining the connecting links
gY
between various groups and their origin from their a. Tall, because genes responsible for tallness are
primitive ones, e.g., Archaeoptyrx. dominant over dwarf trait.
b.
92. Explain the term homologous organ with an example.
n
The organs which have similar basic structure and c. Because in F2 generation, recessive genes got
mode of origin but perform different functions in expressed in homozygous condition.
Fl
ancestory and evolutionary relationship between b. How do analogous organs provide evidence in
apparently different species. favour of evolution?
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
93. How green beetles had colour advantage over red
beetles? Explain. a. Natural Selection, Genetic drift, Mutations,
Variations.
Ans : [All India 2013] b. The organs which are similar in function but are
Green beetle merge with green background of structurally different suggest that although these
vegetation which give survival advantage to a species two organs may look alike superficially giving
from elimination. an idea of common ancestory but the different
a. in the population of beetles, the new variation in structure and origin suggests that organisms
(green colour) get survival benefit / advantage to having these organs have a distant ancestor but
green beetles whereas other (red) perishes. such organs have developed during the course of
b. It is because of Natural selection — some variations evolution as an adaptation to similar mode of life.
are advantageous for an organism to adapt better
in the prevailing conditions of habitat. It makes it 97. a. Why traits such as intelligence and knowledge
easy to obtain food and mating partner by them. cannot be passed on to the next generation?
In this manner they are able to propagate more, b. How can we say that birds are closely related to
transmitting their genes to next generation and reptiles and have evolved from them?
producing more individuals with similar genetic Ans : [CBSE 2013]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 117
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
a. Traits such as intelligence and knowledge are observation regarding their ancestry?
not heritable traits, which do not bring upon Ans : [Delhi 2012]
any changes in the DNA of the germ cells and,
The organs which have similar basic structure and
therefore, cannot be passed on to the progeny.
mode of origin but perform different functions in
b. This can be said because traits such as feathers
different animals are called homologous organs, e.g.,
were first seen in reptiles like Dinosaurs, which
forelimbs of amphibians, reptiles, birds and mammals.
performed the function of providing insulation
Homologous organs give an evidence of common
to them in cold weather although they could not
ancestory and evolutionary relationship between
fly using the feathers but later birds adapted
apparently different species.
the feathers for flight. This means that birds are
very closely related to reptiles, as dinosaurs were Analogous organ are the organs in different
reptiles. organisms which have different basic structure but
have similarity in shape and function, e.g., wings of
98. (a) Differentiate between: bat and bird. These organs do not provide an evidence
1. Homologous organs and Analogous organs. in support with common ancestory.
2. Pollination and Fertilization
(b) What do fossils tell us about the process of
evolution? THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
k
a. (i) Organs in different organisms with same origin 102. A group of grasshoppers — some green and some
or
with different function/ different origin, same brown lived in a grassland having dry bushes and dry
function. grass.
w
(ii) Transfer of pollen from the stamen to the a. Which one would normally be picked up by
pistil of the flower/fusion of male and female predatory birds and why?
et
gametes. b. Population of which grasshopper will increase?
b. Help in establishing links and act as evidence of c. Name this phenomenon.
evolution.
N Ans : [Sample Paper 2010]
99. (a) Explain giving examples how artificial selection a. Green grass hopper, because they stand out,
th
has helped in the formation of newer varieties of against brown background of dry bushes.
cauliflower. b. Brown
ou
(b) List the steps involved in the formation of new c. Natural selection.
species.
103. (a) Explain why the wing of a bat and the wing of
(c) How different races of human beings belong to the
gY
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 118
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
also help in determining the connecting links If a sperm with “X’ fuses with the ovum, female
between various groups and their origin from child is born and if a sperm with ‘Y’ chromosome fuses
their primitive ones. with the ovum, male child is born as shown below in
the cross.
106. What are fossils? What do they tell about the process
of evolution?
Ans : [Outside Delhi 2008, CBSE 2008 C]
The fossils can be defined as remains or impressions
of the hard parts of the past individuals in the strata
of the earth. Fossils helps in working out evolutionary
relationships. Fossils provide one of the most
acceptable evidences in support of evolution, because
we can study the evolutionary past of individuals in
Hence, we find that the sex of the child is actually
the form of their fossils. By studying fossils occurring
determined by the type of sperm that fuses with ovum
in different strata of rocks, geologists are able to
at the time of fertilization.
reconstruct the time course of evolutionary events.
Age of fossils can also be found by time dating using In this manner we can justify that the sex of the
isotopes of carbon (carbon dating). children is determined by what they inherit from their
k
father and not their mother.
107. “Only variations that confer an advantage of an
or
individual organism will survive in a population”.
Comment. FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
w
Ans : [Delhi 2008 C]
According to Theory of Natural Selection, some 109. How do Mendel’s experiment show that traits are
et
variations are advantageous for an organism to inherited independently?
adapt better in the prevailing conditions of habitat. Ans : [All India 2016]
It makes it easy to obtain food and mating partner
N
Mendel carried out dihybrid crosses by crossing
by them. In this manner they are able to propagate
two pea plants differing in contrasting traits of two
th
more, transmitting their genes to next generation
characters. For example, he crossed a pea plant
and producing more individuals with similar genetic
having yellow colour and round seed characters with
makeup and phenotype.
ou
also get to 5 survive but only in a small population. If phenotypes as yellow round and green wrinkled
due to an accident most of the individual with other (parental) and yellow wrinkled and green round
variation get removed, the organisms with leftover (recombinant). This indicated that traits separated
variation get to propagate and survive under such
n
survive in a population.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 119
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
k
f. Much later, because of erosion and water flow,
some rocks wore out and exposed the horse-like
or
fossils.
w
111. Give five points to show the significance of variations.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
et
a. Variations help an organism to get adapted to the It was found that all plants were tall. This
changing environment. proves that tallness is the dominant trait while
b. Variations lead to evolution through natural
N dwarfness is the recessive trait.
selection and adaptation. 114. What are fossils? How are they formed? Describe in
th
c. During sudden change in the environment only brief two methods of determining the age of fossils.
those variants will make the population of that State any one role of fossils in the study of the process
ou
organism emerges as a strong species maintaining Fossils are preserved remains or impressions of pre-
its large population. historic organisms in the different strata of the earth’s
e. Variations make an organism to be resistance to crust.
diseases and environmental fluctuations. or
n
statement.
b. Differentiate between eye and eyespots. Which Fossils are formed when dead organisms are not
Fl
k
a mountain area covered with green bushes.
Speciation - formation of new species from pre-existing
Various sub-population in the large-population
or
ones.
exists in the neighbourhood. Individuals of
Factors - (1) Mutations (2) Natural selection (3)
a sub¬population reproduce sexually among
Genetic drift (4) Geographical Isolation
w
themselves and numerous variations accumulate
Geographical isolation cannot be a major factor in these sub-populations of red beetles.
et
in the speciation of a self pollinating plant species. There may be some reproduction among
Reason - physical barrier cannot be created in self these sub-populations. If a beetle from one sub-
pollinating plants.
N population strays into other’s area and some
individuals from one sub¬population may be
117. a.Why do we say that homozygous plants produce carried by predators to the area of other sub-
th
pure progeny? population, then random reproduction takes
b. Define heterozygous. place. It may lead to migration of genes from one
ou
b. Having different pair of genes. Also fill in the blanks 3 to 8 and then clarify about
c. (i) Natural selection. the misconception that mother and not father is
(ii) Geographical isolation, reproductive isolation. responsible for bearing daughters and not sons.
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 121
Chap 9 : Herededit and Evolution www.cbse.online
121. a.In which form the traits are transferred from F1 - RrYy
parent to the offspring? Ratio - 9 : 3 : 3 : 1
b. Mention the two processes that essentially J occur b. To study the independent inheritance of two traits
in sexual reproduction? in subsequent generation.
c. How the number of chromosomes is retained in a c. F1 progeny exhibited both the dominant traits.
species? F2 exhibited parental traits along with new
Ans : [Delhi 2013] mixtures/recombinants.
a. Chromosomes - thread like structures made up of 123. Woman are often blamed for bearing daughters. As a
DNA found in the nucleus. student with knowledge in science how will you explain
b. Formation of gametes that involves reducing it to your fellow students that the sex of the child is
the chromosome number to half and genetic not determined by mother’s genetic contribution?
recombination. Ans :
Fusion of gametes to maintain the chromosome
number characteristic of that species. Sex of the child is not determined by mother’s genetic
c. The original number of chromosomes becomes contribution. The sex is determined by a specific
half during gamete formation. Hence, when pair of 7 chromosomes called sex-chromosomes. In
the gametes combine, the original number of female, this pair consists of two similar (homologous)
chromosomes gets restored in the progeny, (or chromosomes denoted as XX. Hence, females produce
k
same thing explained in the form of a flow chart). only one type of gametes (Ova/eggs) each having an
‘X’ chromosome.
or
122. Given below is the experiment carried out by Mendel Whereas male human being has two different types
to study inheritance of two traits in garden-pea. of sex chromosomes i.e., X, Y (heterologous) having
w
different sizes and shapes. Hence male produces two
different kinds of gametes (sperms). Half of them have
et
“X’ chromosome and half have ‘Y’ chromosome.
If a sperm with ‘X’ fuses with the ovum, female
N
child is born and if a sperm with ‘Y’ chromosome fuses
with the ovum, male child is bom as shown below in
th
the cross. Therefore, the father’s genes is responsible
for the determination of the sex of the child.
ou
www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
n
4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 122
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
1. ONE MARK QUESTIONS convex mirror for seeing traffic at the rear?
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Advantage of Convex Mirror: It provide wider view of
1. Write down four important characteristics of image the rear traffic.
formed by a plane mirror. Disadvantage: It does not give the correct distance of
Ans : [CBSE 2014] the vehicle at the rear.
Image is virtual, erect, laterally inverted and of same
5. What are the units of power of a lens?
size as object.
k
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
or
2. Describe a spherical mirror. If the focal length is measured in metre then the unit
Ans : [CBSE 2014] of power of a lens is dioptre.
w
Spherical mirror is a part of a sphere. If reflection NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
takes place from inside, it is said to be concave mirror,
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
et
and if the reflection takes place from outside surface
it is a convex mirror. www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
N
Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
th
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
ou
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
3. Define the following terms in relation to concave 6. Give two uses of a convex lens.
n
spherical mirror:
Ans : [All India 2016]
yi
a. Pole
b. Centre of curvature Convex lens are used in (i) spectacles, (ii) telescopes,
c. Radius of curvature (iii) microscopes, (iv) camera.
Fl
d. Principal axis
e. Principal focus 7. Give one use of a concave lens.
@
f. Aperture Ans :
g. Focal length (each one mark) Concave lenses are used in (i) shaving mirror, (ii) flash
Ans : [CBSE2013, 2014, 2015] lights,
a. The mid point of mirror is known as pole. 8. What is a prism?
b. The centre of curvature of a spherical mirror is
Ans : [CBSE 2015,2016]
the centre of that sphere of which mirror is a part,
c. The distance between pole and centre of curvature A prism is an optical device with two triangular
is called radius of curvature of the mirror. bases along with three rectangular lateral surfaces
d. The straight line joining the pole and centre of commonly inclined at an angle of 60°.
curvature is called principal axis.
e. The point on the principal axis through which 9. Define the term reflection.
parallel rays to the principal axis passes or appear Ans : [CBSE 2016]
to pass after reflection. The bouncing back of a ray of light in the same
f. The diameter of the mirror or size of the mirror is medium after striking on a surface of an object.
called aperture.
g. The distance between focus and pole of a mirror 10. Define the terms:
is the focal length of the mirror. a. Angle of incidence
b. Angle of reflection
4. What are the advantages and disadvantages of using a c. Plane of incidence
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 123
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
the some vehicles. position of mirror from the object it is concave
or
Ans : [CBSE 2015] mirror.
Because the image of laterally inverted written letter c. If the image is smaller and erect for all positions
of mirror from the object, it is a convex mirror.
w
will once again laterally inverted in the rear view mirror
of the vehicle going ahead and image so produced will
21. (a) What happens to a ray of fight when it travels
be erect image of the word AMBULANCE.
et
from one medium to another having equal
13. What is the radius of curvature of a plane mirror? refractive indices?
N (b) State the cause of refraction of fight.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
The radius of curvature of a plane mirror is infinite.
th
(a) If a ray travels from one medium to another
14. How many images are formed by two parallel mirrors? medium of same refractive indices then it will not
ou
be infinite.
22. (a) What should be the position of the object, when a
15. Name a mirror that can give an erect and enlarged
concave mirror is to be used:
image of an object.
(i) as a shaving mirror, and
n
Ans : [CBSE 2011, 2012, 2013] (ii) in torches producing parallel beam of fight?
yi
Focal length f = R = 20 = 10 cm (a) (i) Face must be placed in between the pole and
2 2
focus of the mirror so that enlarged, erect
17. Light enters from air to glass having refractive index image of face can be formed.
1.50. What is the speed of light in glass? Speed of light (ii) At focus, because rays coming from the focus
in air is 3 # 108 m/s. after reflection will become parallel.
(b) It is a combination of convex mirror (small head)
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
and plane mirror (legs of normal size).
Speed of light in glass
8 23. Name the type of lens that can be used . as magnifying
v = c = 3 # 10 = 2 # 108 m/s
n 1.5 glass. Give reason(s) and draw a ray diagram to
support your answer.
18. The refractive index of diamond is 2.42. What is the Ans : [CBSE 2011]
meaning of this statement?
A convex lens of smaller focal length can be used as
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
magnifying glass. When an object is placed in between
The meaning of refractive index of diamond is 2.42 the pole and focus of the convex lens then enlarged,
is that speed of light in diamond is 1/2.42 times the erected and same side of object image is formed.
speed of light in air/vacuum D,
i.e. speed of light in diamond
8
v = c = 3 # 10 = 1.24 # 108 m/s
n 2.42
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 124
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
(iv) An image of same size. refracted rays actually refracted rays appear
or
Ans : [CBSE 2011] meet at a point, then to meet at a point
real image is formed. then virtual image is
Given, concave mirror of f= 15 cm. formed
w
a. When object is placed at a distance 10 cm from
mirror (between P and f) image is virtual, enlarged 28. What is meant by power of a lens? Give its SI unit.
et
and erected. When two or more lenses are placed in contact, what
b. For object in between 2F and 3 i.e. 40 cm image will their combined power?
is inverted, diminished and real.
N
c. For object in between F and C (20 cm), image is Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Power of a lens is the ability of the lens to converge or
th
inverted, enlarged and real beyond 2F(C).
d. For object at 2F (30 cm), the image is of same diverge a ray of light incident on it. It is the reciprocal
size. of the focal length of the lens, i.e. P = 1f . The SI unit
ou
spherical lenses, the image distance obtained is R, the angles of refraction are 45°, 35° and 15°
negative, state the significance of the negative respectively. In which medium will the velocity of
sign. light be minimum? Give reason.
n
medium to another is called refraction of light. minimum value of angle r i.e. medium R.
(b) In a lens if the image distance is negative then its
@
meaning is that image formed is at the same side 30. Define absolute refractive index. Absolute refractive
of object, virtual and erect. The lens is concave indices of medium A and medium B are na and nb
lens. respectively, what is the refractive index of medium
B with respect to medium A? How does the velocity
26. What is minimum number of rays required for locating of light vary with change in the optical density of the
the image formed by a concave mirror for an object? media?
Draw a ray diagram to show the formation of a virtual Ans : [CBSE 2012]
image by a concave mirror.
Absolute refractive index of a given medium, w.r.t.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
air/vacuum is known as absolute refractive index of
We require minimum two rays for locating the image the medium
formed by a concave Speed of light in vacuum or air
n =
Speed of light in medium
n = c as c > v
v
n >1
b n = Velocity of light in B = vb = na
a
Velocity of light in A va nb
Higher the optical density, lesser is the velocity of
light in the medium
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 125
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
31. As the velocity of light increases, the refractive index Ans : [CBSE 2014]
of the medium decreases. Light enters from air to water When a ray passes from optically rarer to denser
having refractive index 4/3. Find the speed of light in medium it bends towards the normal.
water. The speed of light in vacuum is 3 # 108 m/s.
na = 1.36 alcohol
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
k
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
or
Radius of curvature of a spherical mirror is the radius
of the sphere of which mirror is a part. It is the distance
w
between pole and centre of curvature of a mirror.
The radius of curvature is equal to the twice the focal
et
length
R = 2f
N
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
th
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
ou
Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
gY
4. NCERT Solutions 34. With the help of ray diagram show that angle of
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be incidence is equal to the angle of reflection when a ray
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly. is incident on the concave/convex mirror.
n
f = 1 m = 1 m =+ 10 m
P + 1.5 15
=+ 2 m
3
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 126
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2011] Magnification m of a mirror gives the relative extent to
or
which the size of image of an object is magnified w.r.t.
size of object. It is the ratio of size of image (h2 ) to size
of an object (h1 ).
w
Size of image
m = = h2 =- v
Size of object h1 u
et
42. Write the relation between object distance and image
N distance from a lens and focal length of a lens.
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
th
38. Differentiate between reflection and refraction of light. 1 =1-1
Ans : [CBSE 2012] f v u
ou
with a surface
yi
+i = +r (angle of +i ! +r (angle of
reflection) refraction)
Fl
interface..
of object
47. (a) For the same angle of incidence 45°, the angle of
refraction in two transparent media; I and II is
20° and 30° respectively. Out of I and II, which
medium is optically denser and why?
(b) Light enters from air to diamond which has
refractive index of 2.42. Calculate the speed
of light in diamond, if speed of light in air is
45. State the laws of refraction of light. Explain the term 3 # 108 ms-1 .
‘absolute refractive index of a medium’ and write Ans : [All India 2011]
an expression to relate it with the speed of light in
a. For the same angle of incidence. The refracted
vacuum.
ray in medium I deviates less than in medium II.
Ans : [CBSE 2018] Hence medium I is more denser than medium II.
Laws of refraction:
a. The incident ray, refracted ray and normal to the
point of incidence all lie in the same plane.
b. The ratio of sin of incident angle to sin of angle of
k
refraction for a given pair of medium is constant.
sin i = constant
or
sin r
Absolute refractive index of a medium is the ratio
w
of speed of light in air or vacuum to speed of light
in the medium.
et
Absolute refractive index
Speed of light in air/vacuum b. Refractive index of diamond = 2.42
= Speed of light in air = 3 # 108 m/s
Speedof light in medium
N
Speed of light in diamond = ?
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
th
Speed of light in air
n = =c
Speed of light in diamond v
ou
angle of emergence and lateral displacement of the ray. 48. A student focused the image of a candle flame on a
Give a formula to find refractive index of glass slab in white screen by placing the flame at various distances
terms of angle of incidence and angle of refraction. from a convex lens. He noted his observations:
n
When a ray passes from optical rarer to denser Distance of flame Distance of screen
medium, it bends towards the normal and vice versa. from the lens (cm) from the lens (cm)
Fl
60 20
40 24
@
30 30
24 40
15 70
a. From the above table, find the focal length of lens
without using lens formula.
b. Which set of observations is incorrect and why?
c. In which case the size of object and image will be
same? Give reason for your answer.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
a. In observation (iii) of the table given u = 30 cm, v =
30 cm, which is only possible when u = v = 2f(at C)
2f = 30 or f=15 cm
+i = angle of incidence
+r = angle of refraction 49. (a) Define power of a lens and write its SI unit.
(b) A convex lens forms a real and inverted image of
+e = angle of emergence a needle at a distance of 50 cm from it. Where is
d = lateral displacement. the needle placed in front of the lens, if image size
a n = sin i
is equal to the object size? Also, find the power of
g sin r
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 128
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
P =1
or
f
b. a n = 2.42
P =+ 100 D or P =+ 4D d
25
w
a
g n = 1.50
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
g
n =?
et
d
an
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at g n = ad n # ag n = da
gn
d
www.cbse.online for
N 2 . 42
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question gn
= = 1.61
d 1.50
Bank
th
52. A 4.5 cm needle is placed 12 cm away from a convex
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved). mirror of focal length 15 cm. Give the location of
ou
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education, Ans : [All India 2014]
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education Given: u =- 12 cm
f =+ 15 cm
n
h1 = 4.5 cm
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 129
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
on a screen 60 cm in front of a mirror by keeping the sphere of which mirror is a part is called radius
of curvature.
or
flame at a distance of 15 cm from its pole.
a. Write the type of mirror he should use.
b. Find the linear magnification of the image
w
produced.
c. What is the distance between the object and its
et
image?
d. Draw a ray diagram to show the image formation
in this case.
N
PC =radius of curvature ^Rh
Ans : [All India 2014] b. Focal length of a mirror is half of the radius of
th
curvature
Given: v =- 60 cm
f =R
ou
u =- 15 cm 2
a. Since the image is real the minor is concave
58. An object of height 5 cm is placed perpendicular to
- ^- 60h
m =- v = =- 4 the principal axis of a concave lens of focal length
gY
b.
u ^- 15h 10 cm. If the distance of the object from the optical
m =- 4 centre of the lens is 20 cm, determine the position,
c. Distance between object position and image nature and size of the image formed using the lens
n
position = 60 - 15 = 45 cm formula.
Ans : [All India 2015]
yi
u =- 20 cm, f = - 10 cm
v =?
@
1 =1-1
d. f v u
1 =1+1
v f u
1 = 1 + 1 =- 3
v - 10 - 20 20
v = - 20 cm =- 6.66 cm
3
Image formed is virtual, erect
m = hl = v
h u
hl = h # v = 5 # b- 20 # 1 l cm
u 3 - 20
= 5 # 1 cm = 5 cm = 1.66 cm
55. Discuss the position and nature of the image formed 3 3
by a concave mirror when the object is moved from
infinity towards the pole of the mirror. 59. If the image formed by a mirror for all positions of
Ans : [All India 2015] the object placed in front of it is always erect and
diminished, what type of mirror is it? Draw a ray
When an object is moved from 3 toward the pole of
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 130
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
diagram to justify your answer. Where and why do we if image formed is real. Express it in terms of
generally use this type of mirror? relation between v and u
Ans : [All India 2015] Ans : [All India 2016]
Only in convex mirror, for all positions of the object Given f =+ 10 cm, u = ?
placed in front of it is always virtual, erected and For virtual image
diminished. Hence this mirror is convex mirror.
m =+ 2
As m = v or v = 2
u u
v = 2u ...(1)
1-1 = 1 ...(2)
v u f
Substituting (1) in (2)
1 -1 = 1
2u u 10
- 1 = 1
2u 10
k
u = - 5 cm
or
For real image, f = 10 cm, m = - 2
v = - 2 , v = - 2u
w
Convex mirrors are used in automobiles as a rear view u
mirror because of wider field of view and formation of 1-1 = 1
et
erect image. v u f
1 -1 = 1
60. The nature, size and position of image of an object
N - 2u u 10
produced by a lens or mirror are as shown below.
Identify the lens/ mirror (X) used in each case and - 3 = 1 or u = - 15 cm
th
2u 10
draw the corresponding complete ray diagram, (size
of the object about half of the image). 62. One half of a convex lens is covered with a black paper.
ou
image.
b. Draw the fay diagram for same object at same
position in front of the same lens, but now
uncovered. Will there be any difference in the
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 131
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
‘absolute refractive index of a medium’ and write a. When the reflected rays after reflection actually
or
an expression to relate it with the speed of light in meet at a point then real image is formed.
vacuum. b. Concave mirror
w
Ans : [CBSE 2017] Plane mirror
Laws of refraction: Convex mirror
et
a. The incident ray, refracted ray and normal to the Concave mirror
point of incidence, all lie in the same plane. c. The rays coming from the sun are parallel to
principal axis and will concentrate at focus after
b. The ratio of sine of incident angle and sine of
N
angle of refraction for a given pair of medium is reflection.
th
constant.
sin i =Constant
sin r
ou
k
Ans : [All India 2011,2015] 70. (a) Define optical centre of a spherical lens.
or
a. When object is placed in between F and 2F(C) (b) You are given a convex lens of focal length 30 cm.
of a converging lens it will form a real magnified Where would you place an object to get a real,
inverted and highly enlarged image of the object?
w
image.
Draw a ray diagram showing the image formation,
(c) A concave lens has a focal length of 20 cm. At
et
what distance an object should be placed so that
it forms an image at 15 cm away from the lens?
N
Ans : [All India 2011]
a. Mid point of a lens through which a ray of light
th
passes undeviated.
b. At f =+ 30 cm, because when object is kept at fin
ou
b.
Fl
c. f = - 20 cm, v = - 15 cm, u = ?
c. When lens is cut along the principal axis its focal
@
Lens formula
length remains same but intensity is reduced.
1-1 = 1
69. (a) Define principal focus of a spherical mirror.
v u f
(b) For what position of the object does a concave 1 -1 = 1
mirror form a real, inverted and diminished image - 15 u - 20
of the object? Draw the ray diagram.
(c) An object 4 cm high is placed at a distance of 6 - 1 = -1 + 1 = -3 + 4 = 1
u 20 15 60 60
cm in front of a concave mirror of focal length 12
u = - 60 cm
cm. Find the position of the image formed.
Ans : [All India 2011] 71. (a) Under what condition, a concave mirror produces
a. The point on the principal axis at which the light a virtual and magnified image? Draw a labelled
rays parallel to principal axis after reflection from ray diagram to show the formation of image in
a concave mirror actually meet or appear to come the above case. Also, state the position of object
from in convex mirror on the principal axis is to produce magnified and real image.
called principal focus. (b) A ray of light moving along principal axis is falling
b. In case of a concave mirror, when the object is on a concave mirror. Draw the path of reflected
placed beyond 2F(C) then image formed is real, ray. Also, state the values of angle of incidence
inverted and diminished. and reflection in this case.
Ans : [All India 2011]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 133
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
a. A concave mirror will produce a virtual and a glass slab, it is observed that a ray of light
magnified image of the object if placed in between undergoing refraction emerges parallel to the
F and pole of the mirror. direction of incident ray. Why does it happen so?
Explain with the help of a diagram.
Ans : [All India 2011]
a. By holding concave mirror, focus the reflected
light incident on the mirror on a sheet of paper.
The distance between paper sheet and mirror
will give the approximate value of focal length of
concave mirror.
Real and magnified image will be formed if the b. Size of image reduces
object is placed in between 2F ^C h and F in front
of a concave mirror.
b. Ray of light moving along the principal axis will
retraces it path because incident angle +i =
reflected angle +r = 0 .
k
or
w
72. Which lens can be used as a magnifying glass? For
which position of object does a convex lens form:
a. a virtual and erect image?
b. a real and inverted image of same size as that of
et
N
object? Draw labelled ray diagrams to show the
formation of the required image in each of the
th
c. The opposite faces of rectangular glass slab AB
above two cases. and DC are parallel and extent of bending on
Ans : [All India 2011] opposite faces is equal and opposite+i = +e .
ou
A convex lens of shorter focal length is used as a Hence incident ray is parallel to emergent ray.
magnifying lens (glass).
74. (a) The refractive index of diamond is 2.42. What is
a. A virtual and erect image in a convex lens is
gY
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 134
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
c = 2.42 or v = c
v 2.42
iii.
b.
iv.
k
(ii) between focus and pole of a concave mirror.
Concave Convex mirror Plane
or
(iii) between centre of curvature and infinity for a
mirror mirror
concave mirror.
Virtual is magnified smaller in size same size (b) (i) Give mathematical formulae for determining
w
image as that of magnification produced by a spherical mirror.
object (ii) What does m = - 1 signify? Identify the
et
d. negative magnification produced by a mirror mirror that can produce it.
mean image is real. Ans : [All India 2012]
N
a.
75. (a) Write one use of concave mirror as well as convex
th
mirror.
(b) Draw ray diagrams for the following cases when a
ou
ray of light:
(i) passing through centre of curvature of a i.
concave mirror is incident on it.
gY
incident on it.
ii.
yi
in vehicles.
iii.
i.
b. m =- 1
m = v =- 1
u
v =- u
(i) Size of image = Size of object
(ii) Minus sign mean that the image is real and
inverted. A concave mirror can produce it
ii. when object is kept at 2F ^C h .
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 135
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
a. See the key points in the beginning of this chapter.
ii.
or
b. f = + 12 cm,
v =+ 48 cm
w
u =?
Lens formula
et
1-1 = 1
iii. v u f
N
1 - 1 = 1 or 1 = 1 - 1
48 u 12 u 48 12
th
or u = - 16 cm
ou
u = - 30 cm
v =?
yi
Lens formula, 1 - 1 = 1
v u f
Fl
v. 1- 1 = 1
v ^- 30h 20
@
78. (a) A converging lens forms a real and inverted image 1 = 1 - 1 & v = 60 cm
of an object at a distance of 100 cm from it. v 20 30
Where should an object be placed in front of the f = 20 cm
lens, so that the size of the image is twice the size
R = 40 cm,
of the object? Also, calculate the power of a lens.
(b) State laws of refraction. u = 30 cm
Object is placed in between F and C ^2F h image is
Ans : [All India 2014]
formed beyond 2F ^C h enlarged image.
(a) v =+ 100 cm
m =+ 2
m = v = 100 = 50 cm
2 2
f = 100 cm = 1 m
3 3
k
or
w
82. One half of a convex lens of focal length 10 cm is
et
covered with a black paper. Can such a lens produce
N
an image of a complete object placed at a distance of
th
30 cm from the lens? Draw a ray diagram to justify
your answer.
(i) Which of the three media A, B or C has
ou
brightness of image will be reduced more than unity or less than unity?
yi
v =- 20 cm
1+ 1 = 1
85. (a) Write relation between u, v f for lenses and for u - 3u - 30
mirrors, where u, v f are object distance, image 2 =- 1
distance and focal length respectively. 3u 30
(b) The magnification produced by a concave mirror
is m =+ 4 . Write the information about the image u = - 20 cm
given by this statement. i.e. if the object is placed at a distance of 20 cm
(c) Draw a ray diagram for the following and show in front of mirror then virtual, an erected image is
the formation of the images in case of concave produced by the concave mirror.
mirror when the object is placed:
87. A 5 cm tall object is placed perpendicular to the
(i) between the pole and focus point.
principal axis of a convex lens of focal length 20 cm.
(ii) at the centre of curvature.
The distance of the object from the lens is 30 cm.
Ans : [All India 2016] Find the
a. u, v and f reflection is given by lens formula a. position
1-1 = 1 b. nature
v u f c. size of the image formed.
1+1 = 1 Ans : [All India 2014]
k
Mirror formula,
v u f
Given, h = 5 cm
or
b. m =+ 4 of a concave mirror means virtual,
enlarged image is formed behind the mirror. u = - 30 cm
f =+ 20 cm
w
c.
v =?
et
a. Lens formula 1-1 = 1
v u f
i.
N 1- 1 = 1
v ^- 30h 20
th
1 = 1 - 1 = 3-2 = 1
v 20 30 60 60
ou
v = 60 cm
b. Nature of the image is real, inverted and magnified.
ii.
m = h2 = v
gY
c.
h1 u
h2 = 60
5 - 30
n
the image is three times the size of the object. 88. An object 4 cm high is placed at a distance of 27 cm in
Ans : [All India 2016] front of a convex lens of focal length 18 cm. Find the
Fl
u =?
a. For real image We have h1 = 4 cm
u =- 27 cm
m =- v =- 3
u
f =+ 18 cm
v = 3u v =?
Mirror formula, 1 =1+1 1 =1-1
f v u f v u
1 = 1 +1 1 =1+ 1
^- 30h 3u u 18 v 27
- 1 = 4 or u =- 40 cm 1 = 1 - 1
30 3u v 18 27
object must be 40 cm in front of mirror to get a real
inverted image by the concave mirror. v = + 54 cm
b. For virtual image m = h2 = v
h1 u
m = - v =+ 3
u h2 = 54
4 - 27
v =- 3u
h2 = - 8
From mirror formula 1 + 1 = 1 Size of image is 8 cm, - ve sign means image is real,
u v f
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 138
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
k
v 10 25 50 50
f = 36 cm = 7.2 cm
or
v = 50 cm = 16.7 cm 5
3
m = v = 18 =- 1.5
w
Size of image, m = h2 = v u - 12
h1 u
m = - 1.5 means the image is magnified
et
h2 = 16.7
5 - 25 92. (a) Two lenses have power of (i) + 2D (ii) - 4D .
N What is the nature and focal length of each lens?
h2 =- 16.7 =- 3.3 cm
5 (b) An object is kept at a distance of 100 cm for a lens
th
Image is real, smaller in size, inverted at a distance of of power - 4D . Calculate image distance.
16.7 cm from the lens. Ans : [All India 2012]
ou
f = - 25 cm, u = - 100 cm
90. An object is placed 15 cm from a convex mirror of Lens formula, 1-1 = 1
v u f
radius of curvature 60 cm. Find the position of image
and its magnification. 1- 1 = 1
v ^- 100h - 25
Ans : [All India 2016]
1 =- 1 - 1 = -5
Here, u =- 15 cm v 25 100 100
R =+ 60 cm v = - 20 cm
f = R =+ 30 cm 93. A 4.5 cm needle is placed 12 cm away from a convex
2
mirror of focal length 15 cm. Give the location of the
v =? image and its magnification.
m =? Ans : [All India 2016]
Mirror formula, 1 =1+1
f v u h1 = 4.5 cm, u =- 12 cm
1 =1- 1 f =+ 15 cm, v = ?
30 v 15 1+1 = 1
Mirror formula,
1 = 1 + 1 = 1+2 = 3 v u f
v 30 15 30 30
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 139
Chap 10 : Light Reflaction and Refraction www.cbse.online
1+ 1 = 1
v - 12 15 The position of screen must be 37.5 cm from the
mirror.
1 = 9
v 60 m = h2 =- v
h1 u
v = 60 = 6.7 cm
9 h2 = ^- 37.5h
4.0 ^- 25h
m = h2 = - v
h1 u
h2 = - 37.5 # 4 =- 6 cm
25
h2 = - 6.7
4.5 ^- 12h Image is enlarged, inverted, real and same side of
object.
h2 =+ 6.7 # 4.5
12
96. The power of a lens is 2.5 dioptre. What is the focal
=+ 2.5 cm length and the type of lens?
Size of image is +2.5, virtual, erect and smaller behind Ans : [Delhi 2015]
the mirror.
P = + 2.5 D
94. A convex mirror used on an automobile has 3 m
f = 1 = 100 cm
k
radius of curvature. If a bus is located at 5 m from P 2.5
this mirror, find the position, nature and size of the
or
image. f = 40 cm
Focal length is positive hence it is a convex lens.
Ans : [All India 2016]
w
97. A10 cm tall object is placed perpendicular to the
We have R =+ 3 m
principal axis of a convex lens of focal length 30 cm.
et
f = R = 1.5 m The distance of the object from the lens is 20 cm. Find
2
the (i) position, (ii) nature and (iii) size of the image
u =- 5 m
N formed.
Mirror formula, Ans : [All India 2014]
th
I +1 =1 We have h1 = 10 cm
v u f
ou
u =- 20 cm
I + 1 = 1
v ^- 5h 1.5 f = + 30 cm
I = 1 + 1 = 1 + .3 = 1.3 v =?
gY
v - 20 30
m = h2 = - v =- 1.15 = 0.23
^- 5h
yi
h1 u 1 = 1 - 1 = 2 - 3 = -1
i.e. image is virtual, erected and smaller in size behind v 30 20 60 60
the mirror.
Fl
v = - 60 cm
95. An object, 4.0 cm in size, is placed 25.0 cm in front m = h2 = v
h1 u
@
k
v u f
or
(a) u =- 10 cm 1- 1 = 1
Let a real image is formed in concave mirror i.e., v ^- 15h 10
m =- v =- 3
w
1 = 1 - 1 = 1
u v 10 15 30
et
v = 3u v = 30 cm
v = 3 # 10 cm = 30 cm = h2 = v
1 =1+1
N h1 u
Mirror formula,
f v u h2 = 30
th
1 = 1 + 1 2.0 - 15
f - 30 - 10 h2 = - 4 cm
ou
1 =- 1 - 1 = - 4
f 30 10 30 Image is real, inverted and four times enlarged.
f =- 30 =- 7.5 cm
gY
4 WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
(b) When u =- 6 cm from pole of a convex mirror. NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
For convex mirror, the image will be virtual,
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 141
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
1. ONE MARK QUESTIONS For a human eye, there is a near point, 25 cm. If the
distance of the object is lesser than this distance, eye
cannot see object clearly.
1. Name the essential parts of human eye,
11. When you enter from a bright sunshine into a dark
Ans : [CBSE 2016] room, you are not able to see clearly for sometime,
(a) Retina (6) Eye lens (c) Cornea (d) Pupil (e) Iris why?
Ans : [Delhi 2015]
2. Which liquid fills the space behind the cornea?
k
In bright light, pupil had become small.
Ans : [Delhi 2016]
or
Aqueous humour is filled in the space behind the 12. On what factor the colour of the scattered light
cornea. depends?
w
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
3. Which part of the eye controls the amount of light
entering the eye? The colour of the scattered light depends on the size
et
of scattered particles.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Pupil controls the amount of light entering the eye.
N
13. What is Presbyopia ?
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
4.
th
What is eye lens made of ?
Presbyopia is a kind of eye defect in old persons due
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
to ageing. It happens due to decrease in flexibility of
ou
Eye lens is made of transparent and flexible jelly like eye lens and weakening of ciliary muscles.
material.
14. What is twinkling of stars due to?
gY
5. How is the sense of vision carried from the eye to the Ans :
brain?
Twinkling of star is due to atmosphere refraction.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
15. Define dispersion of white light.
n
6. Which liquid fills the space between eye lens and The splitting of white light into its constituents seven
colours is called dispersion of light.
Fl
retina?
Ans : [All India 2015] 16. What kind of lens is used in the spectacles of a person
@
Pupil regulates and controls the amount of light depends. Why does the sky appear dark in space?
entering in the eyes. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
20. What is the range of vision for a normal human eye? Scattering of light depends on the presence of
Ans : [CBSE 2013] atmosphere which contains water droplets, molecules
of air, smoke and dust particles.
Range of vision is 25 cm to infinity.
In the space, there is no atmosphere to scatter
21. Name the two phenomena involved in the formation light.
of rainbow.
30. How can change of size of eyeball be one of the reason
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
for: (a) Myopic (b) Hypermetropic
The phenomena involved in formation of rainbow are
Compare the size of eyeball with that of a normal
dispersion and total internal reflection and refraction.
eye in each case. How does this change of size affect
22. Name the component of white light that deviates the the position of image in each case?
least and the most while passing through a prism. Ans : [All India 2016]
Ans : [CBSE 2012] (a) The eye suffering from myopia, has long eye ball
Red colour deviates the least and violet colour deviates than that of normal eye due to which the retina
the most. is at a larger distance from the eye lens. This
k
results in the formation of the image in front of
or
23. A person is advised to wear spectacles with concave the retina.
lenses. What type of defect of the vision is he suffering (b) The eye suffering from hypermetropia has short
from? eye ball than that of normal eye due to which the
w
Ans : [CBSE 2012] retina is smaller distance from the eye lens. This
results in the formation of the image behind the
et
Myopia. retina.
24. Name the part responsible for the power of
N
31. Sushil went to an eye specialist for check up. He
accommodation of the eye. prescribed him to use spectacle lens of + 0.5D power.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
th
a. Name the defect of vision he is suffering from.
Ciliary muscles help for the power accommodation of b. Find the focal length of spectacle lens.
the eye. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
ou
25. Name the condition resulting due to the eye lens a. Hypermetropia.
becoming cloudy. b. Power of spectacle P = + 0.5D
gY
26. Why sky appears dark to the passengers flying at high lens.
altitudes?
yi
27. A person suffering from an eye defect uses lenses of b. Ciliary muscles help in accommodation of power
power – 1D. Name the defect he is suffering from and of eye lens.
the nature of lens used.
33. A child sitting in a classroom is not able to read
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
clearly the writing on the blackboard.
He uses a concave lens (negative power) because he is a. Name the type of defect from which his eye is
suffering from myopia. suffering.
b. With the help of a ray diagram show how this
28. Which colour of white light suffers (i) least deviation
defect can be remedied.
and (ii) maximum deviation when a beam of white
Ans : [Delhi 2015]
light passes through a glass prism?
Ans : [CBSE 2011] a. Myopia
b. Myopia can be remedied by using concave lens.
Longer wavelength light (red) suffers least deviation
and shorter wavelength (violet) suffers maximum
deviation when white light is passed through a prism.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 143
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
k
merge and give a sensation of continuity. position of the star appear changes continuously stars
are very distant point-sized objects. As the path of
or
35. List four common defects of vision that can be rays of light coming from star is continuously changes.
corrected with the use of spectacles. So sometimes light enters into our eyes and some
w
Ans : [Delhi 2013] times it faints. This is twinkling of the star. Since
(i) Myopia (ii) Hypermetropia (iii) presbyopia (iv) planets are closer to us, their size is also big. Our
et
Astigmatism. eyes receive light from different points of the planets.
Hence planets do not twinkle.
36. (a) Explain how a normal human eye is able to see
N
41. List two causes leading to myopia of the eye. Draw
distinctly the object placed at a distance as well
ray diagrams to show the image formation in case of
th
as those placed at a nearer distance.
(b) What is the far point and near point of a normal defective eye and corrected eye.
human eye? Ans : [CBSE 2012]
ou
per requirement of the eye. This changes the focal b. Elongation of eye ball.
length of eye lens. When muscles are relaxed, lens
becomes thin and distant objects are seen clearly.
While seeing closer objects, muscles contract, this
n
people?
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
42. (a) What is the least distance of distinct vision for
Least distance of distinct vision is the minimum
distance between eye and object to see it clearly. the normal eye?
(b) Does the above distance increase or decrease for
In young, the least distance of distinct vision is long sighted eye? Give reason for your answer
lesser and for old people it is more. with diagram.
38. Define dispersion of white light and name the colours Ans : [CBSE 2012]
of white light in order. (a) For a normal human eye, the least distance of
Ans : [CBSE 2012] distinct vision is 25 cm.
(b) Least distance of distinct vision increases for long
When white light is passed through a prism, it splits
sighted eye. A hypermetropic eye can see upto
into its seven constituent colours. Splitting of white
infinite distance, which is more than 25 cm.
light into its constituent colours is called dispersion.
Seven constituent colours are – violet, indigo, blue,
green, yellow, orange and red. (VIBGYOR).
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 144
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2012] sky appear in the absence of earth’s atmosphere?
or
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
P =- 2.5D
The person using a lens of negative focal length Scattering of light \ l1 where l is the wavelength
4
w
of light, i.e. least wavelength will scatter more and
f = 1 = - 1 =- 0.4 m =- 40 cm vice versa. Blue colour light has shorter wavelength
P 2.5
et
Here negative focal length means he uses a concave and hence scattered more than other colours. In space,
lens. there is no atmosphere hence no scattering of light
happens in the space so space appears black.
N
44. Name the part of the eye where image is formed by
the eye lens. What is the nature of the image formed? 50. Why do we observe difference in colours of the sun
th
How is this image sent to the brain? during sunrise, sunset and noon?
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2011]
ou
those placed at a nearer distance. What is the far our head and all wavelength reaches to us due to little
point and near point of a normal human eye?
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 145
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2011] which point sized star sometimes appear brighter
or dimmer with changing position. Due to this,
or
(a) Least distance of distinct vision means the
minimum distance upto which an eye can see stars appears twinkling.
clearly. 57. (a) Write the function of each of the following parts
w
(b) To see distant object focal length of eye lens must of human eye:
be more so it becomes thinner when we want to (i) Cornea (ii) Iris
et
read a book eye lens is comparatively thicker. (iii) Crystalline lens (iv) Ciliary muscles
(b) Why does the sun appear reddish early in the
55. A 14 year old student is not able to see clearly the
N
questions written on the blackboard placed at a morning? Will this phenomenon be observed by
an astronaut on the Moon? Give reason to justify
th
distance of 5 m from him.
a. Name the defect of vision he is suffering from. your answer.
b. With the help of labelled ray diagrams show how Ans : [Delhi 2018, 2017]
ou
actually set. Thus the duration of day time interacts with particle of matter. When sunlight
increases by 4 minutes (2 minutes each time at strikes molecules in atmosphere, the light is
the time sunrise or sunset). redirected in many direction.
b. Scattering of blue colour is most due to shorter
wavelength, where as scattering of red colour is
least. All colours scattered in the sky and red
colour light reaches to earth, due to this sun
appears reddish.
59. Study the diagram and answer the questions the 62. With the help of scattering of light, explain the reason
follows : for the difference in colours of the Sun as it appears
Ans : during sunrise/sunset and noon.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
At the time of sunrise or sunset it appears red where
as at noon it appear white when it is overhead
because at sunrise or sunset blue colour and other
shorter wavelength light get scattered away while
passing through the atmosphere. Scattering of longer
k
a. Identify the defect of vision represented by this wavelength is least which reach to the earth. Due to
this sun appears red during morning and evening time.
or
diagram.
b. List the two possible causes of this defect. When sun is overhead at noon, sun rays travels
c. With the help of ray diagram explain how this smaller distance, due to little scattering of blue and
w
defect can be corrected. violet colour wavelength almost all wavelengths reach
Ans : [Delhi 2016] to earth and due to this sun appears white.
a. The defect of vision is hypermetropia.
b. (i) increase in focal length of eye lens
et
63. State the cause of dispersion, when white light enters
N a glass prism. Explain with a diagram.
(ii) shortening of eye ball.
Ans : [All India 2014]
c. Hypermetropia can be corrected by using convex
th
lens. When white light passes through a prism it splits into
its constituent colours, because each coloured light has
ou
65. State one function each of iris, pupil, and cornea. It can be corrected with the help of a convex lens
Ans : [CBSE 2014] as shown.
a. Iris: It controls the amount of light entering the
eye by changing the size of pupil.
b. Pupil: Pupil is a part of the eye through which
light enters in the eye.
c. Cornea: It is a thin membrane which covers the
eye ball. Light enters the eye through cornea 69. A person is unable to read a book clearly when kept
where it is refracted most. at a distance of 25 cm from his eye. Name the defect.
How can it be corrected? Draw ray diagrams for (i)
66. (a) Explain the phenomenon of scattering of light.
defective eye (ii) corrected eye and explain them.
State the factor on which colour of scattered light
depends. Ans : [CBSE 2013]
k
(b) List any two natural phenomenon based on The person cannot read a book at a distance of 25 cm
scattering of light. from his eyes. So he is suffering from long sightedness/
or
Ans : [CBSE 2014] hypermetropia. It can be corrected by using convex
lens of suitable focal length.
(a) Scattering of light is the phenomenon due to which
w
light gets deflected by the atoms or molecules
of different atmospheric gases and suspended
et
particles present in atmosphere. Scattering
depends upon size of the particles of the medium
through which light passes.
N
(b) Two natural phenomenon based on scattering
th
are (i) Reddish colour of sky during sunrise and
sunset, (ii) Blue colour of sky.
ou
concave lens.
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 148
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
(a) (i) P1 = - 6D as f1 = 1 =- 1 m
P1 6
f1 = - 100 cm =- 16.66 cm
6
(ii) P2 = + 2D as f2 = 1 =+ 1 m
P2 2
k
(b) B f2 = 50 cm
(b) (i) Due to continuous changes in the densities of
or
the atmospheric layers the apparent position
FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS of the star also changes; which make the
w
light coming from the distant point sized
star brighter and dimmer. The light coming
72. (a) A student is unable to see clearly the words
et
from the stars therefore gives a shaking
written on the black board placed at a distance of
appearances, which gives the impression of
approximately 3 m from him. Name the defect of
N twinkling of a star.
vision the boy is suffering from. State the possible
(ii) Since the planets are closer to us. Due to this
causes of this defect and explain the method of
th
they appear a combination of large point-sizes
correcting it.
source of light, and change in the path of light
(b) Why do stars twinkle? Explain.
coming from the planets is not significant. So
ou
atmosphere suffers refraction from the atmospheric (b) Draw diagram of an experimental arrangement for
layers. Since the densities of atmospheric gases observing scattering of light in colloidal solution.
Fl
changes frequently. Since the stars are point sized Name the two chemicals used in this activity.
and at a far distance so sometimes star appear Ans : [All India 2015]
@
brighter and sometimes dimmer which gives the a. In hypermetropia a person cannot see near by
impression as the stars twinkling. objects clearly. Its is due to shortening of the eye
ball or due to increase in focal length of eye lens.
73. Account for the following:
To correct hypermetropia, a convex lens of suitable
a. Part of the human eye that helps in changing the
focal length is needed.
focal length of the eye lens.
b.
b. The condition resulting due to the eye lens
becoming cloudy.
c. The factors on which colour of the scattered white
light depends.
d. The range of vision of a normal eye.
e. The sky appears dark to the astronauts in the
space.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
a. Ciliary muscles. 76. What is meant by scattering of light? Mention the
b. Cataract. factor on which it depends. Explain why the colour of
c. Size of the suspended particles in the medium the clear sky is blue? An Astronaut in space finds sky
through which white, light passes. to be dark. Explain reason for this observation.
d. 25 cm to infinity is the range of vision of normal Ans : [CBSE2015]
eye. (a) Scattering of light is the phenomenon due to
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 149
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
which light gets deflected by the atoms, molecules prism. Collect these coloured lights on a screen or
or particles of the medium when light falls on white sheet of paper. This prove that white light
them. These are known as scatterer particles. is made up of seven colours.
(b) Factors on which scattering depends are the size (b) Violet colour deviates most whereas red colour
of the atoms, molecules of the scatterer. deviates least because they have different speeds
(c) When sunlight falls on the atoms or molecules of in prism they have different refractive indices and
the gases shorter wavelengths J like of blue colour hence have different angle of deviation.
get scattered more due to which sky appears blue.
In space there is no atmosphere, so there is 80. (a) Explain why colour of clear sky appears blue
no scattering hence the sky appears dark/black. during the day with the help of diagram.
(b) Explain why Sun looks reddish at the time of
77. (a) How does refraction take place in the atmosphere? sunrise and sunset.
Why do stars twinkle but not the planets? Ans : [CBSE 2014]
(b) State any two effects of atmospheric refraction on
(a) Due to scattering of blue colours by the dust
the sun as observed from the earth.
particles present in the atmosphere.
Ans : [C8SE2015] (b) During the Sunrise or Sunset, Sun is at the
(a) Due to change in the density of atmospheric layers horizon, and sunlight travels a longer distance
when light travel through them gets refracted. It in the atmosphere. Due to this all colours get
k
is known as atmospheric refraction. Due to this scattered except red which reaches to the eye of
atmospheric refraction intensity of light, coming the observer to whom sun appears reddish in the
or
from a point sized star same times becomes more morning or evening.
and sometimes less, which gives the appearance of
w
twinkling of the star.
(b) (i) Sun can be seen two minute prior it rises and
et
two minute before it sets.
(ii) Twinkling of star.
N
78. Draw a neat labelled diagram of the structure of the
human eye and mention the functions of any four
th
parts.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] 81. A person cannot see the objects distinctly, when
ou
placed beyond 2 m.
a. Identify the eye defect.
b. Give two reasons for this defect.
gY
a. Myopia.
b. Elongation of eye ball or excessive curvature of
Fl
b. Eye Lens: It is a convex lens made of transparent He will be advised to used a concave lens of power
and flexible jelly like material. Its curvature is – 0.5 D.
adjusted by ciliary muscles. d.
c. Iris: It controls and regulates the light entering
the eye by changing the size of pupil.
d. Pupil: It is a hole in the middle of the iris through
which light enters the eye.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 150
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
k
to which a person can see near by objects
or
clearly but unable to see the distant objects.
Myopia is due to (i) excessive curvature of
w
cornea (ii) elongation of eye ball.
(ii) Astigmatism is a kind of human eye defect in
which he cannot see simultaneously horizontal
83. (a) What is dispersion of white light? What is the correction of these defects he is advised to
cause of such dispersion? Draw a diagram, to show use bifocal lenses whose upper half is concave
the dispersion of white light by a glass prism. and lower part is convex to see distant and
gY
(b) A glass prism is able to produce a spectrum when reading purposes respectively.
white light passes through it but a glass slab does (iv) Far sightedness, a person suffering from this
not produce any spectrum. Explain why it is so. defect can see distant objects but unable to
Ans : [CBSE 2009] see nearby objects clearly. The image of an
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 151
Chap 11 : Human Eye and The Colorful World www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
or
For myopic person
b. f =- 150 cm u = 3, v = - 150 cm
w
f =?
P = 1 = 100 =- 0.66 D
f - 150
From lens formula 1 = 1 - 1
et
f v u
86. A person with a defective eye-vision is unable to see
= 1 - 1 =- 1
the objects nearer than 1.5 m. He wants to read books
N - 150 3 150
at a distance of 30 cm. Find the nature, focal length
and power of the lens he needs in his spectacles. P = 100 =- 100 =- 0.66 D
th
f ^cmh 150
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
=- 0.66 D
ou
Defect is hypermetropia
v =- 1.5 m or - 150 cm, u =- 30 cm 90. A person needs a lens of power –0.5 dioptre for
1-1 = 1 correcting his distant vision he needs a lens of power
gY
P = - 0.5 D
f =+ 150 =+ 37.5 cm
4
Fl
f = 1 = 1 =- 2.0 m
A convex lens of focal length 37.5 cm is required P - 0.5
ii. For correcting his near vision
Power = 100 = 100 =+ 2.67 D
@
f ^cmh 37.5
f = 1 = 1 =+ 0.67 m
P + 1.5
87. The far point of a myopic person is 80 cm in front of WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
the eyes. What is the nature and power of the lens
required to enable him to see very distant objects NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
distinctly? For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
Ans : [CBSE 2016] www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Concave lens is used for myopic eye for point x = 80
Bank
cm.
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
For viewing fat distant object, focal length of lens.
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
f =- x =- 80 cm 4. NCERT Solutions
P = 100 = 100 D All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
f ^cmh - 80 provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
=- 1.25 D New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
88. Far point of a myopic person is 40 cm. What type of
lens, should he wear so as to see the distant objects
clearly? Calculate the focal length and the power of
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 152
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
Electricity
k
1 C charge is of = 1 electron
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
1.6 # 10-19
or
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
No. of electrons = 6.25 # 1018 www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
2. List any two factors on which resistance of a conductor Bank
depends. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
et
Ans : [CBSE 2016] 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
Resistance of a conductor:
N All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
a. is directly proportional to its length
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
th
R ?r ...(1) Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
b. is inversely proportional to its area of cross section. study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
ou
R ? 1 ...(2)
A
Combining (1) and (2), we get 8. In an electric circuit, state the relationship between
gY
to be 1 volt?
9. How does the resistivity of alloys compare with those
Ans : [Delhi 2016]
of pure metals from which they may have been formed?
@
Potential difference betweeen two point is said to be Ans : [All India 2014]
1 Volt if the amount of work done in bringing 1 C
charge between them is 1 J. The resistivity of pure metals is lesser than resistivity
of alloys with which these alloys are made.
5. State Ohm’s law.
10. Write SI unit of resistivity.
Ans : [Delhi 2016]
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
If the physical conditions of a conductor remain
same then current through a conductor is directly Ohm-m
proportional to the potential difference b/w the two
11. State a difference between the wire used in the element
ends of the conductor.
of an electric heater and in a fuse wire.
I ? V & V = IR Ans : [CBSE 2014]
6. Mention one reason why tungsten is used for making The wire used in element of electric heater has high
filament of electric lamp. resistance and high melting point where as a fuse wire
Ans : [CBSE 2015] has a low resistance and low melting point.
Tungsten is used for making filament because of its 12. Power of a lamp is 60 W. Find the energy in joules
high melting point and low resistivity. consumed by it in 1 s.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
7. (a) Name the instrument/device used to measure
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 153
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
Schematic diagram of electric circuit con¬taining
or
14. Why do we use copper and aluminium wire for cells, key and three resistances.
transmission of electric current?
w
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Copper and aluminium wires are used for electric
et
transmission due to their low resistivity. N
15. Give an example of a metal which is the best conductor
of heat.
th
Ans : [CBSE 2011 ]
Gold, Silver, Copper etc. metals are good conductor
ou
of heat.
22. Out of the two, a toaster of 1 kW and an electric
16. Define electric circuit. Distinguish between open and heater of 2 kW, which has a greater resistance?
gY
In closed circuit a current flows in the circuit when (2 KW) therefore resistance of toaster is more than
switch is on. resistances of heater.
Fl
17. What is the lowest resistance that can be obtained 23. Why is tungsten metal selected for making filaments
by combining four coils of resistances 4 W , 8 W , 12 W of incandescent lamps?
@
k
t 4
2 2
R1 = V W and R2 = V W
or
50 25 30. Calculate the number of electrons that would flow per
R1 = 25 = 1 second through the cross- section of a wire when 1 A
w
R2 50 2 current flows in it.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
R1 = 1 R2
et
or
2
Given: I = 1 A, t = 1 s
1
i.e. 50 W bulbs has resistance than 25 W bulb.
2
N Q
I = & Q = I#t
t
27. Define resistivity of a material.
th
Ans : [CBSE 2004] Q = 1A#1s (Q = 1 coulomb)
But Q = ne
ou
We have R =rl Q
A n = = 1C
e 1.6 # 10-19
Resistivity, r = RA
gY
Resistivity of a material is the resistance of a conductor The device which is used to measure potential
of this material whose volume is unity. difference is voltmeter. Voltmeter is connected in
Fl
I = 220 = 1 A
1100 5
28. A cylinder of a material is 10 cm long and has a cross- When heater is connected with the same source then
section of 2 cm2. If its resistance along the length be
20 ohm, what will be its resistivity in number and I = V = 220 = 2.2 A
R 100
units?
Ans : [CBSE 2004] 33. (a) What are the values of mA and mA ?
(b) Draw the symbols of battery and rheostat.
l = 10 cm, A = 2 cm2 Ans : [All India 2015]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 155
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2014] in a conductor, but their motion is random motion
or
in the absence of potential difference. Their average
The resistance of an ideal voltmeter is infinite. velocity is zero. Hence there is no current flowing in
conductor. But when a potential difference is applied
w
36. State the factors on which the heat produced in a
current carrying conductor depends. Give one practical across the ends of the conductor, it sets the electrons
application of this effect. to move in a direction. The motion of charge produces
et
an electric current in the conductor.
Ans : [Delhi 2014] N
We know that H = VIt or H = I2 Rt 40. Out of the two wires X and Y shown below. Which
Heat produced in a current carrying conductor one has greater resistance. Justify your answer.
th
H ? I2 (Square of the current in the circuit)
? R (Resistance of the conductor)
? t (Time for which current is passed in conductor)
ou
Voltmeter Ammeter
Area of cross-section = A
yi
1. It is used to It is used to
measure P.D. across measure electric RX = r l
A
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 156
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
the resistance and vice versa. So thick wire has lower ends of the conductor, charges (electrons) will move
resistance. in the conductor.
Potential difference is applied by a cell to maintain
43. Mention two special features of the material to be the charge to move.
used as element of an electric iron.
Ans : [CBSE 2014] 48. How would the reading of voltmeter (V) change, if it
is connected between B and C? Justify your answer.
A material to be used as element of an electric iron
must have (i) high melting point, (ii) high resistivity.
We have, P = 100 W
V = 250 Volt
2 2
P = V or R = V
R P Ans : [CBSE 2011]
^250h2
1W, 3W, 2W resistances are connected in series.
R = = 250 # 250 = 625 W
100 100
k
R = R1 + R2 + R3
or
45. Why do the wires connecting an electric heater to the = 1+3+2 = 6W
mains not glow while its heating element does?
I =V = 3 = 1A
R 6 2
w
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Connecting wire has low resistivity or good Current in each resistance is same, i.e. 1 A .
2
et
conductivity, i.e. resistance of these wires is negligible
Voltage across B & C = 1 # 3 = 3 Volt.
hence no heat is produced while heating element 2 2
is of an alloy whose resistivity is high, due to high
N
resistance heat is produced in the element. VBC = 3 Volt.
2
th
46. In the circuit diagram shown, the two resistance wires
A and B are of same area of cross-section and same
ou
50. Tungsten is used almost exclusively for filaments of a. Tungsten is used in making filament.
electric bulb. List two reasons. b. Its high resistivity and high melting point.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
54. How are ammeters and voltmeters connected in a
(1) high resistivity (2) high melting point and does circuit? What do they help us measure?
not oxidise at very high temperature. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
51. Three V-I graphs are drawn individually for two An ammeter which measure the current in a circuit
resistors and their series combination. Out of A, B, C is connected in series. Voltmeter is used to measure
which one represents the graph for series combination potential difference across a conductor so it is
of the other two. Give reason connected in parallel to it.
Sample A B C
Resistivity 1.6 # 10-5 Wm 5.2 # 10-5 Wm 100 # 10-4 Wm
Which of them is suitable for heating elements of
electrical appliances and why?
k
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
or
Ans : The resistivity of C sample is maximum so it is
More slope of V-I graph means more resistance, slope suitable for making heating element.
w
of C is maximum. Hence its resistance is maximum.
So it is for series combination of two resistors. 56. a. Give reason why tungsten is used for making
filament of electric lamps.
high temperature.
52. State the factors on which the resistance of a cylindrical
conductor depends. How will resistance of a conductor 57. B1, B2 and B3 are three identical bulbs connected as
change if it is stretched so that its length is doubled? shown in the figure. When all the three bulbs glow, a
n
Resistance of cylindrical conductor depends upon its when the bulb B1 gets fused?
length and cross- sectional area. b. What happens to the reading of A1 A2, A3 and A
Fl
When conductor is stretched its radius decreases but when the bulb B1 gets fused?
the volume of the conductor in both the cases will be
same. If length is stretched to twice.
@
l2 = 2l1
As l1 A1 = l2 A2
l1 A1 = 2l1 A2
A1 = 2
A2
Now, R1 = r l1
A1
and R2 = r l2 = r 2l1
A2 A2
Ans : [CBSE2010]
R2 = 2 A1 = 2 2 = 4
R1 #A
2
# a. The other two bulbs will glow even if B1 gets
fused. There is no change in glow of B2 and B3.
R2 = 4R1
Here V = 4.5 V
53. (a) What material is used in making the filament of and I = 3A
an electric bulb?
(b) Name the characteristics which make it suitable RP = V = 4.5
I 3
for this.
RP = 1.5 W
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
For parallel combination
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 158
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
1 = 1 + 1 + 1 Q
RP R1 R2 R3 I = or Q = I # t
t
1 = 1+1+1 Q = 0.2A # 1 hr = 0.2 # 60 # 60 A - s
1.5 R R R
= 720 C
1 = 3 & R = 4.5 W
1.5 R 61. An electric iron draws a current of 0.5 A when the
For B 2 , 4.5 = I # 4.5 voltage is 200 volt. Calculate the amount of electric
charge flowing through it in one hour.
1A = I
Ans : [CBSE 2004]
For B 3 , 4.5 = I # 4.5 1A = I
Current in Ammeter, ^Ah = 1A + 1A = 2A We have I = 0.5 A
V = 200 volt
t = 1 hr = 3600 s
Q = I # t = 0.5 # 3600 A - s = 1800 C
k
flowing through it in one hour.
Ans : [CBSE 2004]
or
Q = It
w
58. (a) Draw a circuit diagram to show how two resistors Given, I = 0.4 A
are connected in series.
V = 200 Volt
et
(b) In a circuit, if the two resistors of 5 ohm and 10
ohm are connected in series, how does the current t = 1 hr = 3600 s
passing through the two resistors compare?
N ` Q = 0.4 # 3600 C
Ans : [C8SE 2006) Q = 1440 C
th
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
ou
a.
63. Show how would you join three resistors, each of
gY
or
59. A bulb is rated at 5.0 V, 100 mA. Calculate its (a)
(a) Write Joule’s law of heating.
yi
Q =? ` Rs = 9 + 9 = 18 W
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 159
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
Rs and R3 are in parallel so, resistance of A is more and its length also.
1 = 1 + 1
Req. Rs R3
1 = 1 +1 = 1+2 = 3
Req. 18 9 18 18
and Req. = 6 W
k
?t
Electrical resistance is the property of a conductor by
or
H ? I2 Rt virtue of which it opposes the flow of current through
or H = I2 Rt it. It is equal to the ratio of the potential difference
w
b. Given two bulbs of 100 W–200 V and 60W–220 V. applied across its ends to the current flowing through
Current in 1st bulb: it.
I1 = P1 = 100 A = 5 = 0.45 A
V 220 11
et R =V
I
N a. When a low current is passed for a short duration,
Current in second bulb. through a conductor, heat produced is almost
th
negligible and hence no appreciable change in its
I2 = P2 = 60 A = 3 A = 0.27 A
V 220 11 resistance.
b. When heavy current is passed through the
ou
64. (a) List the factors on which the resistance of a conductor for 30 s. Conductor may be get heated
conductor in the shape of a wire depends. and its resistance and resistivity change.
(b) Why are metals good conductors of electricity
gY
whereas glass is a bad conductor of electricity? 67. Name and define the SI unit of current. Calculate the
Give reason. number of electrons that flow through a conductor in
(c) Why are alloys commonly used in electrical 1 second to constitute a current of 1 ampere. (Charge
n
q
ii. Resistance is inversely proportional to area of I =
t
cross-section. If q = 1 C, t = 1 s
@
then I = 1A
R ? l, R ? 1 If 1 C charge flows in 1 s in a conductor then magnitude
A
of current is said to be 1A.
R ? l or R = r l
A A q = ne
b. Metal are good conductor due to having large q
n = = I#t
number of free electrons and their low resistivity. e e
Glass is a bad conductor because it has no free
electrons and its resistivity is higher. = 1A # 1-s19 = 100 # 1018
1.6 # 10 16
c. Alloys are commonly used in electrical heating
devices due to their high resistivity and high = 6.25 # 1018
melting point which produces more heat.
68. Electric current flows through three lamps when
65. V-I graphs for two wires A and B are shown in the arranged in (a) a series (b) a parallel. If the filament
figure. If both the wires are made of the same material of one lamp breaks. Explain what happens to the
and are of equal thickness, which of the two is of more other two lamps in both the cases.
length? Give justification for your answer. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Ans : [CBSE 2016] a. In series combination if the filament of one lamp
We know for identical wire more length more resistance breaks then the circuit will be broken and hence
and vice versa slope of wire A is more than B. Hence other lamps stops glowing.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 160
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
work is done.
Ans : [All India 2015]
Given: V = 20 Volt
W = 40 J
W = P#t
= V#I#t
b. In parallel combination of lamps if the element of Q
= V# #t
one lamp breaks then other two will continue to t
glow. or W = V#Q
40 = 20 # Q
or Q = 2C
ne = Q
Q 2
n = =
e 1.6 # 10-19
k
= 1.25 # 1019
or
71. Name and define SI unit of resistance. Calculate the
resistance of a resistor if the current flowing through
it is 200 mA, when the applied potential difference is
w
69. Study the V-I graph for a resistor as shown in the 0.8 V.
figure and prepare a table showing the values of I (in Ans : [Delhi 2014]
amperes) corresponding to four different values of V
(in volts). Find the value of current for V = 10 volts.
et a. SI unit of resistance is ohm ^Wh
N
How can we determine the resistance of the resistor 1W = 1V
1A
from this graph?
th
b. The resistance of a conductor is said to be 1 ohm
if a current of one amp flows through it when a
potential differences of 1 volt is applied across it.
ou
c. R = V = 0.8 =4W
I 200 # 10-3
gY
resistance.
Ans : [CBSE2014]
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 161
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
I = V = 12 A & I = 2A
R 6 R2 = 7.5 W
When length becomes twice = 2 L
76. Find the equivalent resistance of the following circuit:
area of cross-section = A2
then L1 A1 = L2 A2
or LA1 = 2LA2
or A2 = 1
A1 2
R1 = r L
A1
R2 = r 2L & R2 = 2 # A1
A2 R1 A2 Ans :
R2 = 2 2 = 4
R1 #
In the given circuit 2 W, 2 W resistances are in parallel.
R2 = 4R1 Rp = 1 W
New resistance becomes four times.
k
74. A wire of length l and resistance R is stretched so
or
that the length is doubled and area of cross-section is
halved. How will its:
a. Resistance change?
w
b. Resistivity change?
Ans : [CBSE 2010, 2014]
a. Let initial length, area of cross-section and
resistance of wire are l , A and R respectively.
et 1W, 1W resistances also are in parallel.
N
When length is stretched two times, let its area Rl
p = 0.5 W
of cross-section becomes Al. Its initial volume of The circuit can be reduced as,
th
wire = final volume of the wire.
Al = Al2l
ou
or Al = 1 or Al = A
A 2 2
gY
^2l h
Rl = r = r 2l # 2
Al A
A
R = 3 + 3 + 1 + 0.5 = 7.5 W
yi
=4R
b. Resistivity does not change because it is property
77. A hot plate of an electric oven connected to a 220 V
of the material of a conductor.
Fl
R = r l = 10 W = 220 A = 10 A
A 22
b. Current in series combination
or l = 10
A r RS = 22 + 22 = 44 W
For new wire,
IS = 220 = 5 A
L2 = 3l 44
c. Current in parallel combination
A2 = 4A
1 = 1 + 1 = 2 W
R2 = r 3l = 3 r l RP 22 22 22
4A 4 A
& RP = 11 W
R2 = 3 R = 3 # 10 = 15 W
4 4 2
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 162
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
= `120 # 3 = `360
or
79. Two lamps, one is rated 100 W at 220 V, and the Given: l = 625 mm = 0.625 m
other 60 W at 220 V, are connected in parallel to a
R =4W
w
220 V supply. Find the current drawn from the supply
line. r = 4.8 # 10-7 Ohm-m
et
Ans : [CBSE 2014] A =?
Given: Lamp one 100 W, 220 V, Lamp 2 60 W, 220 V. R = r l or A = r l
Let their resistances are R1 and R2
N A R
2 A = 4.8 # 10-7 # 0.625
R =V
th
4
P
= 0.75 # 10-7 m2
R1 = 220 # 220 W = 484 W
ou
100
82. Derive the relation R = R1 + R2 + R3 when three
= 220 # 220 W = 2420 W resistors R1, R2 and R3 are connected in series in an
60 3
gY
electric circuit.
In circuit R1 and R2 are connected in parallel. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
1 = 1 + 3 Three resistors R1, R2 and R3 are connected in series.
R 484 2420
n
I = V = 220 # 2 A = 0.727 A
Fl
R 605
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 163
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
Heat produced by combination of resistors
= 1.62 # 10-8 Wm and 520 # 10-8 Wm respectively.
2
or
Out of these two, name the element that can be used Hl = V t
to make: 2R
a. filament of electric bulb. Hl = 1
w
b. wires for electrical transmission lines. Justify your H 2
answer in each case.
Hl = H
et
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 2
88. Study the following circuit and answer the following
Given: r A = 1.62 # 10-8 Wm
N
questions:
r B = 520 # 10-8 Wm
th
a. For filament of electric bulb resistivity must be
higher i.e. 520 # 10-8 Wm . So element B is used
ou
for filament.
b. For electric transmission resistivity must be lower
which is of element A.
gY
If the physical conditions of a conductor are kept same b. How much current would flow through: (1) 10 W
then current is directly proportional to the potential resistor and (2) 15 W resistor?
Fl
difference across the ends of the conductor V ? I . c. What would be the ammeter reading?
V = RI Ans : [CBSE 2010]
@
k
= 1 + 1 + .....n times potential difference for an electric circuit.
or
R Calculate the potential difference between the
1 =n two terminals of a battery, if 100 joules of work
or
is required to transfer 20 coulombs of charge from
w
RP R
one terminal of the battery to the other.
RP = R
et
n Ans : [CBSE 2009]
b. Given:
a. Potential difference b/w two points in an electric
R1 = 3 W
N field is said to be 1 volt if the amount of work
R2 = 4 W done in bringing a unit positive charge from one
th
R3 = 12 W point to another point is 1 J.
b. Given: W = 100 J , Q = 20 C , V = ?
1 = 1 + 1 + 1
ou
= 4+3+1 = 8 = 2 V = 5 Volt.
12 12 3
94. State the formula co-relating the electric current
R = 3 W = 1.5 W flowing in a conductor and the voltage applied across
n
2
it. Also, show this relationship by drawing a graph.
yi
91. (a) State Ohm’s law. Express it mathematically. What would be the resistance of a conductor, if
(b) Write symbols used in electric circuits to represent: the current flowing through it is 0.35 ampere when the
Fl
k
P1 25
R1 = 240 # 240 W
or
40
R1 = 25 or R1 = 5
w
R2 40 R2 8
R1 < R2 i.e., Resistance of 25 W bulb is more than 40
et
N W bulb.
96. Draw a labelled circuit diagram showing three resistors 98. a. What is meant by saying that the potential
R1, R2 and R3 connected in series with a battery difference between two points is 1 volt?
th
(E), a rheostat (Rh), a plug key (K) and an ammeter b. Why does the connecting cord of an electrical
(A) using standard circuit symbols. Use this circuit to heater not glow while the heating element does?
show that the same current flows through every part c. Electrical resistivity of some substance at 20°C
ou
of the circuit. List two precautions you would observe are given below:
while performing the experiment.
Silver 1.60 # 10-8 Wm
gY
conductor? Why?
ii. Which material would you advise to use in
electrical heating device? Why?
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Precaution: a. If the amount of work done in bringing a unit
a. Connect the ammeter in series with battery. positive charge from one point to another is 1 J in
b. All connection must be tight. an electric field then potential difference b/w the
c. Current must not be greater than the two points is said to be 1 volt.
range of ammeter.
1V = 1J
1C
97. (a) Derive the formula for the calculation of work b. Connected cord of an electrical heater does not
done when current flows through a resistor. glow because this is of copper metal, which has
(b) One electric bulb is rated 40 W and 240 V and low resistivity and good conductivity. Heating
other 25 W and 240 V. Which bulb has higher element glows due to its high resistivity or poor
resistance and how many times? conductivity.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] c. (i) The resistivity of silver is lesser than copper so
a. Let R is the resistance of the resistor in which I it is a good conductor.
current is passed for a time t by applying a p.d. ( (ii) The resistivity of nichrome is maximum in the
V ) across the resistor. given table so nichrome will be advised to use
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 166
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
in electrical heating device. of charge and work. Draw the circuit symbols for
(i) variable resistor, (ii) a plug key which is closed
99. (a) Name an instrument that measures electric one.
current in a circuit. Define unit of electric current. (b) Two electric circuits I and II are shown below “
(b) What are the following symbols mean in an
electric circuit?
(i) (ii)
(c) Draw a closed circuit diagram consisting of 0.5 m
long nichrome wire XY, an , ammeter, a voltmeter,
four cells of 1.5 V and a plug key.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
a. Ammeter. (i) Which of the two circuits has more resistance?
If IC charge flows in an electric circuit is 1 s then (ii) Through which circuit more current passes?
the current is said to be 1 A. (iii) In which circuit, the potential difference
b. (i) Rheostat (ii) Closed key across each resistor is equal?
(iv) If R1 > R2 > R3 in which circuit more heat
will be produced in R1 as compared to other
k
two resistors?
or
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
c.
a. Voltmeter
w
The amount of work done in bringing a unit
positive charge from one point to another in an
et
electric field is said to be potential difference
V =W
100. What is meant by resistance of a conductor? Name
N Q
and define its SI unit. List the factors on which
the resistance of a conductor depends. How is the
th
(i) Variable resistance
resistance of a wire affected if:
a. its length is doubled, (ii) Closed key.
ou
Property of any conductor by virtue of which it (ii) Lesser the resistance more the current in
opposes the flow of current in the conductor is called circuit i.e., in parallel (II) current is max.
its resistance. (iii) In parallel combination (II)
SI unit of resistance is Ohm. If by applying a potential (iv) More heat in (I) across R1.
n
Ans :
a. Potential difference b/w the two terminals of a
cell is produced due to chemical reaction in the
cell. This potential difference maintains a current
Since V ? I
in the circuit.
Hence graph between V and I is a straight line
b. (i) The resistance b/w XZY and XTY are in
for a conductor. Which passes through the origin
parallel combination. Their equivalent resistance.
O of the graph.
1 =1+1
Rxy 2 6
104. Draw a schematic diagram of an electric circuit (in the
“on” position) consisting of a battery of five cells of 2 Rxy = 3 = 1.5 W
2
V each, a 5 W resistor, a 8 W resistor, a 12 W resistor
k
and a plug key, all connected in series. An ammeter (ii) Net resistance of the circuit
or
is put in the circuit to measure the electric current R = 1.5 + 1.5 = 3.0 W
through the resistors and a voltmeter is connected so
as to measure the potential difference across the 12 Hence, I =V = 6
w
R 3
W resistor.
Calculate the reading shown by the: (a) ammeter (b) I = 2.0 A
et
voltmeter in the below electric circuit. (iii) P.D. across X, Y points
Ans : [CBSE 2014] V = IRxy = 2 # 1.5 = 3.0 V
N
Resistors of 5 W , 8 W , 12 W all the connected in series. I in 2 W resistor = 3.0 = 1.5 A
Hence, 2
th
RS = R1 + R2 + R3 I in 6 W resistor = 3.0 = 0.5 A
6
= ^5 + 8 + 12h W
ou
As V = IR
times its initial value. Calculate how it will affect
I = V = 10 A the heat produced in the resistor.
R 25
(c) Find the increase in the amount of heat generated
I = 0.4 A
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 168
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
circuit.
or
If the equivalent resistance is RS Calculate the resistance of 50 m length of wire of
then, V = IRS cross-sectional area 0.01 square mm and of resistivity
w
5 # 10-8 Wm .
But, V = V1 + V2 + V3
Ans : [CASE 20131
et
RS = R1 + R2 + R3
Resistance is the opposition offered in the path of flow
of current by the atoms or molecules of a conductor.
N
Factors affecting resistances:
a. length R ? l
th
b. area of cross-section R ? 1
A
c. nature of material.
b.
ou
6 10 15 30 As R = r l = 5 # 10-8 # 50
A 0.01 # 10-6
yi
= 10 R = 250 W
30
Fl
108. (a) Name and state the law that gives relationship
@
(i) (ii)
(b) How many 176 W resistors in parallel are required
Ans : [CBSE 2013] to carry 5 A on a 220 V line?
a. The law is Ohm’s law. (c) Define electric power, Derive relation between
If the physical conditions of a conductor is kept power, potential difference and resistance.
constant then current through it is directly Ans : [CBSE 2012]
proportional to the potential difference applied
across it. a. R = TV = 2 - 0 W
TI 0.1 - 0
V ? I or V = RI
b. Since V ? I so a graph b/w V and I is a straight R = 20 W
line.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 169
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
1 = 1 + 1 + 1
R R1 R2 R3
b. To prevent oxidising the filament due to high
temperature.
c. The current in the fuse wire must not exceed 5 A
otherwise it will melt.
k
n =4 (b) “Potential difference between points A and B in
a. The rate of electrical energy is consumed in a
or
an electric field is 1V”. Explain the statement.
circuit is called electric power
2
P = W = I Rt
w
t t
P = I2 R But I = V
R
et
2
P = V 2 R or P = V
2
N
R R Ans : [CBSE 2012]
th
a. (i) The resistance of two times long wire also
111. (a) Three resistors R1, R2 and R3 are connected in becomes two times so current decreases in the
parallel and the combination is connected to circuit.
ou
battery, ammeter, voltmeter and key. Draw (ii) If area of the nichrome wire is doubled then
suitable circuit diagram. Obtain an expression its resistance decreases and hence current
for the effective resistance of the combination of increases in the circuit.
gY
Similarly, I1 = V
R1
k
n = 1 # 1 -19 Electric Power: P is defined as the rate at which
1.6 # 10 electric energy is consumed in an electric circuit.
or
n = 6.25 # 1018 electrons 1 watt is the power consumed by an electric appliance
c. K–Plug key, (A)–Ammeter, (V)–Voltmeter, Rh– that carries 1A current when a potential difference of
w
Rheostat 1 volt is applied across it. Whereas 1 Wh. is the unit
of electric energy, which is consumed by an electric
et
appliance of 1 W power in one hour.
Commercial unit of electric energy is kWh.
N 1 kWh = 1000 W # 60 # 60 s
1 kWh = 3.6 # 106 J
th
Energy consumed by heater in one month
= 1000 W # 2h # 30 days = 60 kWh
ou
difference in a circuit. How is it connected? 118. (a) Why is the series arrangement not used for
(c) A current of 2 A passes through a circuit for domestic circuits?
1 minute. If potential difference between the (b) Why is the tungsten used almost exclusively for
terminals of the circuit is 3 V, what is the work
n
Ans : [CBSE 2012] such as bread toasters and electric irons made of
a. Electric potential is the amount of work done in an alloy rather than a pure metal?
Fl
bringing a unit positive charge from one point to (d) Why are copper and aluminium wires usually
another. employed for electricity transmission?
(e) Why does the cord of an electric heater not glow
@
119. (a) Name an instrument that measures electric 120. (a) (i) What is meant by saying that the potential
current in a circuit. Define the unit of electric difference between two points is 1 volt?
current. (ii) How much energy is given to 5 coulomb of
(b) What do the following symbols mean in circuit charge passing through a 12 V battery?
diagrams? (b) Describe an activity with necessary electric circuit
drawn to study the factors on which the resistance
(i) (ii) of a conducting wire depends.
(c) An electric circuit consisting of a 0.5 m long Ans : [CBSE 2008]
nichrome wire XY, an ammeter, a voltmeter, four a. (i) Potential difference b/w the two points is 1
cells of 1.5 V each and a plug key was set up. volt mean if we bring a unit positive charge (+
(i) Draw a diagram of this electric circuit to study 1C) from one point to other point then amount of
the relation between the potential difference work done is 1 J, W = VQ.
maintained between the points X and Y and (ii) Given: Q =5 C, V =12 V, W =12 # 5 = 60 J
the electric current flowing through XY. b. Activity to study the factors of affecting
(ii) Following graph was plotted between V and I resistance of the conductor—Take a cell, an
values: ammeter, manganin wires of different length and
different area of cross- section and key. Connect
an ammeter, a manganin wire of (say) 10 cm long
k
to a cell through a plug key.
or
(i). Now closed the key and note the current in
the circuit with the help of ammeter.
(ii). Now replace the manganin wire with another
w
manganin wire of twice the area of cross-
section and again measure the current in the
et
circuit with the help of ammeter.
(iii).Now repeat the activity by taking a copper
What would be the values of V/I ratios when the
N wire of same length same area of cross-section,
potential difference is 0.8 V, 1.2 V and 1.6 V and note down the current in each case. You
th
respectively? What conclusion do you draw from these will find that current in the circuit in each
values? case is different. Which shows that resistance
depends upon (1) nature of material (2)
ou
c. (i)
Fl
(i) (ii)
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 172
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
Calculate: R1 + R2 = 16 ...(2)
or
a. the current required. Solving eq. (1) and eq. (2)
b. the resistance of its heating element,
c. energy consumed by the iron in 2 hours. R 12 - 16R1 + 48 = 0
w
Ans : [CBSE2016] ^R1 - 4h^R1 - 12h = 0
R1 = 4 W, 12 W
et
Rating of iron is 750 W–200V.
P = 750 W , V = 200 Volt. R2 = 12 W or 4 W
N
a. P = VI or I = P 126. A current of 0.5 A is drawn by a filament of an electric
V bulb for 10 minutes. Find the amount of electric charge
th
I = 750 = 3.75 A that flows through the circuit.
200
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Resistance = V = 200 = 53.3 Volt.
ou
b.
I 3.75
Given: I = 0.5 A
c. Energy consumed in 2 hr = P # t
t = 10 # 60 s
gY
E = 750 # 2 Wh = 1500 Wh
Q
I = or Q = It
123. A piece of wire is redrawn, without change in volume so t
that its radius is halved. Compare the new resistance Q = 0.5 # 10 # 60 C
n
Ans : [CBSE2016]
127. (a) How much current will an electric bulb draw
Let l1 = l from a 220 V source, if the resistance of the bulb
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 173
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
k
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
t = 20cC
or
r = 0.15 mm Power of 1 tube = 40 W
r =? Power of 5 tubes = 5 # 40 W = 200 W
w
Energy consumed by 5 tubes in 5 hr. per day
As R =rl
A
et
2
= 200 # 5 = 1000 Wh
r = R # A = R # pr Energy consumed by electric press per day
l l
N = 500 W # 4 hr
^0.15 # 10-3h2
r = 26 # 22 # = 2000 Wh
7 1
th
Total energy consumed per day
r = 1.84 # 10-6 Wm
= ^1000 + 2000h Wh
ou
when it is doubled on itself, length becomes half and a. total resistance in arm CE,
yi
area becomes double (=2A) b. total current drawn from the battery, and
R1 = r l1 ...(1) c. current in each arm, i.e., AB and CE of the circuit.
A1
Fl
4 =rl
A
@
R2 = r l2 ...(2)
A2
l
R2 = r 2
2A
k
Cost of energy consumed in 30 days I = 1A
or
= `72 # 5 = `360
138. An electric heater rated 600 W operates 6 hours per
135. Two electric lamps of 100 W and 25 W respectively day. Find the cost to operate it for 30 days at Rs. 3.00
w
are joined in parallel to a supply of 200 V. Calculate per unit.
the total current flowing through the circuit. Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
et Given: P = 600 W
Bulbs 100 W 25 W
N t = 6 hr per day
V = 200 V 200 V
no. of days = 30
th
Total P = P1 + P2 Energy consumed by the heater
= 100 + 25 = 125 W = P#t
ou
I = 0.625 A
= 108 kWh
136. Two identical resistors, each of resistance 2 W are
Total cost @ ` 3/- = `108 # 3 = `324
connected in turn: (i) in series, and (ii) in parallel
n
to a battery of 12 V. Calculate the ratio of power 139. Three resistors of 5 W, 10 W, and 15 W are connected
consumed in the two cases.
yi
140. Find the equivalent resistance across the two ends A resistance of coils
and B of this circuit. = 30 + 30 = 60 W
I = 220 = 3.66 A
60
c. When two coils are connected in parallel then
total resistance
= 30 = 15 A
2
k
Ans :
or
a. When wire is cut in equal pieces then resistance
on one piece = R4
b. Effective resistance in parallel combination of
w
these four pieces of resistance R4 each.
1 = 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 = 16
et
Rp R R R R R
Rp = R
N
16
Now R12 and R34 are in series R14 = 1 + 1 = 2 W and
th
R56 and R78 are in series 143. A wire is 1.0 m long, 0.2 mm in diameter and has
a resistance of 10 W . Calculate the resistivity of its
R56 = 1 + 1 = 2 W
ou
material.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
gY
L = 1.0 m
D = 0.2 mm
r = D = 0.2 = 0.1 mm
2 2
n
r = 0.1 # 10-3 m
yi
R = r l or r = R # A
A r
2
r = 10 # pr
@
l
Now R14 and R58 are in parallel
Net equivalent resistance of the network 3.14 # ^0.1 # 10-3h2
10 =
1.0
= 1 + 1 = 1W
2 2 r = 3.14 # 10-7 Wm
141. A hot plate of an electric oven, connected to a 220 V 144. The rating of an electric heater is 1100 W, 220 V.
line. It has two resistance coils A and B each of the Calculate its resistance when it operates at 220 V.
30 W which may be used separately, in series or in Also, calculate the energy consumed in kWh in the
parallel. Find the value of the current required in each month of November, if the heater is used daily for four
of the three cases. hours at the rated voltage.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] Ans : [CBSE 2010]
V = 220 Volt P = 1100 W
RA = RB = 30 W V = 220 V
a. When both are used separately. 2
Then current drawn by each R = V = 220 # 220 W = 484 W = 44 W
P 1100 11
I = V = 220 = 7.3 A Total energy consumed in the month of Nov. (i.e. 30
R 30 days) @ 4 hr per day.
b. When two coils are connected in series then total
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 176
Chap 12 : Electricity www.cbse.online
E = P#t I1 = I2 = 1.5 A
= 1100 # 4 # hr # 30 147. Find out the following in the electric circuit given in
= 1100 # 120 Wh figure:
E = 132 kWh a. Effective resistance of two 8 W resistors in the
combination.
145. (a) For the circuit shown in the diagram, calculate: b. Current flowing through 4 W resistor.
(i) value of current through the 30 W resistor. c. Potential difference across 4 W resistor.
(ii) total resistance of the circuit. d. Power dissipated in 4 W resistor.
(b) Give two advantages of connecting electrical e. Difference in ammeter readings, if any.
devices in parallel with battery.
k
Ans : [CBSE 2010] Ans :
or
a. Potential across each resistor = 6 V. a. 8 W and 8 W resistors are in parallel
(i) I in 30 W resistor, Rp = 8 # 8 = 4 W
w
8+8
=V = 6 = 1 A
R 30 5
= 0.2 A
(ii) All in parallel,
et
N
1 = 1 + 1 +1 = 1+3+6
Rp 30 10 5 30
th
= 10
30
ou
P =4W
e. Both the ammeters are in series in the circuit so
current will be same in both ammeters. Hence no
@
k
= 2.5 # 4 # 60 # 60 provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
or
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
= 10 # 3600 W.s. New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
= 3.6 # 10 4 J
w
151. If a 12 V battery is connected to the arrangement of
et
resistances given below, calculate:
a. the total effective resistance of the arrangement
and
N
b. the total current flowing in the circuit.
th
ou
gY
Rs1 = 10 + 20 = 30 W
5 W and 25 W are in series
Fl
Rs2 = 5 + 25 = 30 W
30 W and 30 W are in parallel.
@
1 = 1 + 1 = 2
Rp 30 30 30
R p = 15 W
(ii) I = V = 12 = 0.8 A
RP 15
V = 200 V
P = 100 W
2
(a) P =V
R
^200h2
R = W = 40000 = 400 W
100 100
(b) Energy consumed in 4 hrs. by one bulb.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 178
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
circular rings around a conductor.
or
5. Mention the special feature regarding shape of
w
magnetic field lines.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
3. State the direction of the magnetic field inside the bar 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
magnet. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 179
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
In our house we get AC of voltage 220 V and frequency 18. What constitutes the field of a magnet?
50 Hz. Ans : [CBSE 2006]
k
11. Name the type of current: (a) used in household The magnetic field is created by the magnet or when
or
supply (b) given by a cell. a charge particle is moving with some velocity in both
Ans : [CBSE 2014] cases they produce a magnetic field around them. The
w
magnetic field is due to current or magnetic material.
a. We use alternating current in our houses which
changes to direction and magnitude with time. 19. What is the advantage of the third wire of earth
et
b. A cell supply direct current (DC) or unidirectional connection in domestic appliances?
current which flows only in one direction only. Ans : [CBSE 2006]
N
12. State the rule which you use to find the direction of In case of any electric fault in domestic appliances,
current may comes in appliance body. The third wire
th
induced current or state Fleming’s right hand rule.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] called earth wire transfer this current to the earth and
user remains safe from any such electric shock.
ou
and middle finger perpendicular to each other in distance from the wire decreases?
such a way that thumb points the direction of force Ans : [CBSE 2006]
on a conductor and forefinger points the direction
If we bring a magnetic compass from a distance to
of magnetic field then middle finger will point the
n
13. How can it be shown that a magnetic field exists away from the current carrying wire its deflection goes
around a wire through which a direct current is on decreasing which shows that magnetic field near
Fl
When we put a small magnetic compass near a current 21. When is the force experienced by a current carrying
carrying conductor it gets deflected, which shows that conductor placed in a magnetic field the maximum?
a magnetic field is produced near a current carrying Ans : [CBSE 2009]
conductor.
A current carrying conductor experience maximum
14. How is the strength of the magnetic field at a point force in a magnetic field when the direction of current
near a wire related to the strength of the electric is perpendicular to the magnetic field.
current flowing in the wire?
22. How is the induced current in a secondary coil related
Ans : [CBSE 2009] to current in a primary coil?
The magnetic field strength at a point near a wire is Ans : [CBSE 2009]
directly proportional to the current strength in the
Induced current in a secondary coil may be more or
conductor.
lesser than the current in primary coil depending upon
15. An alternating electric current has a frequency of 50 the number of turns in secondary.
Hz. How many times does it change its direction in
23. What is the pattern of field fines inside a solenoid?
one second?
What do they indicate?
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
50 Hz ac changes its direction 100 times in 1 sec.
The magnetic field inside a solenoid is uniform in the
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 180
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
form of parallel lines. A coil of many circular turns of insulated wire wrapped
closely in the form of a cylinder is called a solenoid.
24. How is the magnetic field produced in a solenoid used? In a current carrying solenoid magnetic field is same
Ans : [CBSE 2010] at all points inside it, i.e. field is uniform inside the
Magnetic field produced in a solenoid can be used in solenoid. The magnetic field inside a coil vary.
making a soft iron piece electromagnet.
33. An alpha particle (+ve charged particle) enters a
25. What does the direction of thumb indicate in the magnetic field at right angle to it as shown in figure.
right-hand thumb rule? Explain with the help of a relevant rule, the direction
of force acting on the alpha particle.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Thumb points the direction of current in the conductor
holding a straight conductor in right hand.
k
If the angle between a current carrying conductor and per Fleming’s left hand rule.
or
magnetic field is 90° then the force experienced by the
conductor is maximum. 34. An alternating electric current has a frequency of 50
Hz. How many times does it change its direction in
w
27. Suggest one way of discriminating a wire carrying one second? Give reason for your answer.
current from a wire carrying no current. Ans : [CBSE 2016]
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
When a magnetic compass is brought near a current
et 100 times in one second because one complete cycle
involves two times change of direction.
N
carrying conductor it will be deflected. If magnetic
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
compass remains undeflected near a conductor then
th
there is no current in it. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
ou
28. What does the thumb indicated in Fleming’s right 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
hand rule? Bank
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
gY
Thumb indicate the direction of force on conductor 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
i.e. motion of the conductor. 4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
n
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
By convention the magnetic field lines are the path For School Education
and goes to the south pole and inside the magnet the
35. (a) Name the type of electric current generated by
direction of field lines are from south pole to north
the most of the power stations in our country.
@
37. Draw the patterns of magnetic field fines due to a bar b. Magnetic field lines in a solenoid.
magnet. The magnetic field fines are closed curves.
Why? 40. A compass needle is placed near a current carrying
wire. State your observation for the following cases
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
and give reason for the same in each case:
Magnetic field lines emerge out from the N-pole of a a. Magnitude of electric current in the wire is
bar magnet go to the S-pole and inside the magnet increased.
field lines goes from S-pole to N-pole thus form the b. The compass needle is displaced away from the
closed curves. wire.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a. Compass needle is deflected more because more
the current, more the magnetic field near the wire.
b. Magnetic field strength is inversely proportional
to the distance from current carrying wire. So
deflection will decrease in the compass needle
when brought away from wire.
k
of magnetic field at a point determined? Mention few
important properties of magnetic field lines.
or
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
38. (a) In a pattern of magnetic field fines due to a bar Magnetic field lines are the path traced by north pole
w
magnet, how can the regions of relative strength in a magnetic field. A tangent drawn to the magnetic
be identified? field lines gives the direction of magnetic field at that
et
(b) Compare the strength of field near the poles and point.
middle of a bar magnet. a. Magnetic field lines emerge out from the N-pole
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
N and go to the south pole and from S-pole to N-pole
(a) More the density of the magnetic field lines i.e. inside the magnet forming the closed curve.
th
more closer the magnetic field lines more the b. They do not intersect each other.
strength of magnetic field. 42. What is the nature of magnetic field produced by a
ou
(b) Near the poles magnetic field lines are closer than straight current carrying circular coil? Explain with
the middle of a bar magnet. So magnetic strength the help of an experiment.
is more near poles than middle part of bar magnet.
Ans : [Delhi 2015]
gY
39. Identify the type of magnetic fields represented by the Bend a wire in the shape of a circular loop. Pass the
magnetic field fines given below and name the type coil through a cardboard. Connect the free ends of
conductors which can produce them. the coil to a battery and a key. Sprinkle some iron
n
a. Magnetic field lines of a current carrying circular 44. What is meant by the term “magnetic field lines”?
loop.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 182
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
permitted value of the current, overloading also leads
Now bring N pole of a strong magnet towards
or
the heating of wires which may damage the insulation
the coil. There is a momentary deflection in the
of wires.
galvanometer. Now bring the N pole away from
w
the coil, again there is a deflection in the opposite NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
direction in the galvanometer deflection in the
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
et
galvanometer shows that a current is induced in the
www.cbse.online for
coil. The induced current can be produced by keeping
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
magnet stationary and giving movement to the coil,
N Bank
or when both have a relative motion w.r.t. each other.
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
th
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
ou
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 183
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
almost in straight lines. Right hand thumb rule gives Ans : [CBSE 2004]
the direction of magnetic field i.e. if we hold a current The pattern of magnetic lines of force is in the form
carrying conductor in our right hand in such way that of concentric circles around the current carrying wire.
thumb points the direction of current, then the curls
of the fingers encircling the conductor will give the
direction of magnetic field around the conductor.
k
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
or
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
w
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank
et
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
N a. with the increase in current, magnetic field around
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be the conductor also
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
th
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
ou
coil?
b. near the current carrying conductor magnetic field
Ans : [CBSE 2004]
yi
circular coil is
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
a. inversely proportional to the radius ‘a’ of the coil
B \ a1 For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 184
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
a. Strength of magnetic field is doubled when the
or
current through the loop is doubled B \ I .
b. Strength of magnetic field is doubled when the 56. What are permanent magnet and electromagnet?
w
radius of the loop is halved B \ r1 . Give two uses of each.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
53. Draw the pattern of field lines due to a solenoid
et
Permanent Magnet: It has constant magnetic field
carrying electric current. Mark the north and south
around it. e.g. generator, loud speaker.
poles in the diagram.
N Electromagnet: When a soft iron is placed in a solenoid
Ans : [CBSE 2004] it gets magnetised till there is current in solenoid, e.g.
th
The pattern of the magnetic field lines is as shown in electric bells, cranes.
figure.
57. Explain briefly different methods of producing induced
ou
emf.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
gY
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 185
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
conductor increases, the deflection in the galvanometer Which of the two observations is correct and why?
also increases. Ans : [CBSE 2011]
60. No two magnetic field lines can intersect each other. First observation is correct because when current
Explain. increases force also increase. From equation of force on
Ans : [CBSE2010] a current carrying conductor F = BIl. F \ I i.e. more
current more force on a current carrying conductor in
If two magnetic field lines intersect each other then a magnetic field.
at the point of intersection there will be two different
tangents pointing two different directions of magnetic 65. An electron enters a uniform magnetic field at right
field at a point which is not possible. angles to it as shown in the figure below. In which
direction will this electron move? State the rule
61. What is meant by the term magnetic field lines? List applied by you in finding the direction of motion of
any two properties of magnetic field lines. the electron.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
The imaginary path traced by N-pole of a magnet in a
magnetic field is called magnetic field lines.
Properties:
a. Two magnetic field lines never intersect each
k
other.
or
b. Magnetic field lines are crowded near the poles
and near the mid part of magnets the density of
magnetic lines of force decreases.
w
62. Why does a current carrying Conductor experiences Ans : [CBSE 2011]
et
a force when it is placed in a magnetic field? State
As per Fleming’s left hand rule the electron
Fleming’s left hand rule.
will experience a force upward. So it will move
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
N perpendicularly outward.
When a current carrying conductor is placed in
th
a magnetic field it experiences a force due to
interaction between the two magnetic fields due to
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 186
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
More magnetic field more deflection in the compass. a. \ r1 , i.e. magnetic field decreases with increase in
radius.
68. Draw magnetic field lines produced around a b. \ n , i.e. magnetic field increases with increase in
current carrying straight conductor passing through number of turns.
cardboard. How will the strength of the magnetic field
change, when the point where magnetic field is to be 71. Name and state the rule to determine the direction
determined, is moved away from the straight wire of a force experienced by a current carrying straight
carrying constant current? Justify your answer. conductor placed in a magnetic field which is
Ans : [CBSE 2012] perpendicular to it. Name a device that uses current
carrying conductor and magnetic field.
The strength of the magnetic field decreases when
the point where magnetic field is to be determined is Ans : [CBSE 2012]
moved away from the wire. Fleming’s left hand rule gives the direction of force
experienced by a current carrying straight conductor
placed in a magnetic field which is perpendicular to
it. According to Fleming’s left hand rule if we stretch
our left hand thumb, forefinger and middle finger
in such a way that forefinger points the direction of
magnetic field, middle finger points the direction of
k
current then thumb will give the direction of force on
the conductor.
or
w
et
69. Magnetic field lines are shown in the given diagram.
N
A student makes a statement that magnetic field
th
at X is stronger than at Y. Justify this statement.
Also, redraw the diagram and mark the direction of
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 187
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
carrying coil placed in a magnetic field experience 75. Define magnetic field. Describe an activity to draw
a torque. If the coil is free to move it will rotate in magnetic field lines around a bar magnet from one
the magnetic field. pole to another pole.
(c) (i) Armature: The soft iron core on which the coil Ans : [CBSE 2016]
is wound along with coils is called armature which
Magnetic field is the space around a magnet or a
enhances the power of motor.
current carrying conductor in which its magnetic force
(ii) Brushes: Brushes help in transfer of current
can be experience.
between coil and external circuit.
(iii) Split rings reverses the direction of current Fix a plane white drawing sheet on a drawing
after every half rotation of the coil so that the board. Now take a bar magnet and a compass. Place
direction of torque/force on the coil remains the magnet at the middle of the paper and mark its
and it continuous to rotate. boundary with the help of a pencil. Now place the
compass near its N pole of the magnet and marks
73. For the circular coil carrying current shown alongside, the positions of needle of the compass. Now move the
draw magnetic field lines. Decide which of its face compass on the drawing board. Coinciding south pole
behaves as North Pole and which face as South Pole. of the compass with the previous marked point of N
Give reason to justify your answer. pole of the needle and so on, move forward from one
end
(N pole) to the another end (S pole) of the bar magnet.
k
Join all the marked points. You will get magnetic lines
or
of force.
w
et
N
th
ou
V.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
@
I = Total Power = nP
V V
= 2 # 1.1 kW
220 V
= 2 # 1.1 # 1000 W = 10 A
220 V
74. A uniform magnetic field is directed vertically So a fuse wire of rating must be greater than 10 A.
upwards. In which direction in this field should an
a-particle (which are positively charged particles) be 77. Can a freely suspended current carrying solenoid
projected so that it is deflected south ward? Name stay in any direction? Justify your answer. What will
and state the rule you have used to find the direction happen when the direction of current in the solenoid
in this case. is reversed? Explain.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Forefinger - direction of magnetic field (upwards). No, current carrying solenoid behaves like a bar
Thumb - direction of force (southwards) Middle finger magnet and will stay only geographical N and S
gives direction of current or direction of positively direction. If the direction of current is reversed then
charged particle (East) i.e. from west to east a particles the polarity of the magnet will change and hence will
must be projected. rotate through an angle of 180°.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 188
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
78. What is meant by electromagnetic induction? State carrying circular coil changes, if we increase the:
the rule which helps in determining direction of a. value of current flowing through it?
induced current. b. distance of point P from the coil?
Ans : [CBSE 2015] c. number of turns of the coil?
Electromagnetic induction is the phenomenon of Ans : [CBSE 2011, 2014]
production of emf (potential difference) or current a. Magnetic field is directly proportional to current
in a coil due to change in magnetic field around it. so magnetic field increases when current increases.
Fleming right hand rule: If we stretch our right hand b. If we increase the distance of point P, magnetic
thumb, forefinger and middle finger perpendicular to field decreases.
each other in such a way that forefinger points the
direction of magnetic field, and thumb points the
direction of force acting on the conductor (motion
of the conductor), then the middle finger points the
direction of induced current in the conductor.
k
this place from west to east. Consider two points A
and B at equal distances from the wire, respectively
or
above and below it. Giving reason explain where is the
field more at A or at B. c. On increasing the number of turns magnetic field
w
Ans : [CBSE 2014] increasing.
The direction of magnetic field due to current at A 82. What happens to the deflection of the compass needle
is from north to south and at B from south to north.
Therefore, at A earth’s magnetic field and field due to
etplaced at a point near current carrying straight
conductor:
current are in opposite direction and at B earth’s
N
a. if the current is increased?
magnetic field and magnetic field due to current are b. if the direction of current in the conductor is
th
in same direction. changed (reversed)?
c. if compass is moved away from the conductor?
ou
due to solenoids
Explain what happens if a bar magnet with its north
a. number of turns in the solenoid
pole towards one face of the coil is:
b. area of cross section of the coil
a. moved quickly towards the coil,
c. strength of current in solenoid
b. kept stationary inside the coil, and
c. moved quick away from the coil? 84. State the condition for electromagnetic induction to
Ans : [CBSE 2014] take place. A cylindrical bar magnet is kept along the
When a bar magnet is moved towards the coil there is axis of a circular coil as shown in the figure. Will
change in magnetic field in there be a current induced in the coil if the magnet is
a. coil so a current is induced in the coil so rotated about its axis? Discuss.
galvanometer gives a deflection.
b. when magnet is kept stationary in the coil then
due to no change in the magnetic field no current
is induced in the coil.
c. when magnet is moved quickly away from the coil
again there is change in magnetic field associated
with the coil so again a current is induced but in
the opposite direction.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
81. How will the magnetic field produced in a current
Electromagnetic induction
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 189
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
a. Either coil or magnet or both must have a relative 87. (a) Electric fuse is an important component of all
motion between them. domestic circuits. Why?
b. If there is a change in current in a coil then current (b) An electric oven of rating 2 kW, 220 V is operated
will be induced in the another neighbouring coil. in a domestic circuit with a current rating of 5 A.
No current is induced because there is no change What result would you expect? Explain.
in magnetic field. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Electric fuse is a safety device which has high resistance
85. Draw a diagram to show how a magnetic needle
and low melting point and prevents electric appliances
deflects when it is placed above or below a straight
during short circuiting and overloading. By melting
conductor carrying current depending on the direction
itself, a fuse break the circuit.
of the current in the conductor.
Ans : [CBSE 2010] 88. Name two safety measures commonly used in electric
circuits and appliances, what precautions should be
taken to avoid the over loading of domestic electric
circuits?
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Proper earthing and using a fuse load in the electric
circuit must be as per rating of the fuse and do not
k
connect to many plugs in a single socket.
or
89. Why does a current carrying conductor kept in a
magnetic field experience force? On what factors does
w
the direction of this force depend? Name and state the
86. (a) Describe an activity to draw a magnetic field line rule used for determination of direction of this force.
et
outside a bar magnet from one pole to another. Ans : [CBSE 2010]
(b) List any two properties of magnetic field lines.
Around a current carrying conductor a magnetic field
N
Ans : [CBSE 2010] is produced. When it is placed in a magnetic field then
(a) Fix a plane white drawing sheet on a drawing both fields interact each other, and current carrying
th
board. Now take a bar magnet and a compass. conductor experience a force.
Place the magnet at the middle of the paper and Fleming’s left hand rule: If we stretch right hand
ou
mark its boundary with the help of pencil. Now thumb, forefinger and middle finger perpendicular
place compass near N-pole of bar magnet and the to each other in such a way that forefinger points
position of needle of the compass. Now move the the direction of magnetic field, middle finger points
gY
compass on the drawing board coinciding S-pole the direction of current, then thumb will point the
of the compass with the previous marked point of direction of force on the conductor.
N of the needle and so on move forward from one
90. What does the direction of thumb indicate in the right
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 190
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
d. angle between direction of magnetic field and b. AG generators are used to produce AC.
current. c. AC voltage can be increased or decrease with the
Fleming’s Left Hand Rule: help of a transformers.
Fleming’s left hand rule gives the direction of force 95. State one main difference between ac and dc. Why
experienced by a current carrying straight conductor ac is preferred over dc for long range transmission of
placed in a magnetic field which is perpendicular to electric power? Name one source each of dc and ac.
it. According to Fleming’s left hand rule if we stretch
our left hand thumb, forefinger and middle finger Ans : [CBSE 2012]
in such a way that forefinger points the direction of The magnitude and direction of ac remains same
magnetic field, middle finger points the direction of whereas a.c. changes its magnitude and direction
current then thumb will give the direction of force on periodically. Low AC voltage can be increase to high
the conductor. voltage to prevent loss in electric energy during its
long distance transmission.
AC generator and DC generator/or cell.
96. (a) Mention the colour code used for live, neutral and
earth wire.
(b) You want to connect a 2 kW electric oven in the
k
electric circuit. In which power line would you
connect it and why? What may happen if you
or
connect it wrongly in the other power line?
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
w
(a) Live wire – Red
92. A coil made of insulated copper wire is connected to
a galvanometer. What will happen to the deflection Neutral wire – Black
of the galvanometer if this coil is moved towards a
stationary bar magnet and then moved away from it?
et Earth wire – Green
N (b) 2 kW electric iron draws large current. If it is
Give reason for your answer and name the phenomenon connected to a socket of 5Athen fuse will be
involved.
th
blown. So it is connected in power socket of 15 A.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
In both the case there is a change in magnetic field FIVE MARKS QUESTIONS
ou
is called electromagnetic induction (EMI). 97. (a) State Fleming’s left hand rule.
(b) Write the principle of working of an electric motor.
93. What is meant by overloading of an electrical circuit?
(c) Explain the function of the following parts of an
Explain two possible causes due to which overloading electric motor.
n
Connecting large number of electric appliances in forefinger and middle finger are stretched
one socket whose load is more than the maximum perpendicular to each other in such a way that
@
permitted limit. The two possible cause are forefinger indicates the direction of magnetic field,
a. all of a sudden supply of high voltage and middle finger indicate the direction of current
b. too many devices connected in a single socket. in the conductor then thumb will indicate the
direction of force on the conductor.
Precautions:
(b) The principle of electric motor is that when a
a. use of voltage regulator,
current carrying coil is placed in a magnetic field
b. load of a socket must be greater than its permitted
it experiences a torque and if the coil is allowed it
rating.
rotates in the magnetic field.
94. Write one difference between direct current and (c) Function of the parts of an electric motor :
alternating current. Which one of the two is mostly (1) Armature: Armature is a large number
produced at power stations in our country? Name one of turns of the coil on soft iron core which
device which provides alternating current. State one rotates in magnetic field.
important advantage of using alternating current. (2) Brushes: They allow current to pass from
external source to armature.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
(3) Split rings: Split rings are of copper, splits into
Direct current has constant magnitude and two halves and make a connection between
unidirectional current. Alternating current changes its armature and brushes.
magnitude and direction alternatively.
a. Alternating current is produced in power stations 98. (a) Explain what is the difference between direct
in India. current and alternating current? Write one
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 191
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
important advantage of using alternating current. (ii) In bar magnet, magnetism is permanent but
(b) An air conditioner of 2 kW is used in an electric in solenoid it exists only till there is a current
circuit having a fuse of 10 A rating. If the potential in solenoid.
difference of the supply is 220 V, will the fuse
be able to withstand, when the air conditioner is
switched on? Justify your answer.
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
(a) Direct current is a unidirectional current with
constant magnitude. Alternating current is a
current which change its magnitude and direction
after a fixed period. AC voltage can be increased
or decreased. Where is dc voltage cannot be
increased or decreased. AC can be transmitted to
long distances with lesser power loss.
(b) Given P = 2 kW and V = 200 volt,
Power, P = VI & I = VP
I = 2000
220 = 9.09 A
k
The rating of the fuse wire is 10 A which is greater
than current drawn by air conditioner so when air
or
conditioner is switched on, fuse will not blow off.
w
magnetic field fines of a bar magnet, with the help
of a cardboard piece and iron filings.
(b) Compare the field of a bar magnet with that of a
solenoid with the help of figure.
et
N
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
100. (a) Describe an activity to determine the direction
th
(a) Fix a white paper sheet on a drawing board with of magnetic field produced by a current carrying
the help of copper pins. Keep a bar magnet in the straight conductor. Also show that the direction
centre of the paper and sprinkle some iron filings
ou
Ans : [CBSE2016]
(a) Fix a cardboard and pass a straight wire through a
hole in cardboard and connect the two ends of the
(b) A current carrying solenoid behaves as a bar
wire with a cell through a rheostat and key with
magnet one end of the solenoid behaves like a N
a cell. Sprinkle iron filings uniformly on the card
pole and another end as S pole like two poles in
board. Pass the current in the wire and gently tap
bar magnet, so the field lines of a solenoid and bar
the card board. You would find that iron filings
magnet appear same in many ways:
align themselves in concentric circles around the
(i) Magnetic lines of force inside the body is
copper wire which represents the magnetic field
strong and uniform.
around the current carrying conductor. The
(ii) In both the cases stronger field exists at the
direction of magnetic field changes on reversing
poles compared to the middle part.
the direction of current.
Dissimilarities
(b) According to Fleming’s left hand rule the force on
(i) In bar magnet, the poles are not exactly at
the oc-particle will be inwards perpendicular to
the ends of the magnet, in solenoid poles can
the plane of paper, so \-particle will move in the
be considered to be lying at the edges.
direction of force.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 192
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
or
w
et
101. Explain the meanings of the words “electromagnetic”
and “induction” in the term electromagnetic induction.
List three factors on which the value of induced current
N
produced in a circuit depends. Name and state the rule
used to determine the direction of induced current.
th
State one practical application of this phenomenon in
everyday life.
ou
potential dipole is being produced in a coil due to (ii) In a bar magnet, magnetism is retained naturally,
change in magnetic field. The word induction means but in solenoid magnetism is there so long current
that the current has been induced. The value of flows through it.
induced current produced in a circuit depends on the
n
following factors: 103. (a) State the function of ‘a fuse’ in an electric circuit.
yi
The rule is Fleming’s right hand rule. Stretch watt is connected which operates at 220 V. What
the thumb, forefinger and middle finger of right- would happen? Explain.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 193
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
(a) Magnetic field lines around a bar magnet. 2- distance of the point from the wire \ I1
By decreasing current or increasing the distance
of the point from the wire, strength of magnetic
field also decreases.
k
Current drawn I = ^P/V h = ^1500/220h A direction of magnetic field, middle finger indicates
the direction of current in the conductor then
or
I = 7 A (approx). thumb will point the direction of force on the
As the current drawn by the oven is 7 A which is conductor,
larger than the rating of the fuse (5A) so fuse will
w
blow off and circuit will be broken. 108. (a) What is an electromagnet? What does it consist
of?
et
105. (a) Explain any three properties of magnetic field (b) Name one material in each case which is used to
lines. make a : (i) permanent magnet (ii) temporary
(b) Give two uses of magnetic compass.
N
magnet.
Ans : [CBSE 2014] (c) Describe an activity to show how you can make
th
(a) Properties of magnetic field lines: an electromagnet in your school laboratory.
1. Magnetic field lines emerge from N pole Ans : [CBSE 2006]
ou
and merge at S pole outside a bar magnet a. A soft metal core made into a magnet by
and travel from S pole to N pole inside the the passage of electric current through a coil
magnet.
gY
1. In navigation it is used to find direction. is used. (ii) Soft iron is used to make temporary
2. It is used to detect the magnetic field. magnet.
yi
3. It can be used to test whether a substance is c. Take a long nail and put it into a solenoid of
magnetic or not. insulated copper wire. Pass the strong current in
Fl
when a compass needle is placed (i) below this 109. (a) Draw a schematic labelled diagram of a domestic
wire, (ii) above the wire. Draw inference from wiring circuit which includes (i) a main fuse (ii) a
your observations. power meter (iii) one light point and (iv) a power
(b) List the factors on which the strength of the plug.
magnetic field due to a straight conductor carrying (b) Why is it necessary to connect an earth wire to
current depend. How should these be changed to electric appliances having metallic covers?
decrease magnetic field at a point?
Ans : [CBSE 2005]
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
a.
(a) The direction of deflection of a magnetic compass
needle depends upon the direction of the magnetic
field at that point. The direction of the magnetic
field due to a current carrying wire is given by the
right hand screw rule. The direction of magnetic
field below and above the wire is opposite so
deflection in compass needle changes as well i.e,
the deflection is reverse direction.
(b) The factors affecting strength of the magnetic field
due to a straight wire carrying current:
1. magnitude of current in the wire \ I b. The earth wire carry current due to any leakage
or defective electric appliance to the earth keeping
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 194
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
human beings safe preventing from any electric instruments? Why is it necessary to earth the
shock. metallic electric appliances?
(b) Explain what is short-circuiting and overloading
in an electric supply.
(c) What is the usual capacity of the fuse wire in the
line to feed:
(i) lights and fans?
(ii) appliances of 2 kW or more power?
Ans : [CBSE 2007]
(a) We can get an electric shock on touching a faulty
appliance, caused by the leakage of current from
the appliance. Earthing provides a safety measure
c. Properties of magnetic field lines against the electric shock caused by the leakage of
(i) They emerge from the north pole and merge current. Earth wire brings this leakage current to
at south pole of a bar magnet. the ground by a earth wire and we remains safe.
(ii) They do not intersect with each other. (b) Short circuiting takes place when a live wire and
(iii) They emerge and merge normal to the surface neutral wire come in contact with each other due
of magnet to damage of insulation of these wires. Due to
k
short circuiting, resistance of the circuit becomes
110. (a) What is meant by a ‘magnetic field’ ?
or
minimum and a very high current is passed
(b) How is the direction of magnetic field at a point through the circuit which produces spark and
determined? heat and may lead a fire in the house. Overloading
w
(c) Describe an activity to demonstrate the direction when the amount of current flowing through the
of the magnetic field generated around a current circuit exceeds the rating of the protective devices
et
carrying conductor. it is said that circuit is overloaded. It is a situation
(d) What is the direction of magnetic field at the in which many electrical appliances are connected
centre of a current carrying circular loop?
N in a single socket. It will draw more current, may
Ans : [CBSE 2007] lead the burst of fire in building.
th
a. Magnetic field is the space around a magnet or a (c) (i) Bulbs, fans etc. – 5A, (ii) Heater – Micro-oven,
current carrying conductor in which its magnetic Electric iron – 15A
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 195
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
(b)
(b) The direction of magnetic field so produced a. Name the type of current in two cases.
around a current carrying conductor can be find b. Identify any one source for each type of current.
with the help of a magnetic compass. When we c. What is the frequency of current in case (b) in
put a magnetic compass at any point of these field our country?
fines it get deflected. The direction of deflection d. On the basis of these graphs list two differences
k
of the compass needle is the direction of magnetic between the two currents.
or
field. e. Out of the two which one is used in transmitting
electric power over long distances and why?
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
w
a. (i) DC (ii) AC
et
N
th
ou
that thumb points the direction of current in the (ii) DC is unidirectional ac changes its direction
after a fixed period.
yi
conductor
e. AC can be transmitted by changing it at high
113. In our daily life we use two types of electric current voltage with the help of transformer to minimise
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 196
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
a way that thumb gives the direction of motion
the working of an electrical fuse?
or
of the conductor, forefinger gives the direction
(b) A fuse is connected in series or in parallel in
of magnetic field then middle finger will give the
household circuit?
direction of current induced in the conductor.
w
(c) Draw a schematic labelled diagram of a domestic
circuit which has a provision of a main fuse, meter, 118. (a) When do we state that an electrical appliance is
one light bulb and a switch socket.
et
earthed? Mention the function of earth wire in
Ans : [CBSE 2010] N electric lines. Why is it necessary to earth the
a. Heating effect of current electric appliances having metallic body?
b. In series in the household circuit (b) Explain what is short circuiting and overloading
in an electric supply.
th
c.
Ans :
ou
electrically earthed.
(b) If due to damaged insulation, live wire and neutral
wire come in contact with each other then it is
said to be short circuiting overloading. A circuit
n
each other?
c. What is indicated by crowding of magnetic field 119. (a) Define electromagnetic induction.
lines in a given region? (b) Two coils P and S are wound over the same iron
d. What is the frequency of ac in India? core. Coil P is connected to battery and key
e. State one advantage of ac over dc. the coil S is connected to galvanometer. Draw a
Ans : [CBSE 2011] suitable diagram of this arrangement and write
your observations when:
a. From N pole to S pole (i) current in the coil P is started by closing the
b. If two magnetic field lines would intersect each key.
other then at the point of intersection there would (ii) current continues to flow in coil P.
be two different directions of magnetic field which (iii) current in coil P is stopped by removing the
is not possible. key.
c. Magnetic field strength is more in that region.
d. 50 cycles per sec (c/s) or Hz. Explain the reason for such observations.
e. AC can be step up for transmission over a longer Ans : [CBSE 2012]
distances with less power loss. a. The phenomenon by producing a current in a coil
by changing magnetic field associated with it or
117. (a) A coil of insulated copper wire is connected to a
by changing a current in the neighbouring coil
galvanometer. What will happen if a bar magnet
is called electromagnetic induction. Current so
is:
produced is called induced current.
(i) pushed into the coil with its north pole
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 197
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
b. (i) When key K is closed due to increasing current the circuit and justify your answer.
a magnetic field is produced which is changing.
In this changing magnetic field coils is kept so an
induced current flow through it, so galvanometer
shows a deflection.
(ii) After some time current reaches maximum
and becomes constant in P coil. There is
no change in current so there is no change
in magnetic field associated with coil S and (b) Give one difference between the wires used in the
hence no induced current in coil S. Deflection element of an electric heater and in a fuse.
in galvanometer becomes zero. (c) List two advantages of parallel connection over
series connection.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
(a) Errors in the circuit
(i) Fuse wire is connected in neutral wire (N)
where as it must be connected in live wire
(L).
(ii) Circuit of bulb B2 is incomplete.
k
(b) Element of electric heater has high resistance and
high melting point whereas a fuse wire has high
or
(iii) Current becomes zero from maximum in coil resistance and low melting point.
P and hence galvanometer shows a deflection (c) Advantages of parallel connection over series
w
but now it is in opposite direction. connection.
(i) In parallel combination if one appliance fails
et
120. Two coils C1 and C2 are wrapped around a non- to work others keep working.
conducting cylinder. Coil C1 is connected to a battery (ii) Potential difference across each appliance
and key and C2 with galvanometer G. On pressing the
N remains same.
key (K), current starts flowing in the coil C1 State
122. (a) Write the values of the following physical quantities
th
your observation in the galvanometer.
in connection with domestic power supply in our
country: (i) potential difference between live wire
ou
the above observation. Write the name of the rule body of the electric appliance is connected to
that is used to determine the direction of current the earth wire, it provides a low resistance
produced in the phenomena. conducting path and leaked current goes to
deep in the earth and human beings do not
Ans : [CBSE 2012,14]
get a fatal electric shock.
a. Induced current in coil C2 is produced so (ii) Fuse: It is also a safety device. It is a wire of
galvanometer shows a deflection. an alloy with low melting point. If a current
b. Again galvanometer shows a deflection but in greater than a particular values flows in the
opposite direction to the previous one. circuit it will melt and circuit is broken and
c. There will be no deflection in galvanometer. stops power supply in the circuit.
d. This phenomenon is called electromagnetic
induction. The phenomenon in which a changing 123. What is a solenoid? Draw the magnetic line of forces
magnetic field in a coil induces a current in another for solenoid and a bar magnet. Compare the two and
coil kept near it. Fleming’s right hand rule is used state one similarity.
to find the direction of induced current. Ans : [CBSE2013]
121. (a) The given figure shows a domestic electric circuit. A solenoid is a large number of turns of insulated
Study this circuit carefully. List any two errors in copper wires having shape of a cylinder or helix.
Magnetic field are given in following figures.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 198
Chap 13 : Magnetice Effect of Electric Current www.cbse.online
k
or
w
(a) Fix a white paper sheet on a drawing board with
et
the help of copper pins. Keep a bar magnet in the WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
gY
4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
n
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 199
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
Source of Energy
1. ONE MARK QUESTIONS power plants are set up near coal or oil field.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
It is because transmission of electricity is more
1. Write the energy conversion which takes place in efficient than transporting coal or petroleum over the
hydropower plant. same distance. That is why thermal power plants are
Ans : [CBSE 2018,2017] set up near coal or oil fields.
Potential/kinetic/mechanical energy into electrical
10. Write the special technique used for mounting solar
energy.
k
cell panels. Mention its advantage.
Write any two applications of biogas. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
or
2.
Ans : [CBSE 2018] The solar cell panels are mounted on specially designed
inclined roof tops so that more solar energy is incident
w
a. Biogas is used as clean fuel.
b. The slurry left behind in biogas plant can be used over it.
as manure.
et
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
3. Name any two nuclear fuels used for the process of For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
hN
nuclear fission. www.cbse.online for
Ans : [CBSE 2016] 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank
Uranium-235 and Plutonium or Thorium.
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
t
ou
4. Compare the energy produced by fission of a uranium 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
atom with the energy produced due to combustion of 4. NCERT Solutions
a carbon atom from coal. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Y
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
times the energy produced by combustion of 1 carbon
atom.
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 200
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
It is because black surface absorbs more (98%) heat Geothermal energy is non-conventional source of
as compared to white or reflecting surface or light energy which can be harnessed for 24 hours through
coloured surfaces. out the year.
15. Name the characteristic features of micro organisms 25. List two forms of energy in which solar energy
which help in production of biogas in biogas plants. manifests itself in oceans.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Ans :
The micro-organisms are anaerobic bacteria which (i) Ocean thermal energy, (ii) Tidal energy.
break down organic matters and produce biogas in
absence of oxygen (anaerobically). 26. Mention the minimum temperature difference required
between surface water and the water at depth of up to
16. List two steps of energy conversions in thermal power 2 km in an ocean thermal energy plant.
plants. [CBSE 2015] Ans : [CBSE 2014, 2013]
Ans : 20° C should be minimum difference in temperature.
Chemical energy of fuel is converted into Heat energy.
Heat energy is used to produce steam which runs 27. What are hot spots inside earths crust?
turbine and produce electricity (electric energy). Ans : [CBSE 2014]
The regions where molten rocks are formed in the
k
17. Name the major constituents of natural gas.
deeper hot regions of earth crust which are pushed
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
or
upward and trapped in certain regions called hot
Methane is major constituent of natural gas. spots.
w
18. Name the part of a biogas plant where reactions take 28. A black surface absorbs more heat radiations as
place in absence of oxygen. [CBSE 2014] compared to a white or reflecting surface under
et
Ans : identical conditions. List two solar devices which
make use of this property in their design.
Digestor is part of biogas plant where reaction takes
hN
place in absence of oxygen. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
(i) Solar cooker, (ii) Solar water heater.
19. Name any two elements which are used for fabrication
of solar cells. [CBSE 2014,2012] 29. Why a solar cooker painted black from outside?
t
ou
non-renewable sources. the device which converts kinetic energy of wind into
electrical energy.
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 201
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
thermal energy plant. + $ +
35. Name the reaction responsible for large energy
It releases tremendous amount of energy, according to
production in the sun. [CBSE 2013]
2
where m is called mass defect (difference
in mass of reactants and products), c is velocity of
Ans :
light.
Nuclear fusion reaction is responsible for large energy
produced in the Sun. 44. How has the traditional use of wind energy been
modified for our convenience. [CBSE 2008]
36. Name one fuel used in nuclear reactor. Ans :
Ans : [CBSE 2013, 2012]
Rotatory motion of wind mill, with the help of wind
Uranium is used as nuclear fuel. energy is utilized to
(a) lift water from a well or
37. List two nutrients that the slurry left behind in the (b) turn the turbine of electric generator that
biogas plant contain. [CBSE 2011] generates electricity.
Ans :
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
a. Nitrogen
b. Phosphorus are present in slurry left in biogas For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
plants. www.cbse.online for
k
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
38. Biogas is also known as gobar gas. Justify. Bank
or
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
w
The main constituent of starting material for
4. NCERT Solutions
production of biogas is cow dung therefore, it is called
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Gobar gas.
et
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
39. List two practical uses of biogas in rural areas. New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
hN
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
Ans : [CBSE 2011] For School Education
sunlight into electricity i.e., solar energy into electrical a. It is because non-conventional sources of energy
energy. are limited.
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 202
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
b. It makes use of waste materials and slurry left is 53. Explain why:
used as a manure. (i) Solar cookers are covered with glass plate.
(ii) The solar cooker is painted black from inside.
49. Briefly describe the working of thermal power plant.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Why thermal power plants are set up near oil or coal
fields? (i) Glass plate does not allow heat to escape from
Ans : [CBSE 2015] solar cooker due to greenhouse effect.
(ii) Black colour absorbs maximum sunlight (98%).
Working of Thermal Power Plant :
a. Large amount of fossil fuels are burnt in thermal 54. What are the advantages of nuclear energy? [CBSE
power plants . 2011]
b. Heat generated converts water into steam. Ans :
c. Steam runs turbine and generates electricity.
A small amount of a fuel can generate large amount
It is because transmission of electricity is more of energy. 1 atom of uranium produces 10 million
efficient than transporting coal or petroleum over the times more energy than energy produced by 1 atom
same distance. That is why thermal power plants are of carbon.
set up near coal or oil fields.
55. What is solar cell panel? Mention any three of its
50. Define fuel. List any two characteristics that you applications. [CBSE 2011]
k
would look for in a good fuel. [CBSE 2014] Ans :
Ans :
or
Solar cell panel: Solar cell panel is a panel on which
Fuel is a substance which produces heat as well as large number of solar cells are connected together in a
light on complete combustion. particular arrangement.
w
Characteristics of good fuel : Applications of solar panel:
a. It should be cheap and readily available. a. It provides power for artificial satellites.
b. It should not create pollution.
(ii) Element with mass number 2 i.e., ?H is used in to enter the solar cooker but does not allow trapped
hydrogen bomb which is based on nuclear fusion radiation to go out of solar cooker. Trapped heat inside
ng
reaction between isotopes of hydrogen to produce increases the temperature. Glass lid also reduces heat
helium. loss due to reflection.
In nuclear reactor nuclear fission reaction takes
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 203
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
58. How are wastes produced in nuclear power plants amount of energy which converts water into steam.
different from those produced in a thermal power Steam runs turbine and produces electricity.
plants? What happens to the waste of a nuclear power Uranium-235, Plutonium or Thorium are used as
plant? nuclear fuel.
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
The wastes obtained from nuclear power plants are
highly radioactive which give out harmful radiations. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
Whereas in thermal power plants, wastes are not www.cbse.online for
radioactive. 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Disposal of nuclear waste: Bank
a. Nuclear waste are buried deep inside the earth 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
kept in sealed lead nuclear waste container. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
b. Some products are converted into less harmful 4. NCERT Solutions
products with short half life. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
59. What happens when wood is burnt in a limited supply Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
of oxygen? Name the residue left behind after the study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
reaction and state the two advantages of using this
k
residue as a fuel over wood. [CBSE 2010]
Ans : 63. In a solar cooker, the following arrangements are
or
When wood is burnt in limited supply of oxygen, made. Write one function of each arrangement.
olatile gaseous material gets collected in the form of (i) The box is made of insulating material such as
w
wood gas. The vapours on condensation form wood plastic or wood.
tar which on distillation gives acetone and acetic acid. (ii) The inner walls of the box are painted black.
et
The residue left behind is wood charcoal used as a (iii) The box is covered with a transparent glass sheet.
fuel. (iv) A plane mirror is hanged at an angle at the top of
hN
Advantages of charcoal as fuel: the box.
a. It does not produces smoke whereas wood Ans : [CBSE 2009]
produces lot a smoke. (i) It does not allow heat to escape from solar cooker.
b. Charcoal has higher calorific value than wood i.e.,
t
(ii) It is done so as to absorb maximum amount of
produces more energy than wood.
ou
heat.
(iii) Glass sheet allows solar radiations to enter
60. Name four gases commonly present in biogas. State
but does not allow heat to escape and increase
two advantages of using this gas over fossil fuels.
Y
H2S, CH4, H2, CO2 are present in biogas. strong beam which heat solar cooker.
Advantages of using this gas over fossil fuels.
a. It does not create pollution whereas fossil fuels 64. Describe how hydro energy can be converted into
electrical energy. Write any two limitations of hydro
yi
create pollution.
b. It makes use of waste material, therefore cost energy.
effective where as fossil fuels are not. Ans : [CBSE 2009]
Fl
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 204
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
nuclear waste is very difficult. 71. (i) A hydropower plant converts one form of energy
into another. Name these two forms of energy.
(ii) State two advantages of generating hy-
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS droelectricity compared to the generation of
electricity in thermal power plant.
66. What is a dam? Why do we seek to build large dams? Ans : [CBSE 2016]
While building dams, which three main problems Hydropower makes use of kinetic energy of flowing
should be particularly be addressed to maintain peace water into electric energy.
among local people? Mention them. Advantages:
Ans : [CBSE 2018] (i) No pollution in hydropower station whereas
A dam is an arrangement in which very large amount thermal power plants pollutes air.
of water is stored at a height on the rivers especially in (ii) As renewable source of energy is used so it involves
hilly areas. Large dams are built to store more water less recurring cost as compared to thermal power
and produce electricity continuously. plant.
Problems: 72. Enlist the energy changes taking place in hydroelectric
a. Rehabitation of people near dam. power stations. [CBSE 2016]
b. Safeguard of plants and animals.
Ans :
c. Adequate compensation to farmers who lost their
k
agricultural lands due to construction of dam. a. Hydroelectric power plants convert the potential
or
energy of falling water into electricity.
67. List any three parameters on the basis of which a b. In order to produce hydel electricity, high rise
source of energy can be categorised as a good source dams are constructed on the river to obstruct the
w
of energy? flow of water and thereby collect water in larger
Ans : [CBSE 2016] reservoirs.
a. It should have high calorific value.
b. It should be cheap and readily available.
et c. The water level rises and in the process the
kinetic energy of flowing water gets transformed
hN
c. It should not create pollution. into potential energy. The water is then allowed to
fall from height which converts potential energy
68. Write three disadvantages of using fossil fuels. to kinetic energy.
d. Due to falling water turbine rotates i.e., kinetic
t
Ans : [CBSE 2016]
energy changes to mechanical energy which is
ou
a. It creates air pollution and acid rain. then converted to electric energy with the help of
b. Its cost is increasing due to more demand. dynamo connected to turbine.
c. It is non-renewable, therefore, limited, cannot be
Y
replaced. 73. Define the process of nuclear fission. Write the steps
involved in generating electricity in a nuclear reactor.
ng
(i) Why does Kunal use solar cooker instead of LPG? break into lighter nuclei along with liberation of lot
Give reason for your answer. of energy.
a. The heat energy produced in nuclear fission
Fl
cooker?
74. (i) Define tidal energy.
Ans : [CBSE 2016] (ii) Explain how is tidal energy harnessed and write
(i) Kunal use solar cooker instead of LPG because : one limitation of the use of tidal energy.
(a) LPG on combustion gives carbon dioxide Ans : [CBSE 2015]
while solar cooker does not emit anything
harmful. (i) The rise of ocean water due to attraction of moon
(b) Solar cooker cooks food slower than LPG, is called hight tide and its fall is called low tide.
therefore minimum loss of nutrients. The energy obtained from tides is called tidal
(c) Solar cooker is more cost effective than LPG. energy.
(ii) Greenhouse effect. (ii) Tidal energy can be harnessed by constructing
(iii) Low cost involved and no pollution. a dam across a narrow opening to the sea. A
turbine fixed at the opening of dam converts
70. Write down three advantages of harnessing wind tidal energy into electrical energy. The movement
energy. of water during high tide and low tide can be
Ans : [CBSE 2016] used to rotate turbine of generator and produce
electricity.
a. It is environment friendly.
b. It is efficient renewable source of energy, Limitation :
c. It is less expensive as there are no recurring (a) Very few sea coasts in the world have suitable
expenses. sites for the purpose of harnessing tidal
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 205
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
energy. certain regions called hot spots.
(b) The rise and falls of tides that happen only b. When underground water comes in contact with
twice in a day is not sufficient to generate the hot spot, steam is generated.
electricity continuously. c. Steam trapped is routed through pipes to a
turbine and used to generate electricity.
75. Biogas is an excellent fuel. Justify the statement
giving two reasons. Mention the major constituent of NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
biogas along with its percentage. [CBSE 2015] For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
Ans : www.cbse.online for
Biogas is an excellent fuel because: 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
a. It is a clean fuel and requires minimum cost. Bank
b. It makes use of waste products and does not 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
create pollution on combustion. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
The major percentage of CH4 in biogas is 75%. 4. NCERT Solutions
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
76. Why do people oppose the construction of Tehri dam provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
on the river Ganga and Sardar Sarovar project on the New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
river Narmada. study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
or
k
Mention three disadvantages of producing hydro
or
electricity by construction of dams. 79. Explain how hydroelectricity is produced
or Ans : [CBSE 2015]
List any three ways in which construction of dams
w
for production of electricity adversely effects the a. In hydroelectric plant, a dam is made and water
environment of that place. [CBSE 2015] is collected at height.
et
b. The water from height is made to fall on turbine
Ans :
which rotates and produce electricity.
hN
a. People of the areas lose their agricultural land.
b. Natural eco systems are destroyed. 80. State any three reasons to justify that LPG is
c. Vegetation which are submerged under water considered as an ideal fuel.
decompose by micro-organisms in absence of Ans : [CBSE 2014]
t
oxygen to form methane which causes global
ou
(ii) Give one example to illustrate that energy from c. It does not create pollution.
windmill was used in the past to do mechanical
81. State any three advantages of charcoal over wood.
ng
work.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
a. Charcoal has higher calorific value than wood.
yi
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 206
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
to be used for commercial purpose. The number of into vapours which rotates turbine and generates
wind mills are erected over large area, which is known electricity. The cold water from the depth of the
as wind energy farm. ocean is pumped up and condense vapours of
To generate electricity, the rotatory motion of the ammonia to form liquid ammonia.
windmill is used to turn the turbine of the electric c. The essential condition for generation of electricity
generator. The energy output of each wind mill in by ocean is that difference in temperature between
a farm is coupled together to get electricity on a surface and deeper region must be atleast 20° C.
commercial scale. 87. Distinguish between renewable and non-renewable
84. Compare and contrast fossil fuels and the Sun as sources of energy. Also give an example of each of
direct source of energy. [CBSE 2014] these resources.
Ans : Ans : [CBSE 2012]
1. It is non-renewable It is a renewable source 1. They are not likely to They are likely to
source of energy of energy. get exhausted in near get exhausted in near
future. future.
2. It creates pollution. It does not create
pollution.. 2. They create less or no They create more
k
pollution. pollution.
3. It involves regular Solar based devices cost
or
expenses. more initially but work 3. They involve less They involve recurring
for long time without recurring cost. cost. Example: Coal
Example: Solar energy and petrol.
w
recurring cost.
from sun.
85. Compare the advantages of generating energy from
et
biomass than getting it from hydropower plant. 88. Mention why is it not possible to make use of solar
cells to meet our all energy needs? State three reasons
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
hN
to support your answer. Also mention three uses of
or solar cells.
Compare and contrast biomass and hydro electricity Ans : [CBSE 2012]
as sources of energy. [CBSE 2014]
t
It is not possible to make use of solar cells to meet our
Ans :
ou
silver.
1. It does not lead to It involves loss of b. It has low efficiency.
ng
loss of vegetation vegetation and dis- c. During cloudy days and during nights, these cells
and displacement of placement of people will not produce electricity.
people. during construction of Uses:
yi
plant, it minimise only. b. Artificial satellites and space probes like Mars
the problem of waste orbiters use solar cells.
disposal and produces c. Solar street lights are now being used extensively.
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 207
Chap 14 : Source of Energy www.cbse.online
(ii) Burning of cow dung cakes, plant waste creates NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
lot of pollution. Human excreta also creates lot For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
of pollution in rural areas. Biogas converts all the www.cbse.online for
waste materials into useful and clean fuel. 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank
91. a. What is geothermal energy?
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
b. What are the advantages of wind energy?
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
Ans : [CBSE 2011] 4. NCERT Solutions
a. Geothermal energy: The energy obtained from the All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
high temperature inside the earth due to molten provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
rocks is called geothermal energy. New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
b. Advantages of wind energy : study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
For School Education
1. Wind energy is renewable source of energy
and
2. It does not create pollution.
k
of biomass fuels? [CBSE 2011]
or
Ans :
a. Submerged vegetation decompose in presence of
w
micro-organism and generate methane which is
greenhouse gas.
et
b. Biomass is used in biogas plant and produces
biogas which is an excellent fuel. The residue left
hN
in biogas plant is used as manure.
biomass?
b. Why is biogas considered an ideal fuel?
c. Name the parts labelled A, B and C in the
Y
diagram.
ng
yi
Fl
@
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 208
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
Our Enviorment
1. ONE MARK QUESTIONS 9. What is the function of ozone in the upper atmosphere?
Ans : [Delhi 2015]
Ozone shields the surface of the earth from ultraviolet
1. What is an ecosystem? [Delhi 2017, CBSE 2014] rays from the Sim.
Ans :
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
Ecosystem is an interaction of physical and biotic
factors present in an area among each other. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
k
2. Why is forest/lake considered a natural ecosystem? 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
Bank
or
Ans : [Delhi 2017]
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
Forests and lakes have both biotic and abiotic 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
w
components which are present naturally and are 4. NCERT Solutions
interacting without mans interference. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
et
3. If in the following food chain, 100 J of energy is provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
available to the lion, how much energy was available New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
hN
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
to the producer? Plants Deer -> Lion For School Education
1000 joules.
6. Give one protective function of forests. [CBSE 2016]
12. In an ecosystem, rats feed on grains. Name the trophic
Ans : level to which the rats belong.
Forests reduce atmospheric pollution. Ans : [CBSE 2015]
7. The first trophic level in a food chain is always a green Ans :
plant. Why? [CBSE 2016] Second trophic level.
Ans :
13. What is the physical environment of an ecosystem
Plants can only utilize the radiant energy of the sun and
called? Give one example. [CBSE 2015]
transform it to chemical form during photosynthesis.
Ans :
8. Which of the following are always at the second Physical environment of an ecosystem is called as the
trophic level of food chains? Carnivores, Autotrophs, abiotic or non-living component of an ecosystem. This
Herbivores. includes physical factors like temperature, rainfall,
Ans : [CBSE 2016] wind, soil and minerals. (any one)
Ans : 14. How does concentration of a pesticide change once it
Herbivores. enters a food chain? [CBSE 2015]
Ans :
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 209
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
Concentration of pesticide gets accumulated 23. State a way to prevent accumulation of harmful
progressively at each trophic level once it enters a chemicals in our bodies. [CBSE 2014]
food chain. Ans :
15. Draw the conclusion if all the herbivores are removed To minimize use of pesticides in agriculture.
from the grassland. [CBSE 2015]
24. During heavy rain in a village the rainwater carried
Ans : excessive fertilizers to a pond. How will it affect the
If all the herbivores are removed from the grassland, fish population in the pond in the long run?
carnivores will not be able to survive and the Ans : [CBSE 2014]
autotrophs will increase in number.
The growth of fish will decrease as water gets polluted
16. Write the appropriate names of the trophic levels Z due to excessive algae growth.
and X in the figure given
25. Flow of energy is unidirectional. Name the first two
components of the environment involved in this flow
of energy from the sun. [CBSE 2014]
Ans :
Producers and primary consumers.
k
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
or
For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Bank
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
et
Tertiary consumers, X : Primary consumers. 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
4. NCERT Solutions
hN
17. What is meant by biological magnification?
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Accumulation of non-biodegradable chemicals Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
t
progressively at each trophic level in a food chain is study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
ou
18. Give one example each from your daily life where the
26. Mention one negative effect of our affluent lifestyle on
Y
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 210
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
31. Give one example from your daily life where the Compounds which depletes ozone layer are:
household wastes can be effectively reused and (i) Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) and fluorocarbons.
recycled respectively. (ii) Free chlorine.
Ans : [All India 2013] (iii) Aerosols.
To reuse paper envelope To recycle-plastic mug. 42. Draw a food chain which operates in a forest ecosystem.
k
in case of man?
34. A primary consumer in the food chain has 10000 J
Ans : [CBSE 2012,13]
or
energy available. How much energy will be provided
for tertiary consumer in this food chain? DDT is non-biodegradable substance which
Ans : [All India 2012] accumulates at each trophic level. Since man is at the
w
highest trophic level, there is maximum accumulation
100 J.
of DDT in him (biological magnification).
35. Name the two components of an ecosystem.
Ans : [Delhi 2012]
et
45. Ozone is deadly poisonous, still it performs an essential
hN
function. How? [CBSE 2012]
Biotic and abiotic are two components of an ecosystem. Ans :
36. Name two decomposers operating in our ecosystem. Ozone layer shields the surface of the earth and blocks
t
the entry of UV rays from the sun.
Ans : [Delhi 2012]
ou
Bacteria and fungi. 46. What is depicted in the below mentioned scheme?
Ans : [CBSE 20121
Y
ones.
48. Save the Tiger campaign is being over¬emphasised
38. Which chemical is used in fire extinguishers? How is
Fl
Ans :
Fire extinguishers use Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs). It
Tiger stands at the top trophic level. To maintain
depletes ozone layer.
ecological balance in nature and to preserve gene pool.
39. What are the two main components of our environment? Tiger is a threatened species. To help its survival, the
Save the Tiger campaign is emphasized.
Ans : [CBSE 2012,13]
Two main components of our environment are: 49. Why are plastics non-biodegradable substances?
a. Biotic (e.g., plants, animals etc.) Ans : [CBSE 2012]
b. Abiotic (e.g., soil, air, water etc.)
Plastics cannot be broken down by the action of
40. Why are green plants called producers ? enzymes/bacteria/saprophyte.
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 50. Mention the role of microorganisms like bacteria and
Producers are the organisms which prepare their fungi in the ecosystem. [CBSE 2012]
own food in the presence of sunlight and chlorophyll. Ans :
Therefore green plants are called producers as they
To breakdown the dead remains and waste product of
prepare their own food.
organisms.
41. Which compounds are responsible for the depletion of
51. In the following food chain, grass provides 4000 J of
ozone layer? [CBSE 2012]
energy to the grasshopper. How much energy will be
Ans :
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 211
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
available to snake and frog? 90%.
Grass, Grasshopper, Frog, Snake.
59. Why should use of Chlorofluorocarbons be reduced?
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
Ans : [CBSE 2010]
Grass $ Grasshopper $ Frog $ Snake
(4000 J) (400 J) (40 J) (4 J) Chlorofluorocarbons [CFCs] are res¬ponsible for
So, for snake and frog, 4 J and 40 J energy will be depletion of ozone layer.
available by 10 % law respectively.
60. Mention two ways to make our environment clean of
52. What is meant non-biodegradable waste? Identify garbage?
biodegradable waste from the following: Ans : [Delhi 2008]
Empty packet of chips, empty plastic bottle of mineral a. Reduce the use of plastics
water, empty paper box of sweets, empty tin of a cold b. Recycle waste paper, plastic, glass and metal
drink. items.
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
Substances that do not break down by biological
process are called non¬biodegradable waste. Empty For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
paper box of sweets. www.cbse.online for
1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
k
53. Consider a food chain consisting of: Bank
wheat, rat, snakes, peacock: 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
or
What will happen if all the snakes are killed? 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
Ans : [CBSE 2012] 4. NCERT Solutions
w
All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
If all snakes of food chain are killed the peacocks
provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
belonging to the next level will also die. Also the
et
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
population of rats in the preceding level will highly New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
increase. For School Education
hN
54. Choose one consumer each that belongs to the second
and third trophic levels from the organisms given
below: TWO MARKS QUESTIONS
t
ou
(ii) Third trophic level $ Frog and fox. (ii) wild life
Ans : [All India 2017]
ng
+ fertility of soil.
+ (b) They are also a source of income for tribal
@
people.
56. Why are non-biodegradable substances not broken (ii) Wild life is important
down by microbes? [CBSE 2012] (a) To preserve bio-diversity.
Ans : (b) As each species has a position in the food
chain so wildlife helps in balancing the nature.
Microbes are highly specific enzymes which can
breakdown natural materials. 62. What are ozone holes? How do they form?
Ans : [Delhi 2016]
57. If the energy available in phytoplanktons is 10,000 KJ,
how much energy would a whale get on consuming The coolants of Refrigerators and A/Cs use CFCs
them? which release fluorine which react with ozone gas
Ans : [Delhi 2011] and break it into oxygen and a very reactive form
of atomic oxygen which in turn can break another
1000 J. ozone molecule. Thus a chain reaction starts and layer
of ozone becomes thinner at some places in upper
58. When plants are eaten by primary consumers, a great
atmosphere. These are called ozone holes.
deal of energy is lost as heat to the environment
and some amount goes in carrying out various life 63. In cities garbage disposal is a major problem. How can
processes. State the average percentage of energy lost we deal with this problem? List any two ways.
in this manner.
Ans : [All India 2016]
Ans : [Sample Paper 2010]
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 212
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
Two methods of garbage disposal are: given food chain?
a. Converting organic wastes into biogas or compost. Plants $ Deers $ Tigers
Organic wastes like cow dung, leaves etc can be Ans : [CBSE 2015]
decomposed and converted into useful substance
If all deers are removed from the given food chain,
like biogas and manure.
then
b. Recycling plastics, glass and metals.
a. Tigers will not survive.
64. Compare the advantages of cloth bags over polythene b. Plants will increase in number.
bags. [CBSE 2016]
70. Food web increases the stability of an ecosystem.
Ans : Justify.
Cloth bags being biodegradable are broken down by Ans : [CBSE 2015]
the action of bacteria or other saprophytes, whereas
Food web depicts feeding connection in an ecological
polythene bags being non-biodegradable persist in
community. It consists of many food chains. Thus, if
the environment for a long time, causing harm to the
any of the organism becomes endangered or extinct,
ecosystem.
the one who is dependent on it has an alternative
65. Pesticides like DDT which are sprayed to kill pests on option available to him for its survival. In this way,
crops are found to be present in the soil, groundwater, food web increases stability in an ecosystem.
water bodies etc. Explain how do they reach these
k
NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
places?
or
Ans : [CBSE 2016] For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
a. Soil: Pesticides are sprayed to protect plants from 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
w
insects and they, consequently, get settled into soil Bank
particles, when used on plants. 2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
et
b. Groundwater: Through irrigation in the fields, 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
these pesticides present in soil pass into lower 4. NCERT Solutions
hN
layers of soil and reaches groundwater. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
c. Water bodies: When the waste water or other provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
agricultural waste is thrown in water bodies like Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
river, canals, ponds, etc., the pesticides affect
t
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
water bodies. For School Education
ou
Whereas ponds and lakes are natural, and self- land, water and air pollution.
sustained ecosystem in which microorganisms help in b. It may disturb ecosystem as without decomposition,
Fl
decomposing the waste matters. soil will not be replenished, which is essential for
plants, which forms the basis of an ecosystem.
67. What is ozone? How does it form?
@
Ans : [All India 2015] 72. Differentiate between the food habits I of organisms
Ozone layer forms due to combination of molecular belonging to the first and second trophic level.
and elemental form of oxygen in the presence of UV Ans : [All India 2014-15]
rays. O3 or ozone is a deadly poison formed from First trophic level : Producer/autotroph Second
oxygen O2, due to the effect of UV rays of sun. trophic level: Primary consumer/ herbivore.
68. Accumulation of harmful chemicals in our body can 73. State two methods to get rid of non-biodegradable
be avoided. Explain how this can be achieved. wastes.
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Accumulation of chemicals in our body can be avoided a. Paper bags or cloth bags should be used to carry
by: things instead of plastic bags.
a. Washing vegetables and fruits properly with b. Non-biodegradable wastes should be sent in
water. factories for recycling.
b. Soak vegetables and fruits in salt water for few
minutes before cooking. 74. Define food web. State its significance for ecosystem.
c. Most vegetables should be boiled. Ans : [CBSE 2014]
d. Organic subtances should be used for cultivation.
A system of interconnected food chains between
69. What will happen if all the deers are removed in the various organisms is called a food web.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 213
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
A food web maintains ecological balance by b. No, because flow of energy is unidirectional. It is
maintaining the interdependene of different organisms. from lower to higher level.
75. Why Amrita Devi Bishnoi national award for wildlife 81. How will food chain be affected if we hunt all the
conservation has been instituted? [Foreign 2013] tigers in a forest? [All India 2012]
Ans : Ans :
Amrita Devi Bishnoi gave her life while saving wild Tiger is the top Consumer or Top Carnivore.
life and forest trees in her locality. This award is given Eliminating it from food chain through hunting would
for those who show major contribution in conservation lead to leaving the organism at trophic level below
and protection of wild life. it to multiply without control. Since there are large
herbivores like deer, they will eat up the producers
76. Government of India is imposing ban on the use of (grass, plants) and make the soil without vegetation.
polythene bags for shopping. List four advantages of
using cloth or jute bag over polythene bags. No vegetation in soil would cause desertification,
soil erosion, floods, drought etc. Less vegetation means
Ans : [Foreign 2013]
less rainfall and disruption of water cycle. It will be a
Four advantages of using jute/cloth bag over polythene vicious cycle.
bags:
Thus this act can lead to ecological balance as
a. It is biodegradable.
well as climatic problems.
k
b. Does not add to the garbage and land pollution.
c. Made from renewable resources.
or
82. Mention the differences between food habits of
d. Does not block the flow of water in the drains. organisms belonging to the first and third trophic
e. Can be washed and reused many times. level. Give one example of each of them.
w
77. State the meaning of biodiversity. List two advantages Ans : [CBSE 2012,13]
et
of conserving forest and wildlife. [Foreign 2013]
First Trophic Level Third Trophic Level
Ans :
1. The organisms of this The organisms of
hN
Biodiversity consists of various species of plants and trophic level are plants this trophic level are
animals. Wild life means our flora and fauna. and are also called animals and are also
Two advantages of conserving forest and wildlife are: producers. called secondary.
a. To preserve bio-diversity.
t
2. They transform They obtain chemical
ou
by lanes of residential colonies. Suggest ways to make grass (all green plants) (like lion).
people realise that the improper disposal of waste is
ng
harmful to the environment. [Delhi 2013] 83. List two causes of depletion of ozone layer. Mention
any two harmful effects of depletion of this layer.
Ans :
Ans : [CBSE 2012]
yi
c. Awareness campaigns like Swachh Bharat to The harmful effects of depletion of ozone layer are:
disseminate the knowledge about consequences of a. Due to depletion of ozone layer, UV radiations
improper disposal of wastes. reach the earth. These UV radiations cause skin
cancer, damage to eyes and immune system.
79. What would happen if number of carnivores decreases b. This depletion of ozone layer may also lead to
in an ecosystem? [CBSE 2013] variations.
Ans :
84. What will happen if we kill all the organism in a
a. Population of herbivores will increase beyond trophic level?
control. Ans : [All India 2011]
b. Autotrophs will disappear from earth due to
overgrazing done by herbivores. The food chain will get disrupted if we kill all the
c. Both these factors may disturb food chains thus organism in a trophic level. The organism at the lower
affecting the ecosystem. level will increase in number as there in no one to eat
them and those at higher level will die of starvation.
80. State the direction of flow of energy in food chain. This will cause ecological imbalance.
Can food and energy from a trophic level move back
to the previous level? Give reason for your answer.
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
Ans : [CBSE 2013]
a. Energy flows from producer to top carnivores.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 214
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
85. Students in a school listened to the news read in the school which is creating environmental awareness
morning assembly that the mountain of garbage in amongst the school students, spreading the same in
Delhi, suddenly exploded and various vehicles got society and working hard for preventing environmental
buried under it. Several people were also injured and degradation of the surroundings.
there was traffic jam all around. In the brain storming a. Why is it necessary to conserve our environment?
session, the teacher also discussed this issue and asked b. State the importance of green and blue ) dustbins
the students to find out a solution to the problem of in the safe disposal of the household waste.
garbage. Finally they arrived at two main points - one c. List two values exhibited by your classmate who is
is self management of the garbage we produce and the an active member of the Eco-club of your school.
second is to generate less garbage at individual level. Ans : [All India 2016]
a. Suggest two measures to manage the garbage we
a. Conservation of our environment is necessary
produce.
to leave it in good condition for our future
b. As an individual, what can we do to generate the
generations.
least garbage? Give two points.
b. Green and blue dustbins should be used to
c. List two values the teacher instilled in his students
segregate wet and dry waste so that according to
in this episode.
their nature they can be sent for the safe disposal
Ans : [All India 2018] to compost pits/ biogas plant and recycling in
a. Segregation and safe disposal. Encouraging use of factories.
k
recycled paper, plastic and glass items. c. Two values: He is concerned about environment,
b. Following the strategy of 3Rs: problem solving attitude.
or
(i) Reducing the use of packing, buying only
whatever is required, taking small serving at 88. Monika was observing a lizard on the wall which
w
a time. chased an insect and ate it. She felt that lizard is
(ii) Reusing envelops, boxes, bottles and . cans. cruel and ugly. Suddenly the lizard fell and was eaten
by a cat. She started thinking, how organisms are
et
Old clothes can be converted into dusters,
bags etc connected to each other for their food?
a. What is a food chain? Will the world be a better
hN
(c) (i) Scientific attitude (ii) concern for environment.
place without lizards?
86. You have been selected to talk on ozone layer and its b. Make a food chain of five organisms.
protection in the school assembly on Environment c. Do you think lizard is cruel and ugly?
t
Day. d. To which trophic level does the lizard belong?
ou
a. Why should ozone layer be protected to save the Ans : [All India 2017]
environment?
a. Food chain is a sequence of who eats whom in
b. List any two ways you will stress in your talk to
Y
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 215
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
c. Decomposers are the organisms that decompose eating the food some friends collected the leftover
the complex molecules present in the dead remains food and plastic bags etc and planned to dispose them
of plants and animals. Example: Bacteria, Fungi. off by burning. Rakesh immediately checked them
and suggested to segregate the leftover food and peels
91. a. What is an ecosystem? List its two main of fruits from the plastic materials and respectively
components. dispose them off separately in the green and red
b. We do not clean ponds or lakes, but an aquarium dustbins placed in the corner of the park.
needs to be cleaned regularly. Explain. a. In your opinion, is burning plastic an eco¬friendly
Ans : [CBSE 2016, Delhi 2013, CBSE 2008] method of waste disposal? Why? State the
a. A self-sustaining functional unit consisting of advantage of method suggested by Rakesh.
living (biotic) and nonliving (abiotic) components, b. How can we contribute in maintain the parks and
is called an ecosystem. roads neat and clean?
1. Biotic components: Plants and animals. Ans : [Delhi 2015]
2. Abiotic components: Light, soil, temperature, a. No, it pollutes air.
humidity, wind, air, etc. Advantage: Segregation of wastes into
b. An aquarium is an artificial and incomplete biodegradable and non biodegradable wastes at
ecosystem in contrast to a pond or lake which is the initial stage of disposal saves time and energy.
natural, self- sustaining and complete ecosystem. b. By putting wastes in proper dustbins.
k
In natural ecosystem, decomposers help in
recycling waste. So, an aquarium needs to be 95. Energy flow in a food chain is unidirectional. Justify
or
cleaned regularly. this statement. Explain how the pesticides enter a
food chain and subsequently get into our body.
92. What is ozone? How and where is it formed in the
w
Ans : [CBSE 2015, All India 2014]
atmosphere? Explain how it affects an ecosystem?
Ans : [Foreign 2015] a. Energy moves progressively through the various
94. After the examination Rakesh with his friends went 97. Within the school premises while playing some
on a picnic to a nearby park. All friends carried cooled students observed that some people are burning dry
food packed in plastic bags or plastic cans. After leaves. They knew that it would cause harm to the
environment. They immediately went and to these
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 216
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
people requested them to stop it. 101. Distinguish between biodegradable , and non-
(i) How can the above activity be changed to make it biodegradable substances. List two effects of each of
environment friendly? them on our environment.
(ii) Students took initiative to stop the practice. Ans : [CBSE2012,13,15]
What values are displayed by them in this
situation? Biodegradable Non-biodegradable
(iii) How can we spread awareness among people 1. Substances that Substances that are
about being environment friendly? are broken down by not broken down by
Ans : [All India 2014-15] biological processes biological processes
(i) Dry leaves can be put in the cojnpost pit to make are said to be are said to be non-
manure. biodegradable. biodegradable.
(ii) Concern for environment, scientific temperament. 2. These substances These substances
(iii) Counselling, posters, print and audio visual get recycled and, require a lot of space
media. therefore, do not for dumping which
require any dumping causes wastage of
98. What is wild life? How is it important? How is it
sites. land.
being protected by government of India?
Ans : [All India 2013, 2016] Effects of biodegradable substances:
k
Wild life means our flora and fauna. It is important: a. They release harmful gases like methane,
or
a. to preserve bio-diversity. ammonia, carbon dioxide, hydrogen sulphide,
b. as each species has a position in the food chain so etc., during decomposition process.
wildlife helps in balancing the nature. b. They release foul smell only during decomposition
w
Various species of plants and animals are preserved process but they do not cause any type of soil
in botanical gardens, national parks, zoological parks pollution.
and wildlife sanctuaries.
Three environmental friendly activities are: c. They cause pollution of air, soil and water.
a. Should walk short distance to reduce use of vehicle
running on fossil fuels. 102. Make an aquatic food chain up to tertiary consumer
Y
b. Use both sides of papers to reduce its use. Less level. State the trophic level at which concentration of
trees will be cut to make more paper. pesticide is maximum and why? [Sample Paper 2010]
ng
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 217
Chap 15 : Our Enviorment www.cbse.online
Depletion of Ozone layer occurs due to release of environment and maintained ecological balance.
CFCs. This will result in UV radiation reaching the (ii) Forest wealth could be utilized for food, fodder,
earth, thereby causing skin cancer, damage to eyes fuel, fertilizers and fibers keeping in mind its
and immune system. conservation.
Two steps which can be taken are alternate technology We should conserve forests as:
and chemicals should be used to make these appliances (i) Forests purify the air and also prevent pollution
where CFs and CFCs are being used. of air and regulate the climate by maintaining the
In 1987, the United Nations Environment level of rainfall necessary for their own existence.
Programme (UNEP) succeeded in forging an (ii) Forests are a storehouse of biodiversity (hotspots
agreement to freeze CFC production at 1986 levels. of biodiversity).
Many countries have banned the use of CFCs.
WWW.CBSE.ONLINE
k
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
they affect the environment.
3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
or
Ans : [All India 2013] 4. NCERT Solutions
All wastes generated are not of the same nature. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
w
Biodegradable wastes such as plant and animal provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
can be acted upon by decomposers in nature and New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
et
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
broken down easily in simpler substances as they For School Education
possess enzymes to do so. Example: animal excreta,
hN
fruit peels, leftover food, crop refuge and so on.
Some other wastes or materials especially the
ones produced by man can not be broken down by
t
decomposers as they do not possess enzymes to do
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 218
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
k
water by disease causing bacteria. conserve them. If we were to continue consuming these
sources at such alarming rates, we would soon run out
or
2. Where are coliform bacteria found in human beings? of energy! In order to avoid this, alternate sources of
Ans : [CBSE 2016] energy must be found. Burning fossil fuels has other
w
disadvantages too.
In the colon (large intestine). The air pollution, acid rain, the greenhouse effect and
et
3. Name two ancient water harvesting structures in global warming due to gases like carbon dioxide.
Maharashtra. [CBSE 2016]
hN
10. Why management of natural resources should ensure
Ans : equitable distribution of resources? [CBSE 2015]
Bandharas and tals in Maharashtra Ans :
There should be equitable distribution of resources
t
4. Give one protective function of forest.
ou
7. Name any two wastes which can be recycled and 11. Why should biodegradable and non-biodegradable
reused. wastes be discarded in two separate dustbins?
Ans : [CBSE 2015] Ans : [CBSE 2015]
Paper, plastic. Disposal of household waste is carried out in green
and blue bins, respectively. It will be very useful
8. We need to manage our resources. List two reasons in the separate disposal of biodegradable and
to justify this statement. [CBSE 2015] non¬biodegradable wastes. This will also ensure
Ans : the application of 3Rs reduce, reuse and recycle.
a. We need to manage our resources because they Garbage from green bins is sent to compost pits and
are not unlimited biogas plants while from blue bins to factories for
b. the demand is increasing due to human population recycling.
rate increase because of improved health care. Advantage: Segregation of wastes into biodegradable
c. for sustainable development. and non biodegradable wastes at the initial stage of
disposal saves time and energy.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 219
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
12. What is meant by biodiversity hotspots ? Flora and fauna can be preserved in forests. Forests
Ans : [CBSE 2015] need to be preserved due to loss of ecological stability.
A region with large biodiversity of endangered 21. Give one example each from your daily life where the
species, many of them being highly endemic and such household waste can be effectively reused and recycled
regions being subjected to large scale destruction are respectively. [CBSE 2011,13]
designated as Hot spots by ecologists. Forests are Ans :
hotspots because they have large number of species of
plants and animals. Reuse: Used envelopes can be used again by reversing.
Recycle: Papers can be recycled by sending these back
13. Name the industries which are based on forest produce. into factories.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
22. State one reason for the conservation of forest and
Two industries which are dependent on forests for raw wildlife. [CBSE 2011,13]
materials are furniture, sports, and timber and paper Ans :
industries.
Main reason for conserving forest and wildlife is
14. List two items which can be easily recycled, but we maintenance of biodiversity and hence ecological
generally throw them in the dustbin. balance. Every organism plays a very important part
Ans : [All India 2014] in food chain that is responsible for the survival of
k
other organism.
Paper, plastic items.
or
23. List two industries which are dependent on forests for
15. Name the group of bacteria the presence of which
raw materials. [All India 2010]
confirms the contamination of water of a river.
w
Ans :
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
Two industries which are dependent on forests for raw
et
Ans : materials are furniture, sports, and timber and paper
Coliform bacteria. industries.
hN
16. Mention the action taken by Government to save river 24. Name two categories of natural resources.
Ganga. [CBSE 2014] Ans : [Delhi 2009]
Ans :
t
Renewable and non-renewable.
ou
Disposal of untreated sewage was causing harmful The renewable resources are those which can be
effects on health-Spreads water borne diseases, replenished in nature through fast natural cycles such
ng
17.
persons on the environment. Ground water.
Ans : [CBSE 2014, All India 2016] 27. How does the flow of acid rain water into a river make
@
It will prevent equitable distribution of resources so the survival of aquatic life in the river difficult?
that not all, and just a handful of rich and powerful Ans : [All India 2008)
people, benefit from the development of these
Acid water lowers the pH of river water making the
resources. They will exploit it for their own interest
survival of aquatic life difficult.
and maybe cause more damage to them.
18. List two items which can easily be recycled, but we TWO MARKS QUESTIONS
generally throw them in the dustbins.
Ans : [CBSE 2014]
28. List four stakeholders which may be helpful in the
Paper, plastic items.
conservation of forests.
19. What is meant by recycle? Ans : [All India 2018]
Ans : [All India 2013] Stakeholders are:
Converting something not useful/waste to something a. People living in or around forests who are fully
useful. dependent on forests for their life
b. The Forests Department of Government- owners
20. Where can flora and fauna be preserved? Give one of the land are working to control the resources
reason for preserving it. [Delhi 2012] from forests
Ans : c. The industrialists are using forest produce but
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 220
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
not dependent on the forests in any one area. of recycling uses some energy.
d. People involved in wildlife and nature conservation.
e. Each of the above groups depends on forests in a 33. What is meant by the three types of R (3-Rs) to
different way save the environment? Explain with examples how
you would follow the 3-Rs in your school to save the
29. The construction of large dams leads to social and environment.
environmental problems. List two problems of each Ans : [Foreign 2015]
category. [All India 2018]
3R-Reduce, Reuse, Recycle.
Ans : Examples - Switch off the fans and bulbs when not in
a. Social problems they displace large number use, - Reuse of paper, polythene bags, etc., - Reduce
of peasants and tribals without adequate the wastage of water/paper or any other item (or any
compensation or rehabilitation. other relevant example) (any two).
b. Environmental problemsthey contribute
enormously to deforestation and loss of NO NEED TO PURCHASE ANY BOOKS
biodiversity. For session 2019-2020 free pdf will be available at
www.cbse.online for
30. List four advantages of properly managed watershed 1. Previous 15 Years Exams Chapter-wise Question
management. [Delhi 2016) Bank
Ans :
k
2. Previous Ten Years Exam Paper (Paper-wise).
Advantages: 3. 20 Model Paper (All Solved).
or
a. It helps in restoring fertility of soil and thus 4. NCERT Solutions
raising crop production. All material will be solved and free pdf. It will be
w
b. It provides clean drinking water for all. provided by 30 September and will be updated regularly.
Disclaimer : www.cbse.online is not affiliated to Central Board of Secondary Education,
c. Infrastructure for storage, transport and New Delhi in any manner. www.cbse.online is a private organization which provide free
et
study material pdfs to students. At www.cbse.online CBSE stands for Canny Books
agricultural market. For School Education
d. It helped in local water supply for irriga¬tion,
hN
hydro power stations, prevention of floods.
34. List four advantage of water stored in the ground as
31. Why are forests considered biodiversity hotspots? List groundwater. [Foreign 2015]
two ways in which an individual contribute effectively or
t
in the management of forests and wildlife. [Delhi 2015] List any four advantages of groundwater over surface
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 221
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
Biodiversity - number and range of variety of species on land as rain or snow, by making the traditional
of life forms in an area. Effect - loss of diversity may structures like ponds, tanks, small earthen dams,
lead to a loss of ecological stability. constructing dykes, sand and limestone reservoirs etc.
It recharges groundwater locally.
37. List any two advantages associated with water stored
in the ground. [CBSE 2015] 42. Water is a valuable resource. List two ways that
Ans : you would suggest every family member to save this
resource.
Watershed management not only increases the
production and income of the watershed community, Ans : [CBSE 2015]
but also mitigates droughts and floods and increases Using water judiciously by
the life of the downstream dam and reservoirs. a. Using mug and bucket instead of shower to take
It develops primary resources of land and water, bath or while washing car or floor.
to produce secondary resources of , plants and animals b. Reusing water like after washing vegetables we
for use in a manner which will not cause ecological can use it for watering plants.
imbalance. 43. List two measures that you would suggest for the
38. We often observe domestic waste decomposing in the
better management of water resources. [CBSE 2015]
bylanes of our homes. List four ways to make the Ans :
k
residents aware that the improper disposal of wastes a. Rainwater harvesting.
is harmful to the environment and also for their own b. Treatment of waste water.
or
health. [CBSE 2015] c. Storage of water in large tanks, ponds for use in
Ans : agriculture and industry, etc.
w
Creating environmental awareness amongst the 44. What is watershed management? List two benefits
residents spreading the same in the society can be
et
derived by the communities that participate in this
done by system.
a. Organizing cleanliness drives.
hN
Ans : [All India 2014]
b. Insisting on segregating garbage in blue and green
bins. Ans :
c. Reducing the garbage generated from home by
Watershed management emphasises scientific soil and
reusing and reducing strategy.
t
water conservation in order to increase the biomass
ou
cycle, providing some products and maintaining harvesting at community level. [All India 2017]
soil fertility. Ans :
40. Why is sustainable management of natural resources Watershed management:
necessary? Out of the two - reuse and recycle - which, a. increases the production and income of the
in your opinion, is better to practise? Give reason. watershed community,
b. mitigates droughts and floods and increases the
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
life of the downstream dam and reservoirs.
A type of management which encourages utilization
of resources that meet current basic human needs 46. State two main concepts of sustainable development.
while preserving the resources for the needs of future Ans : [CBSE 2014]
generations.
Sustainable development means to adopt such
Reuse is better as it does not consume energy. means of development to fulfil the human needs
which can maintain a balance between environment
41. State the main purpose of water harvesting and development and prevent degradation of the
management and mention the source which fills the environment thereby sustaining the resources for
ponds behind harvesting structures. further use. We must increase the vegetation and
Ans : [CBSE 2015] green grasses patches between the concrete buildings.
Water harvesting is an age old technique adopted by We should use environmentally sound technologies
local people for catching every drop of water falling which do not pollute the environment.
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 222
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
47. What do the three Rs refer to save the environment? We need to use fossil fuels judiciously because
Which one of these would be the best for environment? a. Fossil fuels are non-renewable. They are depleting
Ans : [CBSE 2014,15] at very fast rate.
b. Products of combustion of fossil fuel are CO2
Reduce, Reuse, Recycle.
and CO which are green house gases. They are
ExamplesSwitch off the fans and bulbs when not
responsible for greenhouse effect as they trap heat
in use,
reflected by earth so they cause global warming.
Reuse of paper, polythene bags, etc., Reduce the
c. Soot and smoke cause air pollution.
wastage of water/paper or any other item (or any
d. Gases dissolve in rain water and cause acid rain.
other relevant example) (any two)
53. Local people around forests are referred to as
48. Industrialisation are one of the major causes of
stakeholders for conservation of forests. Give
deforestation. State two reasons. [CBSE 2014]
reasons. [CBSE 2013]
Ans :
Ans :
a. Forests also provide raw material for industries
Stakeholders are people who have some sort of interest
like rubber, wood, timber.
in the forests.
b. They also provide fuel wood, paper, honey, wax,
a. Forests serve as a source of income to tribal
lac, gum, resin, kattha, edible fruits and medicinal
societies even today. In turn they look after the
plants for industries.
k
plants and animals living in the forests.
49. List the products of combustion of fossil fuels. What b. Local people around forests: People living in or
or
are their adverse effects on the environment? around forests who are fully dependent on forests
for their life.
Ans : [All India 2013]
w
(1) Use of bamboo to make huts
Fossil fuels are used in industries and produce large (2) Use of baskets for collecting and storing food
amount of acidic and greenhouse gases, oxides of materials
nitrogen and sulphur, carbon-di-oxide, that are
given out dining burning of fossil fuel and contribute
et (3) Use of wood to make implements for
agriculture, fishing and hunting
hN
towards acid rain formation. Acid rain occur due to (4) Do fishing and hunting in forest
air pollution. When oxides of nitrogen and sulphur in (5) Gather fruits, nuts and medicines from forests
air dissolve in rain water, they form nitric acid and (6) Graze cattle in forests
t
sulphuric acid respectively. Rain carrying these acids
These people lived in forests for centuries and
ou
51. Write the harmful effects of using plastic bags, on the grasses patches between the concrete buildings. We
environment. Suggest alternatives to plastic bags. should use environmentally sound technologies which
Ans : [CBSE 2013] do not pollute the environment.
Reuse is better than recycling as it does not require
Harmful effects of using plastic bags : energy.
a. Plastic bags persist in environment without
getting degraded. 55. What are fossil fuels? Give two examples of fossil fuels.
b. They block water drains and clogging stagnates Ans : [CBSE 2011]
dirty water serving as breeding ground of
The fossils fuels are the fuels formed when plants and
mosquitoes.
animal get buried under
c. Burning plastic pollutes air.
a. Soil and do not get decompose much due to lack
Alternatives to plastic bags :
of oxygen.
a. Reuse of things such as poly-bags, etc.
b. Coal and petroleum
b. Recycle of waste
c. Use of cotton jute bags for carrying vegetables 56. List any four methods of conserving fossil fuels.
etc.
Ans : [CBSE 2011]
52. We need to use fossil fuels judiciously. Justify the a. Using solar cooker
statement. b. Use of pressure cooker
Ans : [CBSE 2013] c. Using public transport
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 223
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
d. Using CFL in that area rather than running off to water bodies
e. Avoid using lift or AC and going to far off places.
f. Switching off engine at traffic light. It is an age-old technique adopted by local people
57. (a) Why are coal and petroleum called fossil fuels?
by making the traditional structures like ponds,
(b) Name any two elements present in fossil fuels in tanks, small earthen dams, constructing dykes, sand
addition in carbon. [CBSE 2011] and limestone reservoirs etc.
The terms used in different states and languages are
Ans :
used for water harvesting structures are:
(a) Because they form when plants and animal get a. khadins, tanks and nadis in Rajasthan.
buried under soil and do not get decomposed b. Bandharas and tals in Maharashtra
much due to lack of oxygen.
(b) Nitrogen and sulphur. 62. As an individual how can you contribute or make a
difference to the management of resources to use them
58. Mention four advantages of exploiting sources with in a sustainable manner.
short-term perspective. Ans : [Delhi 2008C, All India 2009]
Ans : [Delhi 2009]
As an individual I can contribute or make a difference
Exploiting sources with short- term perspective to the management of resources to use them in a
means using the natural resources keeping in mind sustainable manner in the following manner:
k
the benefits to only present generation. a. using paper on both side.
The four advantages are: b. using a jute bag instead of plastic or polythene
or
a. It will be providing food, clothes and other things bag.
for comfort of present generation. c. Throwing organic and recyclable waste in separate
w
b. There will be development in all fields. bins.
c. In general, progress will be visible as powerful and d. Growing more plants.
et
rich people will be able to setup more industries
gaining a lot of money and power.
THREE MARKS QUESTIONS
hN
d. Living standards of people will rise.
these advantages. When we exploit our resources with stored for irrigation and to produce hydroelectricity.
a long-term perspective, it would lead to sustainable Ill planned dams cause following problems:
a. social problems because they displace large
yi
problems. There will be equitable distribution of b. Economic problems because they swallow up huge
sources among all, not just with rich and powerful. amount of public money without generation of
@
proportionate benefits
60. What is wildlife? How is it preserved? Why is it c. Environmental problems because they contribute
important to preserve it? enormously to deforestation and loss of
Ans : [Delhi 2009] biodiversity.
Wild life means our flora and fauna. Its biodiversity 64. (a) Water is an elixir of life, a very important natural
i.e., various species of plants and animals should resource. Your science teacher wants you to
be preserved in botanical gardens, national parks, prepare a plan for your formative assessment, how
zoological parks and wildlife sanctuaries. Wild life is to save water- a vital natural resource. Write two
important: ways that you will suggest to bring awareness in
a. to preserve bio-diversity. your neighbourhood, on how to save water.
b. Each species has a position in the food chain so (b) Name and explain one-way by which underground
wildlife helps in balancing the nature. water table does not go down further.
61. What is water harvesting? Name some ways followed
Ans : [All India 2017]]
by local people for it. (a) (1) will arrange guest speaker program, poster
Ans : [All India 2009 C] making competition and make everyone aware of
the reducing water resources for us.
Water harvesting is a technique to collect water from (2) I will make models on water harvesting
rain in underground or overhead reservoirs so that it and through exhibits teach people in
can seep down the soil once more to form groundwater neighbourhood the technique to collect
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 224
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
water from rain in underground or overhead Washing machine is on, father is washing his car with
reservoirs so that it can seep down the soil the hose¬pipe, daughter is brushing with the tap on,
once more to form groundwater in that area son is enjoying shower for more than half hour and
rather than running off to water bodies and the mother is washing the floor with the bucket full
going to far off places. of water.
(b) Water harvesting is an age old technique adopted a. What changes in the above situation can be done
by local people by making the traditional to conserve water?
structures like ponds, tanks, small earthen dams, b. Why do we need to conserve water when water is
constructing dykes, sand and limestone reservoirs non-exhaustible renewable resource?
etc. c. What values are being neglected by the family?
Ans : [All India 2014-15]
65. What were the main reasons behind Ganga Action
Plan which was initiated in 1985? What values can (a) In the above situation to conserve water one
be learnt from such plans? [CBSE 2016] should try to reduce the use by using bucket and
Ans : mug for taking bath, washing clothes and car. Tap
should be closed while brushing teeth.
The Ganga Action Plan was initiated in 1985 to (b) Fresh water resources are very less. Ocean water
clean up the Ganga river. We know that the Ganga is can not be used for daily activities.
facing serious problem of pollution due to industrial (c) Concern for environment, economy in use
k
effluents, domestic sewage, etc.
Rivers are one of the main sources for drinking 69. Describe the structure of a traditional water harvesting
or
water. It is also used for irrigation. So we must do system with the help of a diagram.
everything to keep our rivers clean. Life in the Indo- Ans : [All India 2013]
w
Gangetic plain depends upon a clean River Ganga. The structure of a traditional water harvesting system
is shown below.
et
66. Differentiate between biodegradable and non-
biodegradable substances with the help of one
example each. List two changes in habit that people
hN
must adopt to dispose non-biodegradable waste, for
saving the environment.
Ans : [CBSE 2015]
t
ou
down into simpler substances by nature / decomposers. built across a seasonally flooded gullies. Monsoon
Example: Plastic/ glass (or any other) rains fill the ponds behind structures. Only the largest
Habits: structure hold the water year round. Most of them dry
yi
a. Use of separate dustbins for biodegradable and up six months or less after the monsoon.
non-biodegradable waste.
Fl
b. Reuse of things such as poly-bags, metal glass 70. (a) Mention any two advantages of constructing
and plastic cans, bottles again instead of throwing dams.
them. (b) Name a dam which was a subject of much
@
k
a. Social disparity and Political forces
Only rich and powerful people are benefited:
b. Economical disparity.
or
We need to use resources carefully because -
a. they are not unlimited 76. Suggest any six approaches towards the conservation
b. the demand is increasing due to human population of forests. [CBSE 2008 C]
w
rate increase because of improved health care.
Ans :
c. for sustainable development
et
We should conserve forest because
73. Why should we aim at sustainable development while a. Forests purify the air, prevent pollution of air,
hN
utilizing our natural resources? [Delhi 2010] regulate the climate by maintaining the level of
Ans : rainfall necessary for their own existence.
b. Forests are necessary to replenish ground water,
Sustainable development means to adopt such
check floods and soil erosion and maintain soil
t
means of development to fulfill the human needs
fertility.
ou
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 226
Chap 16 : Managment of Natural Resources www.cbse.online
k
or
w
et
t hN
ou
Y
ng
yi
Fl
@
Download all GUIDE and Sample Paper pdfs from www.cbse.online or www.rava.org.in Page 227